1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10 11 12 13 14 15 16 17 18 19 20 21 22 23 24 25 26 27 28 29 30 31 32 33 34 35 36 37 38 39 40 41 42 43 44 45 46 47 48 49 50 51 52 53 54 55 56 57 58 59 60 61 62 63 64 65 66 67 68 69 70 71 72 73 74 75 76 77 78 79 80 81 82 83 84 85 86 87 88 89 90 91 92 93 94 95 96 97 98 99 100 101 102 103 104 105 106 107 108 109 110 111 112 113 114 115 116 117 118 119 120 121 122 123 124 125 126 127 128 129 130 131 132 133 134 135 136 137 138 139 140 141 142 143 144 145 146 147 148 149 150 151 152 153 154 155 156 157 158 159 160 161 162 163 164 165 166 167 168 169 170 171 172 173 174 175 176 177 178 179 180 181 182 183 184 185 186 187 188 189 190 191 192 193 194 195 196 197 198 199 200 201 202 203 204 205 206 207 208 209 210 211 212 213 214 215 216 217 218 219 220 221 222 223 224 225 226 227 228 229 230 231 232 233 234 235 236 237 238 239 240 241 242 243 244 245 246 247 248 249 250 251 252 253 254 255 256 257 258 259 260 261 262 263 264 265 266 267 268 269 270 271 272 273 274 275 276 277 278 279 280 281 282 283 284 285 286 287 288 289 290 291 292 293 294 295 296 297 298 299 300 301 302 303 304 305 306 307 308 309 310 311 312 313 314 315 316 317 318 319 320 321 322 323 324 325 326 327 328 329 330 331 332 333 334 335 336 337 338 339 340 341 342 343 344 345 346 347 348 349 350 351 352 353 354 355 356 357 358 359 360 361 362 363 364 365 366 367 368 369 370 371 372 373 374 375 376 377 378 379 380 381 382 383 384 385 386 387 388 389 390 391 392 393 394 395 396 397 398 399 400 401 402 403 404 405 406 407 408 409 410 411 412 413 414 415 416 417 418 419 420 421 422 423 424 425 426 427 428 429 430 431 432 433 434 435 436 437 438 439 440 441 442 443 444 445 446 447 448 449 450 451 452 453 454 455 456 457 458 459 460 461 462 463 464 465 466 467 468 469 470 471 472 473 474 475 476 477 478 479 480 481 482 483 484 485 486 487 488 489 490 491 492 493 494 495 496 497 498 499 500 501 502 503 504 505 506 507 508 509 510 511 512 513 514 515 516 517 518 519 520 521 522 523 524 525 526 527 528 529 530 531 532 533 534 535 536 537 538 539 540 541 542 543 544 545 546 547 548 549 550 551 552 553 554 555 556 557 558 559 560 561 562 563 564 565 566 567 568 569 570 571 572 573 574 575 576 577 578 579 580 581 582 583 584 585 586 587 588 589 590 591 592 593 594 595 596 597 598 599 600 601 602 603 604 605 606 607 608 609 610 611 612 613 614 615 616 617 618 619 620 621 622 623 624 625 626 627 628 629 630 631 632 633 634 635 636 637 638 639 640 641 642 643 644 645 646 647 648 649 650 651 652 653 654 655 656 657 658 659 660 661 662 663 664 665 666 667 668 669 670 671 672 673 674 675 676 677 678 679 680 681 682 683 684 685 686 687 688 689 690 691 692 693 694 695 696 697 698 699 700 701 702 703 704 705 706 707 708 709 710 711 712 713 714 715 716 717 718 719 720 721 722 723 724 725 726 727 728 729 730 731 732 733 734 735 736 737 738 739 740 741 742 743 744 745 746 747 748 749 750 751 752 753 754 755 756 757 758 759 760 761 762 763 764 765 766 767 768 769 770 771 772 773 774 775 776 777 778 779 780 781 782 783 784 785 786 787 788 789 790 791 792 793 794 795 796 797 798 799 800 801 802 803 804 805 806 807 808 809 810 811 812 813 814 815 816 817 818 819 820 821 822 823 824 825 826 827 828 829 830 831 832 833 834 835 836 837 838 839 840 841 842 843 844 845 846 847 848 849 850 851 852 853 854 855 856 857 858 859 860 861 862 863 864 865 866 867 868 869 870 871 872 873 874 875 876 877 878 879 880 881 882 883 884 885 886 887 888 889 890 891 892 893 894 895 896 897 898 899 900 901 902 903 904 905 906 907 908 909 910 911 912 913 914 915 916 917 918 919 920 921 922 923 924 925 926 927 928 929 930 931 932 933 934 935 936 937 938 939 940 941 942 943 944 945 946 947 948 949 950 951 952 953 954 955 956 957 958 959 960 961 962 963 964 965 966 967 968 969 970 971 972 973 974 975 976 977 978 979 980 981 982 983 984 985 986 987 988 989 990 991 992 993 994 995 996 997 998 999 1000 1001 1002 1003 1004 1005 1006 1007 1008 1009 1010 1011 1012 1013 1014 1015 1016 1017 1018 1019 1020 1021 1022 1023 1024 1025 1026 1027 1028 1029 1030 1031 1032 1033 1034 1035 1036 1037 1038 1039 1040 1041 1042 1043 1044 1045 1046 1047 1048 1049 1050 1051 1052 1053 1054 1055 1056 1057 1058 1059 1060 1061 1062 1063 1064 1065 1066 1067 1068 1069 1070 1071 1072 1073 1074 1075 1076 1077 1078 1079 1080 1081 1082 1083 1084 1085 1086 1087 1088 1089 1090 1091 1092 1093 1094 1095 1096 1097 1098 1099 1100 1101 1102 1103 1104 1105 1106 1107 1108 1109 1110 1111 1112 1113 1114 1115 1116 1117 1118 1119 1120 1121 1122 1123 1124 1125 1126 1127 1128 1129 1130 1131 1132 1133 1134 1135 1136 1137 1138 1139 1140 1141 1142 1143 1144 1145 1146 1147 1148 1149 1150 1151 1152 1153 1154 1155 1156 1157 1158 1159 1160 1161 1162 1163 1164 1165 1166 1167 1168 1169 1170 1171 1172 1173 1174 1175 1176 1177 1178 1179 1180 1181 1182 1183 1184 1185 1186 1187 1188 1189 1190 1191 1192 1193 1194 1195 1196 1197 1198 1199 1200 1201 1202 1203 1204 1205 1206 1207 1208 1209 1210 1211 1212 1213 1214 1215 1216 1217 1218 1219 1220 1221 1222 1223 1224 1225 1226 1227 1228 1229 1230 1231 1232 1233 1234 1235 1236 1237 1238 1239 1240 1241 1242 1243 1244 1245 1246 1247 1248 1249 1250 1251 1252 1253 1254 1255 1256 1257 1258 1259 1260 1261 1262 1263 1264 1265 1266 1267 1268 1269 1270 1271 1272 1273 1274 1275 1276 1277 1278 1279 1280 1281 1282 1283 1284 1285 1286 1287 1288 1289 1290 1291 1292 1293 1294 1295 1296 1297 1298 1299 1300 1301 1302 1303 1304 1305 1306 1307 1308 1309 1310 1311 1312 1313 1314 1315 1316 1317 1318 1319 1320 1321 1322 1323 1324 1325 1326 1327 1328 1329 1330 1331 1332 1333 1334 1335 1336 1337 1338 1339 1340 1341 1342 1343 1344 1345 1346 1347 1348 1349 1350 1351 1352 1353 1354 1355 1356 1357 1358 1359 1360 1361 1362 1363 1364 1365 1366 1367 1368 1369 1370 1371 1372 1373 1374 1375 1376 1377 1378 1379 1380 1381 1382 1383 1384 1385 1386 1387 1388 1389 1390 1391 1392 1393 1394 1395 1396 1397 1398 1399 1400 1401 1402 1403 1404 1405 1406 1407 1408 1409 1410 1411 1412 1413 1414 1415 1416 1417 1418 1419 1420 1421 1422 1423 1424 1425 1426 1427 1428 1429 1430 1431 1432 1433 1434 1435 1436 1437 1438 1439 1440 1441 1442 1443 1444 1445 1446 1447 1448 1449 1450 1451 1452 1453 1454 1455 1456 1457 1458 1459 1460 1461 1462 1463 1464 1465 1466 1467 1468 1469 1470 1471 1472 1473 1474 1475 1476 1477 1478 1479 1480 1481 1482 1483 1484 1485 1486 1487 1488 1489 1490 1491 1492 1493 1494 1495 1496 1497 1498 1499 1500 1501 1502 1503 1504 1505 1506 1507 1508 1509 1510 1511 1512 1513 1514 1515 1516 1517 1518 1519 1520 1521 1522 1523 1524 1525 1526 1527 1528 1529 1530 1531 1532 1533 1534 1535 1536 1537 1538 1539 1540 1541 1542 1543 1544 1545 1546 1547 1548 1549 1550 1551 1552 1553 1554 1555 1556 1557 1558 1559 1560 1561 1562 1563 1564 1565 1566 1567 1568 1569 1570 1571 1572 1573 1574 1575 1576 1577 1578 1579 1580 1581 1582 1583 1584 1585 1586 1587 1588 1589 1590 1591 1592 1593 1594 1595 1596 1597 1598 1599 1600 1601 1602 1603 1604 1605 1606 1607 1608 1609 1610 1611 1612 1613 1614 1615 1616 1617 1618 1619 1620 1621 1622 1623 1624 1625 1626 1627 1628 1629 1630 1631 1632 1633 1634 1635 1636 1637 1638 1639 1640 1641 1642 1643 1644 1645 1646 1647 1648 1649 1650 1651 1652 1653 1654 1655 1656 1657 1658 1659 1660 1661 1662 1663 1664 1665 1666 1667 1668 1669 1670 1671 1672 1673 1674 1675 1676 1677 1678 1679 1680 1681 1682 1683 1684 1685 1686 1687 1688 1689 1690 1691 1692 1693 1694 1695 1696 1697 1698 1699 1700 1701 1702 1703 1704 1705 1706 1707 1708 1709 1710 1711 1712 1713 1714 1715 1716 1717 1718 1719 1720 1721 1722 1723 1724 1725 1726 1727 1728 1729 1730 1731 1732 1733 1734 1735 1736 1737 1738 1739 1740 1741 1742 1743 1744 1745 1746 1747 1748 1749 1750 1751 1752 1753 1754 1755 1756 1757 1758 1759 1760 1761 1762 1763 1764 1765 1766 1767 1768 1769 1770 1771 1772 1773 1774 1775 1776 1777 1778 1779 1780 1781 1782 1783 1784 1785 1786 1787 1788 1789 1790 1791 1792 1793 1794 1795 1796 1797 1798 1799 1800 1801 1802 1803 1804 1805 1806 1807 1808 1809 1810 1811 1812 1813 1814 1815 1816 1817 1818 1819 1820 1821 1822 1823 1824 1825 1826 1827 1828 1829 1830 1831 1832 1833 1834 1835 1836 1837 1838 1839 1840 1841 1842 1843 1844 1845 1846 1847 1848 1849 1850 1851 1852 1853 1854 1855 1856 1857 1858 1859 1860 1861 1862 1863 1864 1865 1866 1867 1868 1869 1870 1871 1872 1873 1874 1875 1876 1877 1878 1879 1880 1881 1882 1883 1884 1885 1886 1887 1888 1889 1890 1891 1892 1893 1894 1895 1896 1897 1898 1899 1900 1901 1902 1903 1904 1905 1906 1907 1908 1909 1910 1911 1912 1913 1914 1915 1916 1917 1918 1919 1920 1921 1922 1923 1924 1925 1926 1927 1928 1929 1930 1931 1932 1933 1934 1935 1936 1937 1938 1939 1940 1941 1942 1943 1944 1945 1946 1947 1948 1949 1950 1951 1952 1953 1954 1955 1956 1957 1958 1959 1960 1961 1962 1963 1964 1965 1966 1967 1968 1969 1970 1971 1972 1973 1974 1975 1976 1977 1978 1979 1980 1981 1982 1983 1984 1985 1986 1987 1988 1989 1990 1991 1992 1993 1994 1995 1996 1997 1998 1999 2000 2001 2002 2003 2004 2005 2006 2007 2008 2009 2010 2011 2012 2013 2014 2015 2016 2017 2018 2019 2020 2021 2022 2023 2024 2025 2026 2027 2028 2029 2030 2031 2032 2033 2034 2035 2036 2037 2038 2039 2040 2041 2042 2043 2044 2045 2046 2047 2048 2049 2050 2051 2052 2053 2054 2055 2056 2057 2058 2059 2060 2061 2062 2063 2064 2065 2066 2067 2068 2069 2070 2071 2072 2073 2074 2075 2076 2077 2078 2079 2080 2081 2082 2083 2084 2085 2086 2087 2088 2089 2090 2091 2092 2093 2094 2095 2096 2097 2098 2099 2100 2101 2102 2103 2104 2105 2106 2107 2108 2109 2110 2111 2112 2113 2114 2115 2116 2117 2118 2119 2120 2121 2122 2123 2124 2125 2126 2127 2128 2129 2130 2131 2132 2133 2134 2135 2136 2137 2138 2139 2140 2141 2142 2143 2144 2145 2146 2147 2148 2149 2150 2151 2152 2153 2154 2155 2156 2157 2158 2159 2160 2161 2162 2163 2164 2165 2166 2167 2168 2169 2170 2171 2172 2173 2174 2175 2176 2177 2178 2179 2180 2181 2182 2183 2184 2185 2186 2187 2188 2189 2190 2191 2192 2193 2194 2195 2196 2197 2198 2199 2200 2201 2202 2203 2204 2205 2206 2207 2208 2209 2210 2211 2212 2213 2214 2215 2216 2217 2218 2219 2220 2221 2222 2223 2224 2225 2226 2227 2228 2229 2230 2231 2232 2233 2234 2235 2236 2237 2238 2239 2240 2241 2242 2243 2244 2245 2246 2247 2248 2249 2250 2251 2252 2253 2254 2255 2256 2257 2258 2259 2260 2261 2262 2263 2264 2265 2266 2267 2268 2269 2270 2271 2272 2273 2274 2275 2276 2277 2278 2279 2280 2281 2282 2283 2284 2285 2286 2287 2288 2289 2290 2291 2292 2293 2294 2295 2296 2297 2298 2299 2300 2301 2302 2303 2304 2305 2306 2307 2308 2309 2310 2311 2312 2313 2314 2315 2316 2317 2318 2319 2320 2321 2322 2323 2324 2325 2326 2327 2328 2329 2330 2331 2332 2333 2334 2335 2336 2337 2338 2339 2340 2341 2342 2343 2344 2345 2346 2347 2348 2349 2350 2351 2352 2353 2354 2355 2356 2357 2358 2359 2360 2361 2362 2363 2364 2365 2366 2367 2368 2369 2370 2371 2372 2373 2374 2375 2376 2377 2378 2379 2380 2381 2382 2383 2384 2385 2386 2387 2388 2389 2390 2391 2392 2393 2394 2395 2396 2397 2398 2399 2400 2401 2402 2403 2404 2405 2406 2407 2408 2409 2410 2411 2412 2413 2414 2415 2416 2417 2418 2419 2420 2421 2422 2423 2424 2425 2426 2427 2428 2429 2430 2431 2432 2433 2434 2435 2436 2437 2438 2439 2440 2441 2442 2443 2444 2445 2446 2447 2448 2449 2450 2451 2452 2453 2454 2455 2456 2457 2458 2459 2460 2461 2462 2463 2464 2465 2466 2467 2468 2469 2470 2471 2472 2473 2474 2475 2476 2477 2478 2479 2480 2481 2482 2483 2484 2485 2486 2487 2488 2489 2490 2491 2492 2493 2494 2495 2496 2497 2498 2499 2500 2501 2502 2503 2504 2505 2506 2507 2508 2509 2510 2511 2512 2513 2514 2515 2516 2517 2518 2519 2520 2521 2522 2523 2524 2525 2526 2527 2528 2529 2530 2531 2532 2533 2534 2535 2536 2537 2538 2539 2540 2541 2542 2543 2544 2545 2546 2547 2548 2549 2550 2551 2552 2553 2554 2555 2556 2557 2558 2559 2560 2561 2562 2563 2564 2565 2566 2567 2568 2569 2570 2571 2572 2573 2574 2575 2576 2577 2578 2579 2580 2581 2582 2583 2584 2585 2586 2587 2588 2589 2590 2591 2592 2593 2594 2595 2596 2597 2598 2599 2600 2601 2602 2603 2604 2605 2606 2607 2608 2609 2610 2611 2612 2613 2614 2615 2616 2617 2618 2619 2620 2621 2622 2623 2624 2625 2626 2627 2628 2629 2630 2631 2632 2633 2634 2635 2636 2637 2638 2639 2640 2641 2642 2643 2644 2645 2646 2647 2648 2649 2650 2651 2652 2653 2654 2655 2656 2657 2658 2659 2660 2661 2662 2663 2664 2665 2666 2667 2668 2669 2670 2671 2672 2673 2674 2675 2676 2677 2678 2679 2680 2681 2682 2683 2684 2685 2686 2687 2688 2689 2690 2691 2692 2693 2694 2695 2696 2697 2698 2699 2700 2701 2702 2703 2704 2705 2706 2707 2708 2709 2710 2711 2712 2713 2714 2715 2716 2717 2718 2719 2720 2721 2722 2723 2724 2725 2726 2727 2728 2729 2730 2731 2732 2733 2734 2735 2736 2737 2738 2739 2740 2741 2742 2743 2744 2745 2746 2747 2748 2749 2750 2751 2752 2753 2754 2755 2756 2757 2758 2759 2760 2761 2762 2763 2764 2765 2766 2767 2768 2769 2770 2771 2772 2773 2774 2775 2776 2777 2778 2779 2780 2781 2782 2783 2784 2785 2786 2787 2788 2789 2790 2791 2792 2793 2794 2795 2796 2797 2798 2799 2800 2801 2802 2803 2804 2805 2806 2807 2808 2809 2810 2811 2812 2813 2814 2815 2816 2817 2818 2819 2820 2821 2822 2823 2824 2825 2826 2827 2828 2829 2830 2831 2832 2833 2834 2835 2836 2837 2838 2839 2840 2841 2842 2843 2844 2845 2846 2847 2848 2849 2850 2851 2852 2853 2854 2855 2856 2857 2858 2859 2860 2861 2862 2863 2864 2865 2866 2867 2868 2869 2870 2871 2872 2873 2874 2875 2876 2877 2878 2879 2880 2881 2882 2883 2884 2885 2886 2887 2888 2889 2890 2891 2892 2893 2894 2895 2896 2897 2898 2899 2900 2901 2902 2903 2904 2905 2906 2907 2908 2909 2910 2911 2912 2913 2914 2915 2916 2917 2918 2919 2920 2921 2922 2923 2924 2925 2926 2927 2928 2929 2930 2931 2932 2933 2934 2935 2936 2937 2938 2939 2940 2941 2942 2943 2944 2945 2946 2947 2948 2949 2950 2951 2952 2953 2954 2955 2956 2957 2958 2959 2960 2961 2962 2963 2964 2965 2966 2967 2968 2969 2970 2971 2972 2973 2974 2975 2976 2977 2978 2979 2980 2981 2982 2983 2984 2985 2986 2987 2988 2989 2990 2991 2992 2993 2994 2995 2996 2997 2998 2999 3000 3001 3002 3003 3004 3005 3006 3007 3008 3009 3010 3011 3012 3013 3014 3015 3016 3017 3018 3019 3020 3021 3022 3023 3024 3025 3026 3027 3028 3029 3030 3031 3032 3033 3034 3035 3036 3037 3038 3039 3040 3041 3042 3043 3044 3045 3046 3047 3048 3049 3050 3051 3052 3053 3054 3055 3056 3057 3058 3059 3060 3061 3062 3063 3064 3065 3066 3067 3068 3069 3070 3071 3072 3073 3074 3075 3076 3077 3078 3079 3080 3081 3082 3083 3084 3085 3086 3087 3088 3089 3090 3091 3092 3093 3094 3095 3096 3097 3098 3099 3100 3101 3102 3103 3104 3105 3106 3107 3108 3109 3110 3111 3112 3113 3114 3115 3116 3117 3118 3119 3120 3121 3122 3123 3124 3125 3126 3127 3128 3129 3130 3131 3132 3133 3134 3135 3136 3137 3138 3139 3140 3141 3142 3143 3144 3145 3146 3147 3148 3149 3150 3151 3152 3153 3154 3155 3156 3157 3158 3159 3160 3161 3162 3163 3164 3165 3166 3167 3168 3169 3170 3171 3172 3173 3174 3175 3176 3177 3178 3179 3180 3181 3182 3183 3184 3185 3186 3187 3188 3189 3190 3191 3192 3193 3194 3195 3196 3197 3198 3199 3200 3201 3202 3203 3204 3205 3206 3207 3208 3209 3210 3211 3212 3213 3214 3215 3216 3217 3218 3219 3220 3221 3222 3223 3224 3225 3226 3227 3228 3229 3230 3231 3232 3233 3234 3235 3236 3237 3238 3239 3240 3241 3242 3243 3244 3245 3246 3247 3248 3249 3250 3251 3252 3253 3254 3255 3256 3257 3258 3259 3260 3261 3262 3263 3264 3265 3266 3267 3268 3269 3270 3271 3272 3273 3274 3275 3276 3277 3278 3279 3280 3281 3282 3283 3284 3285 3286 3287 3288 3289 3290 3291 3292 3293 3294 3295 3296 3297 3298 3299 3300 3301 3302 3303 3304 3305 3306 3307 3308 3309 3310 3311 3312 3313 3314 3315 3316 3317 3318 3319 3320 3321 3322 3323 3324 3325 3326 3327 3328 3329 3330 3331 3332 3333 3334 3335 3336 3337 3338 3339 3340 3341 3342 3343 3344 3345 3346 3347 3348 3349 3350 3351 3352 3353 3354 3355 3356 3357 3358 3359 3360 3361 3362 3363 3364 3365 3366 3367 3368 3369 3370 3371 3372 3373 3374 3375 3376 3377 3378 3379 3380 3381 3382 3383 3384 3385 3386 3387 3388 3389 3390 3391 3392 3393 3394 3395 3396 3397 3398 3399 3400 3401 3402 3403 3404 3405 3406 3407 3408 3409 3410 3411 3412 3413 3414 3415 3416 3417 3418 3419 3420 3421 3422 3423 3424 3425 3426 3427 3428 3429 3430 3431 3432 3433 3434 3435 3436 3437 3438 3439 3440 3441 3442 3443 3444 3445 3446 3447 3448 3449 3450 3451 3452 3453 3454 3455 3456 3457 3458 3459 3460 3461 3462 3463 3464 3465 3466 3467 3468 3469 3470 3471 3472 3473 3474 3475 3476 3477 3478 3479 3480 3481 3482 3483 3484 3485 3486 3487 3488 3489 3490 3491 3492 3493 3494 3495 3496 3497 3498 3499 3500 3501 3502 3503 3504 3505 3506 3507 3508 3509 3510 3511 3512 3513 3514 3515 3516 3517 3518 3519 3520 3521 3522 3523 3524 3525 3526 3527 3528 3529 3530 3531 3532 3533 3534 3535 3536 3537 3538 3539 3540 3541 3542 3543 3544 3545 3546 3547 3548 3549 3550 3551 3552 3553 3554 3555 3556 3557 3558 3559 3560 3561 3562 3563 3564 3565 3566 3567 3568 3569 3570 3571 3572 3573 3574 3575 3576 3577 3578 3579 3580 3581 3582 3583 3584 3585 3586 3587 3588 3589 3590 3591 3592 3593 3594 3595 3596 3597 3598 3599 3600 3601 3602 3603 3604 3605 3606 3607 3608 3609 3610 3611 3612 3613 3614 3615 3616 3617 3618 3619 3620 3621 3622 3623 3624 3625 3626 3627 3628 3629 3630 3631 3632 3633 3634 3635 3636 3637 3638 3639 3640 3641 3642 3643 3644 3645 3646 3647 3648 3649 3650 3651 3652 3653 3654 3655 3656 3657 3658 3659 3660 3661 3662 3663 3664 3665 3666 3667 3668 3669 3670 3671 3672 3673 3674 3675 3676 3677 3678 3679 3680 3681 3682 3683 3684 3685 3686 3687 3688 3689 3690 3691 3692 3693 3694 3695 3696 3697 3698 3699 3700 3701 3702 3703 3704 3705 3706 3707 3708 3709 3710 3711 3712 3713 3714 3715 3716 3717 3718 3719 3720 3721 3722 3723 3724 3725 3726 3727 3728 3729 3730 3731 3732 3733 3734 3735 3736 3737 3738 3739 3740 3741 3742 3743 3744 3745 3746 3747 3748 3749 3750 3751 3752 3753 3754 3755 3756 3757 3758 3759 3760 3761 3762 3763 3764 3765 3766 3767 3768 3769 3770 3771 3772 3773 3774 3775 3776 3777 3778 3779 3780 3781 3782 3783 3784 3785 3786 3787 3788 3789 3790 3791 3792 3793 3794 3795 3796 3797 3798 3799 3800 3801 3802 3803 3804 3805 3806 3807 3808 3809 3810 3811 3812 3813 3814 3815 3816 3817 3818 3819 3820 3821 3822 3823 3824 3825 3826 3827 3828 3829 3830 3831 3832 3833 3834 3835 3836 3837 3838 3839 3840 3841 3842 3843 3844 3845 3846 3847 3848 3849 3850 3851 3852 3853 3854 3855 3856 3857 3858 3859 3860 3861 3862 3863 3864 3865 3866 3867 3868 3869 3870 3871 3872 3873 3874 3875 3876 3877 3878 3879 3880 3881 3882 3883 3884 3885 3886 3887 3888 3889 3890 3891 3892 3893 3894 3895 3896 3897 3898 3899 3900 3901 3902 3903 3904 3905 3906 3907 3908 3909 3910 3911 3912 3913 3914 3915 3916 3917 3918 3919 3920 3921 3922 3923 3924 3925 3926 3927 3928 3929 3930 3931 3932 3933 3934 3935 3936 3937 3938 3939 3940 3941 3942 3943 3944 3945 3946 3947 3948 3949 3950 3951 3952 3953 3954 3955 3956 3957 3958 3959 3960 3961 3962 3963 3964 3965 3966 3967 3968 3969 3970 3971 3972 3973 3974 3975 3976 3977 3978 3979 3980 3981 3982 3983 3984 3985 3986 3987 3988 3989 3990 3991 3992 3993 3994 3995 3996 3997 3998 3999 4000 4001 4002 4003 4004 4005 4006 4007 4008 4009 4010 4011 4012 4013 4014 4015 4016 4017 4018 4019 4020 4021 4022 4023 4024 4025 4026 4027 4028 4029 4030 4031 4032 4033 4034 4035 4036 4037 4038 4039 4040 4041 4042 4043 4044 4045 4046 4047 4048 4049 4050 4051 4052 4053 4054 4055 4056 4057 4058 4059 4060 4061 4062 4063 4064 4065 4066 4067 4068 4069 4070 4071 4072 4073 4074 4075 4076 4077 4078 4079 4080 4081 4082 4083 4084 4085 4086 4087 4088 4089 4090 4091 4092 4093 4094 4095 4096 4097 4098 4099 4100 4101 4102 4103 4104 4105 4106 4107 4108 4109 4110 4111 4112 4113 4114 4115 4116 4117 4118 4119 4120 4121 4122 4123 4124 4125 4126 4127 4128 4129 4130 4131 4132 4133 4134 4135 4136 4137 4138 4139 4140 4141 4142 4143 4144 4145 4146 4147 4148 4149 4150 4151 4152 4153 4154 4155 4156 4157 4158 4159 4160 4161 4162 4163 4164 4165 4166 4167 4168 4169 4170 4171 4172 4173 4174 4175 4176 4177 4178 4179 4180 4181 4182 4183 4184 4185 4186 4187 4188 4189 4190 4191 4192 4193 4194 4195 4196 4197 4198 4199 4200 4201 4202 4203 4204 4205 4206 4207 4208 4209 4210 4211 4212 4213 4214 4215 4216 4217 4218 4219 4220 4221 4222 4223 4224 4225 4226 4227 4228 4229 4230 4231 4232 4233 4234 4235 4236 4237 4238 4239 4240 4241 4242 4243 4244 4245 4246 4247 4248 4249 4250 4251 4252 4253 4254 4255 4256 4257 4258 4259 4260 4261 4262 4263 4264 4265 4266 4267 4268 4269 4270 4271 4272 4273 4274 4275 4276 4277 4278 4279 4280 4281 4282 4283 4284 4285 4286 4287 4288 4289 4290 4291 4292 4293 4294 4295 4296 4297 4298 4299 4300 4301 4302 4303 4304 4305 4306 4307 4308 4309 4310 4311 4312 4313 4314 4315 4316 4317 4318 4319 4320 4321 4322 4323 4324 4325 4326 4327 4328 4329 4330 4331 4332 4333 4334 4335 4336 4337 4338 4339 4340 4341 4342 4343 4344 4345 4346 4347 4348 4349 4350 4351 4352 4353 4354 4355 4356 4357 4358 4359 4360 4361 4362 4363 4364 4365 4366 4367 4368 4369 4370 4371 4372 4373 4374 4375 4376 4377 4378 4379 4380 4381 4382 4383 4384 4385 4386 4387 4388 4389 4390 4391 4392 4393 4394 4395 4396 4397 4398 4399 4400 4401 4402 4403 4404 4405 4406 4407 4408 4409 4410 4411 4412 4413 4414 4415 4416 4417 4418 4419 4420 4421 4422 4423 4424 4425 4426 4427 4428 4429 4430 4431 4432 4433 4434 4435 4436 4437 4438 4439 4440 4441 4442 4443 4444 4445 4446 4447 4448 4449 4450 4451 4452 4453 4454 4455 4456 4457 4458 4459 4460 4461 4462 4463 4464 4465 4466 4467 4468 4469 4470 4471 4472 4473 4474 4475 4476 4477 4478 4479 4480 4481 4482 4483 4484 4485 4486 4487 4488 4489 4490 4491 4492 4493 4494 4495 4496 4497 4498 4499 4500 4501 4502 4503 4504 4505 4506 4507 4508 4509 4510 4511 4512 4513 4514 4515 4516 4517 4518 4519 4520 4521 4522 4523 4524 4525 4526 4527 4528 4529 4530 4531 4532 4533 4534 4535 4536 4537 4538 4539 4540 4541 4542 4543 4544 4545 4546 4547 4548 4549 4550 4551 4552 4553 4554 4555 4556 4557 4558 4559 4560 4561 4562 4563 4564 4565 4566 4567 4568 4569 4570 4571 4572 4573 4574 4575 4576 4577 4578 4579 4580 4581 4582 4583 4584 4585 4586 4587 4588 4589 4590 4591 4592 4593 4594 4595 4596 4597 4598 4599 4600 4601 4602 4603 4604 4605 4606 4607 4608 4609 4610 4611 4612 4613 4614 4615 4616 4617 4618 4619 4620 4621 4622 4623 4624 4625 4626 4627 4628 4629 4630 4631 4632 4633 4634 4635 4636 4637 4638 4639 4640 4641 4642 4643 4644 4645 4646 4647 4648 4649 4650 4651 4652 4653 4654 4655 4656 4657 4658 4659 4660 4661 4662 4663 4664 4665 4666 4667 4668 4669 4670 4671 4672 4673 4674 4675 4676 4677 4678 4679 4680 4681 4682 4683 4684 4685 4686 4687 4688 4689 4690 4691 4692 4693 4694 4695 4696 4697 4698 4699 4700 4701 4702 4703 4704 4705 4706 4707 4708 4709 4710 4711 4712 4713 4714 4715 4716 4717 4718 4719 4720 4721 4722 4723 4724 4725 4726 4727 4728 4729 4730 4731 4732 4733 4734 4735 4736 4737 4738 4739 4740 4741 4742 4743 4744 4745 4746 4747 4748 4749 4750 4751 4752 4753 4754 4755 4756 4757 4758 4759 4760 4761 4762 4763 4764 4765 4766 4767 4768 4769 4770 4771 4772 4773 4774 4775 4776 4777 4778 4779 4780 4781 4782 4783 4784 4785 4786 4787 4788 4789 4790 4791 4792 4793 4794 4795 4796 4797 4798 4799 4800 4801 4802 4803 4804 4805 4806 4807 4808 4809 4810 4811 4812 4813 4814 4815 4816 4817 4818 4819 4820 4821 4822 4823 4824 4825 4826 4827 4828 4829 4830 4831 4832 4833 4834 4835 4836 4837 4838 4839 4840 4841 4842 4843 4844 4845 4846 4847 4848 4849 4850 4851 4852 4853 4854 4855 4856 4857 4858 4859 4860 4861 4862 4863 4864 4865 4866 4867 4868 4869 4870 4871 4872 4873 4874 4875 4876 4877 4878 4879 4880 4881 4882 4883 4884 4885 4886 4887 4888 4889 4890 4891 4892 4893 4894 4895 4896 4897 4898 4899 4900 4901 4902 4903 4904 4905 4906 4907 4908 4909 4910 4911 4912 4913 4914 4915 4916 4917 4918 4919 4920 4921 4922 4923 4924 4925 4926 4927 4928 4929 4930 4931 4932 4933 4934 4935 4936 4937 4938 4939 4940 4941 4942 4943 4944 4945 4946 4947 4948 4949 4950 4951 4952 4953 4954 4955 4956 4957 4958 4959 4960 4961 4962 4963 4964 4965 4966 4967 4968 4969 4970 4971 4972 4973 4974 4975 4976 4977 4978 4979 4980 4981 4982 4983 4984 4985 4986 4987 4988 4989 4990 4991 4992 4993 4994 4995 4996 4997 4998 4999 5000 5001 5002 5003 5004 5005 5006 5007 5008 5009 5010 5011 5012 5013 5014 5015 5016 5017 5018 5019 5020 5021 5022 5023 5024 5025 5026 5027 5028 5029 5030 5031 5032 5033 5034 5035 5036 5037 5038 5039 5040 5041 5042 5043 5044 5045 5046 5047 5048 5049 5050 5051 5052 5053 5054 5055 5056 5057 5058 5059 5060 5061 5062 5063 5064 5065 5066 5067 5068 5069 5070 5071 5072 5073 5074 5075 5076 5077 5078 5079 5080 5081 5082 5083 5084 5085 5086 5087 5088 5089 5090 5091 5092 5093 5094 5095 5096 5097 5098 5099 5100 5101 5102 5103 5104 5105 5106 5107 5108 5109 5110 5111 5112 5113 5114 5115 5116 5117 5118 5119 5120 5121 5122 5123 5124 5125 5126 5127 5128 5129 5130 5131 5132 5133 5134 5135 5136 5137 5138 5139 5140 5141 5142 5143 5144 5145 5146 5147 5148 5149 5150 5151 5152 5153 5154 5155 5156 5157 5158 5159 5160 5161 5162 5163 5164 5165 5166 5167 5168 5169 5170 5171 5172 5173 5174 5175 5176 5177 5178 5179 5180 5181 5182 5183 5184 5185 5186 5187 5188 5189 5190 5191 5192 5193 5194 5195 5196 5197 5198 5199 5200 5201 5202 5203 5204 5205 5206 5207 5208 5209 5210 5211 5212 5213 5214 5215 5216 5217 5218 5219 5220 5221 5222 5223 5224 5225 5226 5227 5228 5229 5230 5231 5232 5233 5234 5235 5236 5237 5238 5239 5240 5241 5242 5243 5244 5245 5246 5247 5248 5249 5250 5251 5252 5253 5254 5255 5256 5257 5258 5259 5260 5261 5262 5263 5264 5265 5266 5267 5268 5269 5270 5271 5272 5273 5274 5275 5276 5277 5278 5279 5280 5281 5282 5283 5284 5285 5286 5287 5288 5289 5290 5291 5292 5293 5294 5295 5296 5297 5298 5299 5300 5301 5302 5303 5304 5305 5306 5307 5308 5309 5310 5311 5312 5313 5314 5315 5316 5317 5318 5319 5320 5321 5322 5323 5324 5325 5326 5327 5328 5329 5330 5331 5332 5333 5334 5335 5336 5337 5338 5339 5340 5341 5342 5343 5344 5345 5346 5347 5348 5349 5350 5351 5352 5353 5354 5355 5356 5357 5358 5359 5360 5361 5362 5363 5364 5365 5366 5367 5368 5369 5370 5371 5372 5373 5374 5375 5376 5377 5378 5379 5380 5381 5382 5383 5384 5385 5386 5387 5388 5389 5390 5391 5392 5393 5394 5395 5396 5397 5398 5399 5400 5401 5402 5403 5404 5405 5406 5407 5408 5409 5410 5411 5412 5413 5414 5415 5416 5417 5418 5419 5420 5421 5422 5423 5424 5425 5426 5427 5428 5429 5430 5431 5432 5433 5434 5435 5436 5437 5438 5439 5440 5441 5442 5443 5444 5445 5446 5447 5448 5449 5450 5451 5452 5453 5454 5455 5456 5457 5458 5459 5460 5461 5462 5463 5464 5465 5466 5467 5468 5469 5470 5471 5472 5473 5474 5475 5476 5477 5478 5479 5480 5481 5482 5483 5484 5485 5486 5487 5488 5489 5490 5491 5492 5493 5494 5495 5496 5497 5498 5499 5500 5501 5502 5503 5504 5505 5506 5507 5508 5509 5510 5511 5512 5513 5514 5515 5516 5517 5518 5519 5520 5521 5522 5523 5524 5525 5526 5527 5528 5529 5530 5531 5532 5533 5534 5535 5536 5537 5538 5539 5540 5541 5542 5543 5544 5545 5546 5547 5548 5549 5550 5551 5552 5553 5554 5555 5556 5557 5558 5559 5560 5561 5562 5563 5564 5565 5566 5567 5568 5569 5570 5571 5572 5573 5574 5575 5576 5577 5578 5579 5580 5581 5582 5583 5584 5585 5586 5587 5588 5589 5590 5591 5592 5593 5594 5595 5596 5597 5598 5599 5600 5601 5602 5603 5604 5605 5606 5607 5608 5609 5610 5611 5612 5613 5614 5615 5616 5617 5618 5619 5620 5621 5622 5623 5624 5625 5626 5627 5628 5629 5630 5631 5632 5633 5634 5635 5636 5637 5638 5639 5640 5641 5642 5643 5644 5645 5646 5647 5648 5649 5650 5651 5652 5653 5654 5655 5656 5657 5658 5659 5660 5661 5662 5663 5664 5665 5666 5667 5668 5669 5670 5671 5672 5673 5674 5675 5676 5677 5678 5679 5680 5681 5682 5683 5684 5685 5686 5687 5688 5689 5690 5691 5692 5693 5694 5695 5696 5697 5698 5699 5700 5701 5702 5703 5704 5705 5706 5707 5708 5709 5710 5711 5712 5713 5714 5715 5716 5717 5718 5719 5720 5721 5722 5723 5724 5725 5726 5727 5728 5729 5730 5731 5732 5733 5734 5735 5736 5737 5738 5739 5740 5741 5742 5743 5744 5745 5746 5747 5748 5749 5750 5751 5752 5753 5754 5755 5756 5757 5758 5759 5760 5761 5762 5763 5764 5765 5766 5767 5768 5769 5770 5771 5772 5773 5774 5775 5776 5777 5778 5779 5780 5781 5782 5783 5784 5785 5786 5787 5788 5789 5790 5791 5792 5793 5794 5795 5796 5797 5798 5799 5800 5801 5802 5803 5804 5805 5806 5807 5808 5809 5810 5811 5812 5813 5814 5815 5816 5817 5818 5819 5820 5821 5822 5823 5824 5825 5826 5827 5828 5829 5830 5831 5832 5833 5834 5835 5836 5837 5838 5839 5840 5841 5842 5843 5844 5845 5846 5847 5848 5849 5850 5851 5852 5853 5854 5855 5856 5857 5858 5859 5860 5861 5862 5863 5864 5865 5866 5867 5868 5869 5870 5871 5872 5873 5874 5875 5876 5877 5878 5879 5880 5881 5882 5883 5884 5885 5886 5887 5888 5889 5890 5891 5892 5893 5894 5895 5896 5897 5898 5899 5900 5901 5902 5903 5904 5905 5906 5907 5908 5909 5910 5911 5912 5913 5914 5915 5916 5917 5918 5919 5920 5921 5922 5923 5924 5925 5926 5927 5928 5929 5930 5931 5932 5933 5934 5935 5936 5937 5938 5939 5940 5941 5942 5943 5944 5945 5946 5947 5948 5949 5950 5951 5952 5953 5954 5955 5956 5957 5958 5959 5960 5961 5962 5963 5964 5965 5966 5967 5968 5969 5970 5971 5972 5973 5974 5975 5976 5977 5978 5979 5980 5981 5982 5983 5984 5985 5986 5987 5988 5989 5990 5991 5992 5993 5994 5995 5996 5997 5998 5999 6000 6001 6002 6003 6004 6005 6006 6007 6008 6009 6010 6011 6012 6013 6014 6015 6016 6017 6018 6019 6020 6021 6022 6023 6024 6025 6026 6027 6028 6029 6030 6031 6032 6033 6034 6035 6036 6037 6038 6039 6040 6041 6042 6043 6044 6045 6046 6047 6048 6049 6050 6051 6052 6053 6054 6055 6056 6057 6058 6059 6060 6061 6062 6063 6064 6065 6066 6067 6068 6069 6070 6071 6072 6073 6074 6075 6076 6077 6078 6079 6080 6081 6082 6083 6084 6085 6086 6087 6088 6089 6090 6091 6092 6093 6094 6095 6096 6097 6098 6099 6100 6101 6102 6103 6104 6105 6106 6107 6108 6109 6110 6111 6112 6113 6114 6115 6116 6117 6118 6119 6120 6121 6122 6123 6124 6125 6126 6127 6128 6129 6130 6131 6132 6133 6134 6135 6136 6137 6138 6139 6140 6141 6142 6143 6144 6145 6146 6147 6148 6149 6150 6151 6152 6153 6154 6155 6156 6157 6158 6159 6160 6161 6162 6163 6164 6165 6166 6167 6168 6169 6170 6171 6172 6173 6174 6175 6176 6177 6178 6179 6180 6181 6182 6183 6184 6185 6186 6187 6188 6189 6190 6191 6192 6193 6194 6195 6196 6197 6198 6199 6200 6201 6202 6203 6204 6205 6206 6207 6208 6209 6210 6211 6212 6213 6214 6215 6216 6217 6218 6219 6220 6221 6222 6223 6224 6225 6226 6227 6228 6229 6230 6231 6232 6233 6234 6235 6236 6237 6238 6239 6240 6241 6242 6243 6244 6245 6246 6247 6248 6249 6250 6251 6252 6253 6254 6255 6256 6257 6258 6259 6260 6261 6262 6263 6264 6265 6266 6267 6268 6269 6270 6271 6272 6273 6274 6275 6276 6277 6278 6279 6280 6281 6282 6283 6284 6285 6286 6287 6288 6289 6290 6291 6292 6293 6294 6295 6296 6297 6298 6299 6300 6301 6302 6303 6304 6305 6306 6307 6308 6309 6310 6311 6312 6313 6314 6315 6316 6317 6318 6319 6320 6321 6322 6323 6324 6325 6326 6327 6328 6329 6330 6331 6332 6333 6334 6335 6336 6337 6338 6339 6340 6341 6342 6343 6344 6345 6346 6347 6348 6349 6350 6351 6352 6353 6354 6355 6356 6357 6358 6359 6360 6361 6362 6363 6364 6365 6366 6367 6368 6369 6370 6371 6372 6373 6374 6375 6376 6377 6378 6379 6380 6381 6382 6383 6384 6385 6386 6387 6388 6389 6390 6391 6392 6393 6394 6395 6396 6397 6398 6399 6400 6401 6402 6403 6404 6405 6406 6407 6408 6409 6410 6411 6412 6413 6414 6415 6416 6417 6418 6419 6420 6421 6422 6423 6424 6425 6426 6427 6428 6429 6430 6431 6432 6433 6434 6435 6436 6437 6438 6439 6440 6441 6442 6443 6444 6445 6446 6447 6448 6449 6450 6451 6452 6453 6454 6455 6456 6457 6458 6459 6460 6461 6462 6463 6464 6465 6466 6467 6468 6469 6470 6471 6472 6473 6474 6475 6476 6477 6478 6479 6480 6481 6482 6483 6484 6485 6486 6487 6488 6489 6490 6491 6492 6493 6494 6495 6496 6497 6498 6499 6500 6501 6502 6503 6504 6505 6506 6507 6508 6509 6510 6511 6512 6513 6514 6515 6516 6517 6518 6519 6520 6521 6522 6523 6524 6525 6526 6527 6528 6529 6530 6531 6532 6533 6534 6535 6536 6537 6538 6539 6540 6541 6542 6543 6544 6545 6546 6547 6548 6549 6550 6551 6552 6553 6554 6555 6556 6557 6558 6559 6560 6561 6562 6563 6564 6565 6566 6567 6568 6569 6570 6571 6572 6573 6574 6575 6576 6577 6578 6579 6580 6581 6582 6583 6584 6585 6586 6587 6588 6589 6590 6591 6592 6593 6594 6595 6596 6597 6598 6599 6600 6601 6602 6603 6604 6605 6606 6607 6608 6609 6610 6611 6612 6613 6614 6615 6616 6617 6618 6619 6620 6621 6622 6623 6624 6625 6626 6627 6628 6629 6630 6631 6632 6633 6634 6635 6636 6637 6638 6639 6640 6641 6642 6643 6644 6645 6646 6647 6648 6649 6650 6651 6652 6653 6654 6655 6656 6657 6658 6659 6660 6661 6662 6663 6664 6665 6666 6667 6668 6669 6670 6671 6672 6673 6674 6675 6676 6677 6678 6679 6680 6681 6682 6683 6684 6685 6686 6687 6688 6689 6690 6691 6692 6693 6694 6695 6696 6697 6698 6699 6700 6701 6702 6703 6704 6705 6706 6707 6708 6709 6710 6711 6712 6713 6714 6715 6716 6717 6718 6719 6720 6721 6722 6723 6724 6725 6726 6727 6728 6729 6730 6731 6732 6733 6734 6735 6736 6737 6738 6739 6740 6741 6742 6743 6744 6745 6746 6747 6748 6749 6750 6751 6752 6753 6754 6755 6756 6757 6758 6759 6760 6761 6762 6763 6764 6765 6766 6767 6768 6769 6770 6771 6772 6773 6774 6775 6776 6777 6778 6779 6780 6781 6782 6783 6784 6785 6786 6787 6788 6789 6790 6791 6792 6793 6794 6795 6796 6797 6798 6799 6800 6801 6802 6803 6804 6805 6806 6807 6808 6809 6810 6811 6812 6813 6814 6815 6816 6817 6818 6819 6820 6821 6822 6823 6824 6825 6826 6827 6828 6829 6830 6831 6832 6833 6834 6835 6836 6837 6838 6839 6840 6841 6842 6843 6844 6845 6846 6847 6848 6849 6850 6851 6852 6853 6854 6855 6856 6857 6858 6859 6860 6861 6862 6863 6864 6865 6866 6867 6868 6869 6870 6871 6872 6873 6874 6875 6876 6877 6878 6879 6880 6881 6882 6883 6884 6885 6886 6887 6888 6889 6890 6891 6892 6893 6894 6895 6896 6897 6898 6899 6900 6901 6902 6903 6904 6905 6906 6907 6908 6909 6910 6911 6912 6913 6914 6915 6916 6917 6918 6919 6920 6921 6922 6923 6924 6925 6926 6927 6928 6929 6930 6931 6932 6933 6934 6935 6936 6937 6938 6939 6940 6941 6942 6943 6944 6945 6946 6947 6948 6949 6950 6951 6952 6953 6954 6955 6956 6957 6958 6959 6960 6961 6962 6963 6964 6965 6966 6967 6968 6969 6970 6971 6972 6973 6974 6975 6976 6977 6978 6979 6980 6981 6982 6983 6984 6985 6986 6987 6988 6989 6990 6991 6992 6993 6994 6995 6996 6997 6998 6999 7000 7001 7002 7003 7004 7005 7006 7007 7008 7009 7010 7011 7012 7013 7014 7015 7016 7017 7018 7019 7020 7021 7022 7023 7024 7025 7026 7027 7028 7029 7030 7031 7032 7033 7034 7035 7036 7037 7038 7039 7040 7041 7042 7043 7044 7045 7046 7047 7048 7049 7050 7051 7052 7053 7054 7055 7056 7057 7058 7059 7060 7061 7062 7063 7064 7065 7066 7067 7068 7069 7070 7071 7072 7073 7074 7075 7076 7077 7078 7079 7080 7081 7082 7083 7084 7085 7086 7087 7088 7089 7090 7091 7092 7093 7094 7095 7096 7097 7098 7099 7100 7101 7102 7103 7104 7105 7106 7107 7108 7109 7110 7111 7112 7113 7114 7115 7116 7117 7118 7119 7120 7121 7122 7123 7124 7125 7126 7127 7128 7129 7130 7131 7132 7133 7134 7135 7136 7137 7138 7139 7140 7141 7142 7143 7144 7145 7146 7147 7148 7149 7150 7151 7152 7153 7154 7155 7156 7157 7158 7159 7160 7161 7162 7163 7164 7165 7166 7167 7168 7169 7170 7171 7172 7173 7174 7175 7176 7177 7178 7179 7180 7181 7182 7183 7184 7185 7186 7187 7188 7189 7190 7191 7192 7193 7194 7195 7196 7197 7198 7199 7200 7201 7202 7203 7204 7205 7206 7207 7208 7209 7210 7211 7212 7213 7214 7215 7216 7217 7218 7219 7220 7221 7222 7223 7224 7225 7226 7227 7228 7229 7230 7231 7232 7233 7234 7235 7236 7237 7238 7239 7240 7241 7242 7243 7244 7245 7246 7247 7248 7249 7250 7251 7252 7253 7254 7255 7256 7257 7258 7259 7260 7261 7262 7263 7264 7265 7266 7267 7268 7269 7270 7271 7272 7273 7274 7275 7276 7277 7278 7279 7280 7281 7282 7283 7284 7285 7286 7287 7288 7289 7290 7291 7292 7293 7294 7295 7296 7297 7298 7299 7300 7301 7302 7303 7304 7305 7306 7307 7308 7309 7310 7311 7312 7313 7314 7315 7316 7317 7318 7319 7320 7321 7322 7323 7324 7325 7326 7327 7328 7329 7330 7331 7332 7333 7334 7335 7336 7337 7338 7339 7340 7341 7342 7343 7344 7345 7346 7347 7348 7349 7350 7351 7352 7353 7354 7355 7356 7357 7358 7359 7360 7361 7362 7363 7364 7365 7366 7367 7368 7369 7370 7371 7372 7373 7374 7375 7376 7377 7378 7379 7380 7381 7382 7383 7384 7385 7386 7387 7388 7389 7390 7391 7392 7393 7394 7395 7396 7397 7398 7399 7400 7401 7402 7403 7404 7405 7406 7407 7408 7409 7410 7411 7412 7413 7414 7415 7416 7417 7418 7419 7420 7421 7422 7423 7424 7425 7426 7427 7428 7429 7430 7431 7432 7433 7434 7435 7436 7437 7438 7439 7440 7441 7442 7443 7444 7445 7446 7447 7448 7449 7450 7451 7452 7453 7454 7455 7456 7457 7458 7459 7460 7461 7462 7463 7464 7465 7466 7467 7468 7469 7470 7471 7472 7473 7474 7475 7476 7477 7478 7479 7480 7481 7482 7483 7484 7485 7486 7487 7488 7489 7490 7491 7492 7493 7494 7495 7496 7497 7498 7499 7500 7501 7502 7503 7504 7505 7506 7507 7508 7509 7510 7511 7512 7513 7514 7515 7516 7517 7518 7519 7520 7521 7522 7523 7524 7525 7526 7527 7528 7529 7530 7531 7532 7533 7534 7535 7536 7537 7538 7539 7540 7541 7542 7543 7544 7545 7546 7547 7548 7549 7550 7551 7552 7553 7554 7555 7556 7557 7558 7559 7560 7561 7562 7563 7564 7565 7566 7567 7568 7569 7570 7571 7572 7573 7574 7575 7576 7577 7578 7579 7580 7581 7582 7583 7584 7585 7586 7587 7588 7589 7590 7591 7592 7593 7594 7595 7596 7597 7598 7599 7600 7601 7602 7603 7604 7605 7606 7607 7608 7609 7610 7611 7612 7613 7614 7615 7616 7617 7618 7619 7620 7621 7622 7623 7624 7625 7626 7627 7628 7629 7630 7631 7632 7633 7634 7635 7636 7637 7638 7639 7640 7641 7642 7643 7644 7645 7646 7647 7648 7649 7650 7651 7652 7653 7654 7655 7656 7657 7658 7659 7660 7661 7662 7663 7664 7665 7666 7667 7668 7669 7670 7671 7672 7673 7674 7675 7676 7677 7678 7679 7680 7681 7682 7683 7684 7685 7686 7687 7688 7689 7690 7691 7692 7693 7694 7695 7696 7697 7698 7699 7700 7701 7702 7703 7704 7705 7706 7707 7708 7709 7710 7711 7712 7713 7714 7715 7716 7717 7718 7719 7720 7721 7722 7723 7724 7725 7726 7727 7728 7729 7730 7731 7732 7733 7734 7735 7736 7737 7738 7739 7740 7741 7742 7743 7744 7745 7746 7747 7748 7749 7750 7751 7752 7753 7754 7755 7756 7757 7758 7759 7760 7761 7762 7763 7764 7765 7766 7767 7768 7769 7770 7771 7772 7773 7774 7775 7776 7777 7778 7779 7780 7781 7782 7783 7784 7785 7786 7787 7788 7789 7790 7791 7792 7793 7794 7795 7796 7797 7798 7799 7800 7801 7802 7803 7804 7805 7806 7807 7808 7809 7810 7811 7812 7813 7814 7815 7816 7817 7818 7819 7820 7821 7822 7823 7824 7825 7826 7827 7828 7829 7830 7831 7832 7833 7834 7835 7836 7837 7838 7839 7840 7841 7842 7843 7844 7845 7846 7847 7848 7849 7850 7851 7852 7853 7854 7855 7856 7857 7858 7859 7860 7861 7862 7863 7864 7865 7866 7867 7868 7869 7870 7871 7872 7873 7874 7875 7876 7877 7878 7879 7880 7881 7882 7883 7884 7885 7886 7887 7888 7889 7890 7891 7892 7893 7894 7895 7896 7897 7898 7899 7900 7901 7902 7903 7904 7905 7906 7907 7908 7909 7910 7911 7912 7913 7914 7915 7916 7917 7918 7919 7920 7921 7922 7923 7924 7925 7926 7927 7928 7929 7930 7931 7932 7933 7934 7935 7936 7937 7938 7939 7940 7941 7942 7943 7944 7945 7946 7947 7948 7949 7950 7951 7952 7953 7954 7955 7956 7957 7958 7959 7960 7961 7962 7963 7964 7965 7966 7967 7968 7969 7970 7971 7972 7973 7974 7975 7976 7977 7978 7979 7980 7981 7982 7983 7984 7985 7986 7987 7988 7989 7990 7991 7992 7993 7994 7995 7996 7997 7998 7999 8000 8001 8002 8003 8004 8005 8006 8007 8008 8009 8010 8011 8012 8013 8014 8015 8016 8017 8018 8019 8020 8021 8022 8023 8024 8025 8026 8027 8028 8029 8030 8031 8032 8033 8034 8035 8036 8037 8038 8039 8040 8041 8042 8043 8044 8045 8046 8047 8048 8049 8050 8051 8052 8053 8054 8055 8056 8057 8058 8059 8060 8061 8062 8063 8064 8065 8066 8067 8068 8069 8070 8071 8072 8073 8074 8075 8076 8077 8078 8079 8080 8081 8082 8083 8084 8085 8086 8087 8088 8089 8090 8091 8092 8093 8094 8095 8096 8097 8098 8099 8100 8101 8102 8103 8104 8105 8106 8107 8108 8109 8110 8111 8112 8113 8114 8115 8116 8117 8118 8119 8120 8121 8122 8123 8124 8125 8126 8127 8128 8129 8130 8131 8132 8133 8134 8135 8136 8137 8138 8139 8140 8141 8142 8143 8144 8145 8146 8147 8148 8149 8150 8151 8152 8153 8154 8155 8156 8157 8158 8159 8160 8161 8162 8163 8164 8165 8166 8167 8168 8169 8170 8171 8172 8173 8174 8175 8176 8177 8178 8179 8180 8181 8182 8183 8184 8185 8186 8187 8188 8189 8190 8191 8192 8193 8194 8195 8196 8197 8198 8199 8200 8201 8202 8203 8204 8205 8206 8207 8208 8209 8210 8211 8212 8213 8214 8215 8216 8217 8218 8219 8220 8221 8222 8223 8224 8225 8226 8227 8228 8229 8230 8231 8232 8233 8234 8235 8236 8237 8238 8239 8240 8241 8242 8243 8244 8245 8246 8247 8248 8249 8250 8251 8252 8253 8254 8255 8256 8257 8258 8259 8260 8261 8262 8263 8264 8265 8266 8267 8268 8269 8270 8271 8272 8273 8274 8275 8276 8277 8278 8279 8280 8281 8282 8283 8284 8285 8286 8287 8288 8289 8290 8291 8292 8293 8294 8295 8296 8297 8298 8299 8300 8301 8302 8303 8304 8305 8306 8307 8308 8309 8310 8311 8312 8313 8314 8315 8316 8317 8318 8319 8320 8321 8322 8323 8324 8325 8326 8327 8328 8329 8330 8331 8332 8333 8334 8335 8336 8337 8338 8339 8340 8341 8342 8343 8344 8345 8346 8347 8348 8349 8350 8351 8352 8353 8354 8355 8356 8357 8358 8359 8360 8361 8362 8363 8364 8365 8366 8367 8368 8369 8370 8371 8372 8373 8374 8375 8376 8377 8378 8379 8380 8381 8382 8383 8384 8385 8386 8387 8388 8389 8390 8391 8392 8393 8394 8395 8396 8397 8398 8399 8400 8401 8402 8403 8404 8405 8406 8407 8408 8409 8410 8411 8412 8413 8414 8415 8416 8417 8418 8419 8420 8421 8422 8423 8424 8425 8426 8427 8428 8429 8430 8431 8432 8433 8434 8435 8436 8437 8438 8439 8440 8441 8442 8443 8444 8445 8446 8447 8448 8449 8450 8451 8452 8453 8454 8455 8456 8457 8458 8459 8460 8461 8462 8463 8464 8465 8466 8467 8468 8469 8470 8471 8472 8473 8474 8475 8476 8477 8478 8479 8480 8481 8482 8483 8484 8485 8486 8487 8488 8489 8490 8491 8492 8493 8494 8495 8496 8497 8498 8499 8500 8501 8502 8503 8504 8505 8506 8507 8508 8509 8510 8511 8512 8513 8514 8515 8516 8517 8518 8519 8520 8521 8522 8523 8524 8525 8526 8527 8528 8529 8530 8531 8532 8533 8534 8535 8536 8537 8538 8539 8540 8541 8542 8543 8544 8545 8546 8547 8548 8549 8550 8551 8552 8553 8554 8555 8556 8557 8558 8559 8560 8561 8562 8563 8564 8565 8566 8567 8568 8569 8570 8571 8572 8573 8574 8575 8576 8577 8578 8579 8580 8581 8582 8583 8584 8585 8586 8587 8588 8589 8590 8591 8592 8593 8594 8595 8596 8597 8598 8599 8600 8601 8602 8603 8604 8605 8606 8607 8608 8609 8610 8611 8612 8613 8614 8615 8616 8617 8618 8619 8620 8621 8622 8623 8624 8625 8626 8627 8628 8629 8630 8631 8632 8633 8634 8635 8636 8637 8638 8639 8640 8641 8642 8643 8644 8645 8646 8647 8648 8649 8650 8651 8652 8653 8654 8655 8656 8657 8658 8659 8660 8661 8662 8663 8664 8665 8666 8667 8668 8669 8670 8671 8672 8673 8674 8675 8676 8677 8678 8679 8680 8681 8682 8683 8684 8685 8686 8687 8688 8689 8690 8691 8692 8693 8694 8695 8696 8697 8698 8699 8700 8701 8702 8703 8704 8705 8706 8707 8708 8709 8710 8711 8712 8713 8714 8715 8716 8717 8718 8719 8720 8721 8722 8723 8724 8725 8726 8727 8728 8729 8730 8731 8732 8733 8734 8735 8736 8737 8738 8739 8740 8741 8742 8743 8744 8745 8746 8747 8748 8749 8750 8751 8752 8753 8754 8755 8756 8757 8758 8759 8760 8761 8762 8763 8764 8765 8766 8767 8768 8769 8770 8771 8772 8773 8774 8775 8776 8777 8778 8779 8780 8781 8782 8783 8784 8785 8786 8787 8788 8789 8790 8791 8792 8793 8794 8795 8796 8797 8798 8799 8800 8801 8802 8803 8804 8805 8806 8807 8808 8809 8810 8811 8812 8813 8814 8815 8816 8817 8818 8819 8820 8821 8822 8823 8824 8825 8826 8827 8828 8829 8830 8831 8832 8833 8834 8835 8836 8837 8838 8839 8840 8841 8842 8843 8844 8845 8846 8847 8848 8849 8850 8851 8852 8853 8854 8855 8856 8857 8858 8859 8860 8861 8862 8863 8864 8865 8866 8867 8868 8869 8870 8871 8872 8873 8874 8875 8876 8877 8878 8879 8880 8881 8882 8883 8884 8885 8886 8887 8888 8889 8890 8891 8892 8893 8894 8895 8896 8897 8898 8899 8900 8901 8902 8903 8904 8905 8906 8907 8908 8909 8910 8911 8912 8913 8914 8915 8916 8917 8918 8919 8920 8921 8922 8923 8924 8925 8926 8927 8928 8929 8930 8931 8932 8933 8934 8935 8936 8937 8938 8939 8940 8941 8942 8943 8944 8945 8946 8947 8948 8949 8950 8951 8952 8953 8954 8955 8956 8957 8958 8959 8960 8961 8962 8963 8964 8965 8966 8967 8968 8969 8970 8971 8972 8973 8974 8975 8976 8977 8978 8979 8980 8981 8982 8983 8984 8985 8986 8987 8988 8989 8990 8991 8992 8993 8994 8995 8996 8997 8998 8999 9000 9001 9002 9003 9004 9005 9006 9007 9008 9009 9010 9011 9012 9013
|
%\iffalse THIS IS A META COMMENT
% File: merlin.mbs
%% Copyright 1994-2004 Patrick W Daly
% Max-Planck-Institut f\"ur Aeronomie
% Max-Planck-Str. 2
% D-37191 Katlenburg-Lindau
% Germany
% E-mail: daly@linmpi.mpg.de
%
% This program can be redistributed and/or modified under the terms
% of the LaTeX Project Public License Distributed from CTAN
% archives in directory macros/latex/base/lppl.txt; either
% version 1 of the License, or any later version.
%
% It is part of the custom-bib collection,
% a contribution to the LaTeX2e system.
%====================================================================
% Master Bibliography Style
% for customizing bibliographic style files (.bst)
% with the help of docstrip.tex
% and the auxiliary program makebst.tex
%--------------------------------------------------------------------
% (See version and date in the \ProvidesFile command below)
%--------------------------------------------------------------------
% This file supports numerical and author-year citation styles
% for natbib, harvard, astronom, authordate, apalike
% It also supports languages other than English
%--------------------------------------------------------------------
% This file is self-documenting: simply LaTeX it!
% (Alternatively, extract documentation driver with option `driver')
%====================================================================
%
%<*!tail>
% (The following notice appears in bst files generated from this file)
% ===============================================================
% IMPORTANT NOTICE:
% This bibliographic style (bst) file has been generated from one or
% more master bibliographic style (mbs) files, listed above.
%
% This generated file can be redistributed and/or modified under the terms
% of the LaTeX Project Public License Distributed from CTAN
% archives in directory macros/latex/base/lppl.txt; either
% version 1 of the License, or any later version.
% ===============================================================
% Name and version information of the main mbs file:
%\fi
% \ProvidesFile{merlin.mbs}[2004/02/09 4.13 (PWD, AO, DPC)]
%\iffalse
%</!tail>
%<*a&!a>
% The following ensures that the driver part is not seen by makebst
% The driver part must not contain any \end other than \end{document} !
\ifx\endoptions\undefined\let\tempx=\relax\else
\long\def\tempx#1\end#2{}\fi\tempx
%</a&!a>
%<*driver>
\NeedsTeXFormat{LaTeX2e}%
\documentclass[a4paper,10pt,twoside]{article}%
\usepackage{doc}%
\raggedbottom
\CodelineNumbered
\RecordChanges
% Comment out next line to print coding
\OnlyDescription
\setlength{\oddsidemargin}{0.5\paperwidth}
\addtolength{\oddsidemargin}{-0.5\textwidth}
\addtolength{\oddsidemargin}{-1in}
\setlength{\evensidemargin}{\oddsidemargin}
\begin{document}
\DocInput{merlin.mbs}
\end{document}
%</driver>
% END OF META COMMENT \fi
% \CharacterTable
% {Upper-case \A\B\C\D\E\F\G\H\I\J\K\L\M\N\O\P\Q\R\S\T\U\V\W\X\Y\Z
% Lower-case \a\b\c\d\e\f\g\h\i\j\k\l\m\n\o\p\q\r\s\t\u\v\w\x\y\z
% Digits \0\1\2\3\4\5\6\7\8\9
% Exclamation \! Double quote \" Hash (number) \#
% Dollar \$ Percent \% Ampersand \&
% Acute accent \' Left paren \( Right paren \)
% Asterisk \* Plus \+ Comma \,
% Minus \- Point \. Solidus \/
% Colon \: Semicolon \; Less than \<
% Equals \= Greater than \> Question mark \?
% Commercial at \@ Left bracket \[ Backslash \\
% Right bracket \] Circumflex \^ Underscore \_
% Grave accent \` Left brace \{ Vertical bar \|
% Right brace \} Tilde \~}
%
% \CheckSum{450}
% \setcounter{StandardModuleDepth}{1}
% \setcounter{IndexColumns}{2}
% \setlength{\IndexMin}{10cm}
%
% \changes{1.0}{1993 Aug 16}{Initial version}
% \changes{2.0}{1994 Jan 31}{Add multilingual capabilities}
% \changes{2.1--2.5}{1995 May 2}{Changes to \texttt{babel.mbs} parallel 1.3--1.7
% in \texttt{genbst.mbs}}
% \changes{1.3(2.1)}{1994 Jul 1}{Change documentation to \LaTeXe}
% \changes{1.3(2.1)a}{1994 Sep 1}{Alter wording of article title capitalization
% choice}
% \changes{1.4(2.2)}{1994 Sep 5}{Add full author name possibilities}
% \changes{1.4(2.2)}{1994 Sep 5}{Fix up some punctuations}
% \changes{1.4(2.2)a}{1994 Sep 7}{Add possibility to put titles in quotes}
% \changes{1.5(2.3)}{1994 Sep 15}{Accommodate new \texttt{harvard.sty}}
% \changes{1.5(2.3)}{1994 Sep 15}{Add full names for \texttt{natbib} v5.3}
% \changes{1.5(2.3)a}{1994 Oct 11}{Add option so year can contain any text}
% \changes{1.5(2.3)b}{1995 Jan 18}{Allow edited by to be in parentheses}
% \changes{1.5(2.3)b}{1995 Jan 18}{Allow (year) to have no punctuation
% following}
% \changes{1.5(2.3)c}{1995 Jan 20}{Journal volume numbers with more choice}
% \changes{1.6(2.4)}{1995 Feb 2}{Date with no punctuation preceding it}
% \changes{1.6(2.4)}{1995 Feb 2}{Editor names can be reversed like authors'}
% \changes{1.6(2.4)}{1995 Feb 2}{Can abbreviate `edited by' to `ed(s).'}
% \changes{1.6(2.4)}{1995 Feb 2}{Released version}
% \changes{1.7(2.5)}{1995 Feb 9}{Add \texttt{seq-key} option}
% \changes{3.0}{1995 Mar 15}{Becomes \texttt{merlin.mbs}, with language
% support in additional files}
% \changes{3.0}{1995 Feb 27}{Allow full author names to be reversed}
% \changes{3.0}{1995 Mar 1}{Add \texttt{isbn} field option}
% \changes{3.0}{1995 Mar 3}{Citation names can be bold or small caps}
% \changes{3.0}{1995 Mar 8}{Colon and space may follow year}
% \changes{3.0}{1995 Mar 15}{Names can be reversed, dotless intials}
% \changes{3.0}{1995 Mar 17}{Volume, number can be followed by semi-colon}
% \changes{3.0}{1995 Mar 20}{Allow word editor or ed to be in parentheses}
% \changes{3.0}{1995 Mar 20}{Abbreviated journal names can have dots removed}
% \changes{3.1}{1995 May 4}{Fix `edited by' so it is not abbreviated
% automatically with `editor'}
% \changes{3.1}{1995 May 6}{Re-do head/tail options to allow easy update of
% older \texttt{.dbj} files}
% \changes{3.2}{1995 May 19}{Minimum number of authors can be up to 6, not 5}
% \changes{3.2}{1995 May 19}{Allow date as part of journal spec., for medical
% journals}
% \changes{3.2}{1995 May 19}{Suppress `pages' and `pp'}
% \changes{3.2}{1995 May 19}{Allow date to be `1994 Jul', with or without dot}
% \changes{3.2}{1995 Jun 7}{Authors as Jones C.T.}
% \changes{3.2}{1995 Jun 16}{Sort without \emph{von} part}
% \changes{3.2}{1995 Jul 31}{Release as version 3.2}
% \changes{3.3}{1995 Aug 7}{Extra labels put in braces so they are treated
% as one unit by natbib}
% \changes{3.3}{1995 Aug 7}{Publisher's address can precede name}
% \changes{3.3}{1995 Sep 4}{Add full authors only if different from short list}
% \changes{3.4}{1995 Sep 5}{Add number of references as argument to
% \texttt{thebibliography} environment}
% \changes{3.4}{1995 Sep 28}{Fix placement of \texttt{bolden} in
% \texttt{format.vol.num.pages}}
% \changes{3.4}{1995 Sep 28}{Add possibility of date between volume and pages}
% \changes{3.4}{1995 Sep 28}{Word `and' can be in normal font in citations}
% \changes{3.5}{1995 Oct 4}{Tech Reports to have titles like books}
% \changes{3.5}{1995 Oct 9}{Delimit \texttt{\char`\\harvardyearright} properly}
% \changes{3.5}{1995 Oct 9}{Add option to sort by year (numerical only)}
% \changes{3.5}{1995 Oct 12}{Allow multiple journal-name files}
% \changes{3.5}{1995 Oct 16}{Allow months in dates even for author-year}
% \changes{3.5}{1995 Oct 24}{Fix sorting bug for limited number of authors}
% \changes{3.5}{1995 Oct 30}{Add \texttt{named} format for author--year cites}
% \changes{3.6}{1995 Nov 2}{Blocks can be separated by semi-colons}
% \changes{3.6}{1995 Nov 23}{Journal names in normal font}
% \changes{3.6}{1995 Nov 23}{Volume subnumber added to pages}
% \changes{3.6}{1995 Nov 24}{Book pages in parentheses}
% \changes{3.6}{1995 Dec 7}{Put Jr at end for AGU author style}
% \changes{3.6}{1995 Dec 7}{Put `and' in same font in list and citation}
% \changes{3.6}{1996 Jan 30}{Allow `et al' to be in normal font}
% \changes{3.6a}{1996 Feb 1}{Fix bugs with \texttt{xand} option}
% \changes{3.7}{1996 Feb 2}{Fix small caps with NFSS}
% \changes{3.7}{1996 Feb 5}{Fix clash of \texttt{emphasize} and
% \texttt{purify\$}}
% \changes{3.8}{1996 Feb 29}{Add \texttt{alpha}-type style}
% \changes{3.8}{1996 Mar 1}{Style alpha is never unsorted}
% \changes{3.8}{1996 Mar 12}{Allow blanks between blocks}
% \changes{3.8}{1996 Mar 12}{Publisher in parentheses}
% \changes{3.8}{1996 Mar 15}{Allow author-year to be sorted by year}
% \changes{3.8}{1996 Mar 16}{Cited `and' resets only one attribute}
% \changes{3.8}{1996 Mar 19}{Allow date to be between volume and number}
% \changes{3.81}{1996 Jun 17}{Add \texttt{\char`\\natexlab} for \texttt{natbib} 6.3}
% \changes{3.81}{1996 Jun 19}{Fix coding for adding `page' to journals}
% \changes{3.81}{1996 Jun 19}{Add `volume' to journals}
% \changes{3.81}{1996 Jun 19}{Remove word `in'}
% \changes{3.81}{1996 Jun 19}{Place publisher before chapter/pages}
% \changes{3.81}{1996 Jun 25}{Allow period after date}
% \changes{3.81}{1996 Jun 26}{Commas between blocks, except for article titles
% where period comes}
% \changes{3.81}{1996 Sep 12}{Allow comma before date}
% \changes{3.81}{1996 Sep 13}{Reorganize incollection organization and
% publisher}
% \changes{3.81}{1996 Sep 13}{Allow edition to come before publisher}
% \changes{3.81}{1996 Sep 16}{Allow author--year to be in citation order}
% \changes{3.81}{1996 Sep 16}{Publisher, address, date can all be in
% parentheses}
% \changes{3.81}{1996 Sep 18}{Remove extraneous hyphen before
% \texttt{\char`\\getans}}
% \changes{3.82}{1996 Nov 15}{Allow pages at end before notes}
% \changes{3.82}{1996 Nov 15}{Fix bug with quoted titles when title missing}
% \changes{3.82}{1996 Dec 16}{Fix bug that put comma before publisher in
% parentheses}
% \changes{3.82}{1996 Dec 16}{Allow AGU author style with full names}
% \changes{3.83}{1997 Feb 5}{Allow dash for repeated authors, periods
% before notes}
% \changes{3.83}{1997 Apr 25}{Change case of first note word if mid-sentence}
% \changes{3.84}{1997 Sep 16}{Option to break long page numbers}
% \changes{3.84}{1997 Oct 20}{Option for titles in guillemets}
% \changes{3.84}{1997 Oct 20}{Option to use underlining for emphasis}
% \changes{3.84}{1997 Oct 30}{Reorganize options for year in journal spec}
% \changes{3.84}{1997 Oct 30}{Multiple options in menu}
% \changes{3.85}{1998 Feb 10}{Fonts for names: can exclude first names,
% use-defined font allowed, improved coding for `and' and `et~al.'}
% \changes{3.86}{1998 Feb 25}{Use \texttt{format.date} consistently in place
% of \texttt{year} alone}
% \changes{3.86}{1998 Feb 25}{Suppress ISBN number when certain crossrefs
% are present}
% \changes{3.86}{1998 Feb 25}{Add option for comma between year and pages}
% \changes{3.86}{1998 Apr 20}{Bug with minimum 6 authors corrected}
% \changes{3.87}{1998 Jul 23}{Add \texttt{url} field for all styles}
% \changes{3.87}{1998 Jul 23}{Suppress months in numerical mode}
% \changes{3.87}{1998 Jul 23}{Author limitation now 99}
% \changes{3.87}{1998 Jul 23}{Add \texttt{annote} field and annotation}
% \changes{3.87}{1998 Aug 17}{Add \texttt{issn} field}
% \changes{3.87}{1998 Aug 17}{Correct spelling of `guillimet'}
% \changes{3.87}{1998 Aug 17}{Make \textsl{et~al.} a variable \texttt{bbl.etal}}
% \changes{3.87}{1998 Aug 17}{Add \texttt{language} field}
% \changes{3.87h}{1998 Oct 16}{Add html output possibilities}
% \changes{3.88}{1998 Nov 27}{Option to suppress edition conversion in English}
% \changes{3.88}{1998 Dec 2}{Conf. booktitles are upright if book titles are}
% \changes{3.88}{1998 Dec 2}{Various extra options for book pages,
% inproceedings, mainly for MPG Jahrbuch}
% \changes{3.88}{1998 Jan 13}{For html, newblock just adds period, no new line}
% \changes{3.88}{1999 Feb 1}{Do edition suppression properly}
% \changes{3.88}{1999 Feb 26}{Fix font handling of names}
% \changes{3.88}{1999 Feb 26}{Test for multipages for word `page(s)' in journals}
% \changes{3.89}{1999 May 12}{Missing years may be left blank, not just ????}
% \changes{3.89}{1999 May 12}{When key replaces author, leave year blank}
% \changes{3.89d1}{1999 Jul 20}{AO: %Arthur Ogawa (ogawa@teleport.com)
% Add new entries: collaboration, eid, eprint, numpages, per option
% \texttt{revdata}}
% \changes{3.89d1}{1999 Jul 20}{AO: Add reference component tags (\texttt{bibinfo}
% and friends)}
% \changes{4.00}{1999 Sept 17}{PWD: incorporate AO's changes with moderations}
% \changes{4.00}{2000 Jan 21}{PWD: add \texttt{archive} field}
% \changes{4.01}{2000 May 4}{PWD: Fix improper \texttt{change.case\$} and
% \texttt{bibinfo.check} ordering}
% \changes{4.02}{2000 June 27}{Fix bug with `in' with articles}
% \changes{4.03}{2002 Jan 14}{PWD: add \texttt{seq-yrr} for reversed year ordering}
% \changes{4.03}{2002 Jan 14}{PWD: add \texttt{thtit-x} to suppress thesis titles}
% \changes{4.03}{2002 Jan 14}{PWD: add line to define \texttt{natexlab} in aux file for harvard}
% \changes{4.03}{2002 Jan 14}{PWD: bug fix when both \texttt{pp-last} and \texttt{dt-jnl} given}
% \changes{4.04}{2002 Sep 13}{PWD: add support for Slovene/Slovenian language}
% \changes{4.05}{2002 Oct 21}{PWD: bug fix in \texttt{inproceedings} with
% \texttt{pp-last} and \texttt{dt-beg}}
% \changes{4.06}{2003 Apr 2}{PWD: add \texttt{nmd-2} and \texttt{nmd-3} for use with \texttt{nmdash}}
% \changes{4.10}{2003 May 28}{PWD: add DOI}
% \changes{4.10}{2003 June 3}{PWD: use \texttt{\backslash providecommand}
% instead of \TeX\ commands, but provide \texttt{noprov} option to undo it.}
% \changes{4.10}{2003 June 3}{PWD: make \texttt{eid} available not just for Rev\TeX}
% \changes{4.10}{2003 June 11}{PWD: add \texttt{pg-pre} for total book pages location}
% \changes{4.11}{2003 June 23}{PWD: fix DOI to have no space after colon}
% \changes{4.11}{2003 June 23}{PWD: add options \texttt{ser-vol} and \texttt{ser-ed}}
% \changes{4.11a}{2003 Aug 19}{PWD: fix bug with \texttt{ser-ed} option}
% \changes{4.12}{2003 Sep 8}{PWD: rename \texttt{noprov} to \texttt{plntx} for Plain \TeX\ compatibility}
% \changes{4.12a}{2003 Nov 6}{PWD: fix bug in which comma separators go on wrong side; change was
% originally made in \texttt{makebst} but not in \texttt{merlin}}
% \changes{4.13}{2003 Feb 9}{PWD: fix some bugs in \texttt{inbook} and \texttt{incollection}}
% \changes{4.13}{2003 Feb 9}{PWD: add option \texttt{nm-rvcx}}
% \changes{4.13}{2003 Feb 9}{PWD: add option \texttt{tit-col} for colon after titles}
%
% \pagestyle{myheadings}
% \markboth{P. W. Daly}{A General Master Bibliography Style}
%
% \title{{\bfseries A Master Bibliographic Style File}\\
% for numerical, author--year, multilingual applications}
%
% \author{Patrick W. Daly}
%
% \GetFileInfo{merlin.mbs}
% \date{This paper describes file \texttt{\filename},\\
% version \fileversion{} from \filedate
% \thanks{Work on \texttt{custom-bib}~4.00 was supported by the
% American Physical Society}}
%
% \maketitle
%
% \MakeShortVerb{\|}
%
% \parskip=1ex \parindent=0pt
%
% \newcommand{\btx}{{\sc Bib}\TeX}
% \newcommand{\dtx}{\textsf{docstrip}}
%
% \section{Introduction}
% A problem facing users of \btx{} is that there is no standard for
% formatting lists of references. Publishers and journals insist
% on completely arbitrary placement of commas, colons, and ordering of
% entries. Furthermore, author--year styles of citations are supported by
% certain special \LaTeX{} packages, but each for only a very limited
% number of bibliographic styles. Finally, most such style files are for
% English only, and any adaptations to other languages must duplicate the
% entire spectrum of such files.
%
% All of these obstacles are in principle easily overcome by simply
% reprogramming \btx{} by means of an appropriate \emph{bibliographic style
% file} (extension \texttt{.bst}). \btx{} is in fact extremely flexible;
% unfortunately its programming language is very low-level, permitting only
% the most basic of hacks for the normal user.
%
% The solution to this is a \emph{generic} or \emph{master bibliographic
% style file} (extension \texttt{.mbs}) containing \dtx{} options for
% alternative coding. By selecting the desired options, one can customize a
% \texttt{.bst} file to one's needs.
%
% This file, \texttt{\filename}, is my latest version of a general-purpose
% \texttt{.mbs} file to meet as many bibliographic needs as possible.
% It was originally assembled from Oren Patashnik's standard files {\tt
% plain.bst} and \texttt{unsrt.bst}, plus his non-standard file {\tt
% apalike.bst}, a very basic author--year citation style.
% It has since evolved extensively as I have added features found in
% available \texttt{.bst} files, and those demanded by publishers or
% suggested to me by many user/contributors.
%
% To produce a customized bibliographic style (\texttt{.bst}) file from this
% master file, simply \TeX{} or \LaTeX{} the `program' \texttt{makebst.tex}.
% When asked for the name of the master file, answer with
% \begin{quote}\tt\filename\end{quote}
% and then reply to the questions in the following menus. The last question
% is whether you want to generate the \texttt{.bst} file right away.
%
% More details on this process and on the options available are to be found
% in the rest of this article.
%
% \section{History of this File}
%
% Since the first release of this generic file, in November 1993, under the
% name \texttt{genbst.mbs}, I have received innumerable
% suggestions for additions, most of which I have tried to include. Often
% this has resulted in reorganizing the coding, and adding new functions.
% The resulting \texttt{.bst} files are now quite different from those of
% Patashnik, although the underlying ideas are the same.
%
% A second version was released shortly afterwards that paralleled the first
% one except that it included support for languages other than English.
% That file was named \texttt{babel.mbs}, following the \texttt{babel}
% system of Johannes Braams. Although I always viewed it as version 2 of
% \texttt{genbst.mbs}, all additions to the one were also included in the
% other. This of course was tedious and prone to error. I looked forward to
% the day when \texttt{babel.mbs} would become the only supported version.
% The reason I was reluctant to do that before was that the overhead per
% language was fairly high, and I dreaded to think how large the file would
% become when 20 or 30 languages were added.
%
% I then found a way to put the language definitions into separate files,
% one per language. This means that new languages do not burden the basic
% file, and that users need only keep those support files that might
% interest him or her. New ones may also be made up locally by hacking an
% existing language definition file. (The file \texttt{english.mbs} is
% supplied only for this purpose.)
%
% For this reason, \texttt{\filename} was released as version~3 of
% \texttt{genbst.mbs} and \texttt{babel.mbs}. In spite of the new name, it
% should be regarded as their direct successor. Needless to say, this means
% that the earlier two \texttt{.mbs} files will no longer be maintained.
%
% To include language support, all explicit English words like
% \textsl{editor} and \textsl{chapter} have been replaced by functions
% whose definitions may be altered in the resulting \texttt{.bst} file
% (less desirable method) or which may be redefined by an external
% language definition file (preferred method). Alternatively, one can select
% the pseudo-language named \texttt{babel} which inserts \LaTeX{} commands
% for the explicit words, the definitions of which must be
% contained in a file called {\tt babelbst.tex}. Only the languages English
% and \texttt{babel} are included internally to \texttt{\filename}; all
% others are contained in external language definition files.
%
% Another new feature is the possibility of including a file containing
% prestored shorthand designations for certain journal names. Such a file
% is provided for physics journals, but others could be made up using this
% one as a model. See Section~\ref{sec:jnames}.
%
% To take advantage of these external files, one must use
% \texttt{makebst} version~3; \texttt{\filename} may still be used with
% earlier versions, but without the external files.
%
% Version~4 arose out of a project by David Carlisle who created a variant
% of \texttt{\filename} for REV\TeX\ and the American Physical Society with
% the help of Mark Doyle of the APS. The main purpose was to add extra
% fields (see page~\pageref{sec:revtex}) that were needed. Subsequently
% Arthur Ogawa revised the code considerably, making it more rational,
% fixing some bugs and adding some extra features.
%
% I was then asked to incorporate all these changes into the official
% version of \texttt{\filename}. This required much debugging, since the
% Ogawa's rationalization upset several of the delicate interplays between
% various options. The result is version~4.0, the work on which has been
% supported by the American Physical Society.
%
% Version~4.0 contains the REV\TeX\ extra fields and the
% Carlisle-Doyle-Ogawa rewrites. An additional feature that derived from
% Carlisle's work on REV\TeX\ is the tagging of the text entries in the
% bibliography. This means the volume number is given as
% |\bibinfo{volume}{5}|. Normally only the number 5 is printed, but another
% program could use this to reconstruct the original database entries.
%
% Arthur Ogawa also added some features to \texttt{makebst} to provide a more
% verbose protocol. As a result, version~4 of \texttt{\filename} can only be
% used with version~4 of \texttt{makebst}. Older versions of \texttt{\filename}
% will still function with the newer \texttt{makebst}. Also, \texttt{.dbj}
% files created with older versions should still produce the same results with
% \texttt{\filename}~4.
%
% \def\temp{merlin.mbs}\ifx\temp\filename
% This file is now named after the legendary magician in the hope that it
% can produce wonders by incanting the right magic formulas. However, one
% should bear in mind that even Merlin was not omnipotent. It would be too
% much to hope that all bibliographic wishes will be fulfilled quickly and
% easily, but we shall try as best we can. Watch the wizardry at work!
% \fi
%
% \section{About Master Bibliographic Style Files}
%
% For details about how master bibliography style files are to be
% constructed, see the documentation on \texttt{makebst}. Here only a
% rough overview is given.
%
% \subsection{The \dtx{} Program}
% The \dtx{} program, written by Frank Mittelbach, is now a fundamental
% part of the \LaTeXe{} installation. Its original purpose is to remove
% comment lines from documented files, but has the secondary function of
% selecting alternative lines of coding.
%
% A master \btx{} bibliographic style file is one that, when processed by
% \dtx{} with selected options, produces a regular \btx{} \texttt{.bst}
% file with the desired features.
%
% In this sense, \dtx{} functions something like a C preprocessor. In fact,
% Oren Patashnik's original \texttt{.bst} files were all produced from a single
% source file by means of the preprocessor. The advantage of \dtx{} is that
% it is portable to all installations with \TeX.
%
% \subsection{The \dtx{} Batch Job}
%
% The \dtx{} program can be run either interactively, where the user must
% answer questions via the keyboard, or by means of a batch job where all
% the inputs are prepared in a file beforehand. For producing a \btx{}
% style file from a master file, the batch job method is the only feasible
% one, simply because of the large number of options available. (There is
% another reason for employing a batch job: the interactive method adds an
% |\endinput| command at the end, something that \btx{} will protest
% about.)
%
% The batch job files in general do not have any particular extension but I
% use \texttt{.dbj} for \emph{\dtx{} batch job}. These files are useful
% because they document the options used to produce the \texttt{.bst} file,
% and they may be edited to experiment with alternative options.
%
% \subsection{The \texttt{makebst} Program}
%
% It is possible to make up a batch job file by hand using the option
% information listed in Section~\ref{sec:options}, but my accompanying
% program \texttt{makebst} simplifies the task considerably. It reads menu
% information in the master file itself in order to present the user with
% an interactive list of choices, translating the answers into appropriate
% options that are then written to a batch job file.
%
% To run it, simply process \texttt{makebst.tex} with \TeX\ or \LaTeX, and
% answer the questions. The first of these is whether you want some
% instructions or not, and the second is the name of the \texttt{.mbs} that
% you want to use. The next query is about the name of the desired
% \texttt{.bst} file (which will also be the root name of the batch job).
% After that, all further questions come from menu information in the
% master file.
%
% At the very end, \texttt{makebst} asks if it should run the batch job for
% you. Isn't that a fine service?
%
% \section{Multilingual Adaptation}
% The original \texttt{.bst} files from Oren Patashnik contain explicit
% English words that are output into the final text. Since \LaTeX{} is
% increasingly being used for other languages, and since the official
% version since December 1991 also uses macros in place of explicit words,
% it seems appropriate for \btx{} to follow suit.
%
% In this master bibliographic style file {\tt\filename}, all explicit
% words have been replaced by functions: e.g., the word \textsl{editor} has
% become the function \texttt{bbl.editor}. Depending on the language option
% chosen, this function is defined to be the text {\tt"editor"},
% {\tt"Redakteur"}, or {\tt"redacteur"}, for English, German, and French,
% respectively.
%
% There is another special `language' called \texttt{babel} that instead inserts
% the text |"\bbleditor{}"|; the definitions of these \LaTeX{} commands
% must be in a separate file named \texttt{babelbst.tex} that is read in at
% the start of the bibliography.
%
% Only English and \texttt{babel} are supported directly in
% \texttt{\filename}; all other language definitions are contained in
% separate definition files, e.g., \texttt{french.mbs}, \texttt{german.mbs}.
%
% The language selection is made during the \texttt{makebst} run, which
% asks for the name of the language definition file as the first menu item. If
% either English or \texttt{babel} is wanted, reply with the default, which
% is \texttt{\filename} itself; otherwise give the name of the desired
% language file.
%
% \begin{quote}\slshape
% \textbf{Note:} the language definition files can only be used with
% \texttt{makebst} version~3 or later, and
%
% with an external definition file, the \dtx{} run requires two passes
% through \texttt{\filename}, doubling the processing time.
% \end{quote}
%
% Apart from the language adaptation of the whole bibliography, there is also
% the possibility of switching languages for individual references, so as to
% hyphenate the title properly. This is done with the \texttt{language} field
% and the \verb!\setlanguage! command.
%
% \subsection{Adding a New Language Definition File}
%
% To create a new language definition file, simply take one of the existing
% ones, like \texttt{english.mbs}, and replace the explicit English words
% with their translations. There are, however, a number of points that can
% complicate this procedure.
%
% \begin{enumerate}
% \item
% Do not forget to change the documentation in the file, especially
% version number, date, author.
%
% \item
% There are option menus that need to be translated too. It might also be
% desirable to add or remove options. In most cases, the options in the
% language files involve possible abbreviations, like
% \begin{quote}
% \verb!\mes{^^JABBREVIATE WORD `PAGES':}!\\
% \verb!\optdef{*}{}{`Page(s)'}{(no abbreviation)}!\\
% \verb!\optdef{a}{pp}{`Page' abbreviated}{as p. or pp.}!\\
% \verb!\getans!
% \end{quote}
%
% In this example, the option \texttt{pp} appears later in the definition
% \begin{quote}
% \verb!FUNCTION {bbl.pages}!\\
% \verb+%<!pp>{ "pages" }+\\
% \verb!%<pp>{ "pp." }!
% \end{quote}
% This a \emph{local} option, that only affects the coding in the definition
% file. It is possible to add more local options.
%
% \item
% However, all options, whether activated by the main file or by the
% definition file, apply to both. In other words, there really is no such
% thing as a local option. In the above example, \texttt{pp} is only
% local because it is never used in \texttt{\filename}.
%
% \item
% Add the name of the language as an option, with
% \begin{quote}
% \verb!\mes{^^JOptions for ENGLISH}!\\
% \verb!\wr{\spsp\spsp english,\pc: English language}!
% \end{quote}
% (This is how options are added without |\optdef| and |\getans|.) The
% main file just might recognize it in order to take some
% language-specific action. The least it should do is add a comment at
% the start of the \texttt{.bst} file stating for which language it is to
% be used.
%
% \item
% There could be some problems with edition numbers due to language
% dependent ways of treating ordinal numbers (1st, 2nd, 3rd in English;
% 1$^{\mbox{\scriptsize re}}$, 2$^{\mbox{\scriptsize e}}$,
% 3$^{\mbox{\scriptsize e}}$ in French; 1., 2., 3., in German). Some
% accommodation already exists for the oddball language English, and
% further hacking may be needed for others.
%
% \item
% If there should be any need for a double-quote character in
% the translations (German needs it for umlauts) then there is trouble
% because the \btx{} strings do not allow it. Instead, use the command
% |\qq|, as in the German word |F\qq{u}nfte| for {\sl F\"unfte} (fifth).
% It is then vital to add the option \texttt{umlaut} with
% \begin{quote}
% \verb!\wr{\spsp\spsp umlaut,\pc: Activate umlaut command}!
% \end{quote}
%
% Bernd Raichle points out that |\^^b| can be used in place of |\"|
% within \btx{} code. One can thus replace |F\qq{u}nfte| with |F\^^b unfte|
% and do away with the \texttt{umlaut} option.
%
% \end{enumerate}
%
% \subsection{Changing \texttt{babelbst.tex} for a New Language}
%
% Alternatively, a new language can be added by
% modifying the file \texttt{babelbst.tex} and selecting the language {\tt
% babel} for the \texttt{.bst} file. If this is the only language to be used,
% then just change the English words in the definitions.
%
% However, some form of switching would be more desirable. With \TeX\
% version 3, there is a |\language| parameter to control the hyphenation
% patterns, and this could be used to select the correct language. For
% example, if language 0 is English and language 1 German, then put the
% English version of \texttt{babelbst.tex} into \texttt{englbst.tex} and the
% German
% version in \texttt{germbst.tex}. Then \texttt{babelbst.tex} could contain:
% \begin{quote}\begin{verbatim}
% \ifcase\language \input{englbst} \or \input{germbst}
% \else \input{englbst} \fi
% \end{verbatim}
% \end{quote}
%
% This is of course installation dependent.
%
% \subsection{Extracting the Sample \texttt{babelbst.tex} File}
%
% A sample \texttt{babelbst.tex} (for English) is contained in this master
% file. Extract it with \dtx{} and the option \texttt{bblbst}. It may be
% edited (and possibly renamed) for other languages as needed.
%
% \subsection{Problem with Edition Numbers}
% Something to note here is the ordinal numbers for editions. \btx{}
% demands that the field \texttt{edition} be given in the database as a word
% \textsl{First}, \textsl{Second}, etc., or as \textsl{1st}, \textsl{2nd},
% etc. This is bad policy
% because it is language dependent. So what I do is to test for the words
% \textsl{first} through \textsl{fifth} (case independently) and replace them
% with language-dependent equivalents. If the {\tt<ord>} option is selected,
% these equivalents are ordinal numbers for that language. Any other words
% cannot be interpreted and must be printed as is.
%
% However, if the \texttt{edition} is given as a number, with or without
% following letters, then the numbers 1 through 5 are replaced by their
% words; any higher numbers just have the ordinal ending (\textsl{th}
% in English) added to them.
%
% These numbers are only used with the word \textsl{edition} or
% its equivalent in other languages, so the translators need
% to provide only the one gender, e.g., feminine for both German and
% French.
%
%
% \section{Prestoring Names of Journals}\label{sec:jnames}
%
% The standard \texttt{.bst} files contain the names of some 20 journals
% in the field of computing, stored as macros for easy reference within the
% database \texttt{.bib} files. For example, the \textsl{Journal of
% Computer and System Sciences} can be referred to as \texttt{jcss}.
% With the option \texttt{jabr} (for journal abbreviation) this same
% shorthand produces \textsl{J.~Comput. Syst. Sci.}.
%
% Some \texttt{.bst} files for physics journals include additional journal
% names, and it is conceivable that other faculties might wish to prepare
% their own such lists, with each name present in a full or abbreviated
% form. Such an external file can now be added with \texttt{\filename} and
% \texttt{makebst} version~3.
%
% As a model, I supply a file \texttt{physjour.mbs} with the names of
% physics journals which I have taken from other \texttt{.bst} files.
% I also have a file \texttt{geojour.mbs} with the names of geophysics
% journals, and a contributed file \texttt{photjour.mbs} containing names of
% optics journals.
%
% In fact, version~3.5 can even include multiple journal-name files.
% Thus one can decide whether to include both, one, or none of the above
% files.
%
% \section{HTML Output}
% There is an option \texttt{html} to create a \texttt{.bst} file producing
% hypertext (HTML) output instead of the regular \LaTeX\ code. This is still
% experimental. The resulting \btx\ output will still be a file with extension
% \texttt{.bbl} and will contain the \LaTeX\ special characters, like |\"a| for
% \"a. One must go over the output to convert such characters to the HTML
% equivalents, and to remove curly braces. Only then can it be renamed
% \texttt{.html}.
%
% Three possible lists are offered:
% \begin{itemize}
% \item a simple paragraph for each entry,
% \item a numbered list,
% \item a description list with the key as the label.
% \end{itemize}
%
% \section{Updating Older \texttt{.dbj} Files}\label{sec:update}
% If you have existing \texttt{.dbj} files for generating \texttt{.bst}
% files from the older version \texttt{genbst.mbs}, these may be run with
% \texttt{\filename} by simply changing the name of the source
% \texttt{.mbs} file. For example, where the older \texttt{.dbj} file contains
% the line
% \begin{quote}
% |\generateFile{mystyle.bst}{f}{\from{genbst.mbs}{%|
% \end{quote}
% edit the file so that \texttt{genbst.mbs} is replaced by
% \texttt{\filename}. The resulting \texttt{mystyle.bst} file will then be
% an updated version of the older one, containing all the same features.
%
% Version~4 of \texttt{\filename} can only be used with version~4 of
% \texttt{makebst}, whereas older versions of \texttt{\filename} will still
% function with the newer \texttt{makebst}. Also, \texttt{.dbj} files created
% with older versions should still produce the same results with
% \texttt{\filename}~4, albeit with different coding.
%
% \section{Acknowledgements}
% I wish to thank all the people who have taken the trouble to send me
% suggestions or special requests. Admittedly, it has been out of
% self-interest on their part, since they had bibliographic needs to be
% met. And I have often questioned the need for many of their demands. Yet,
% that is part of the bibliographic jungle that I am trying to eliminate.
% If I thought that bibliographies were arbitrarily formatted before I
% started this project, I have more than sufficient confirmation since
% then. The fault lies not with the poor contributors, but with the
% publishers who cannot agree on a decent standard.
%
% I want to thank Frank Mittelbach, not only for creating \dtx{}
% in the first place, but also for sending me his bibliographic requirements,
% and for suggesting an improvement to \texttt{makebst}.
%
% David Carlisle has added the REV\TeX\ fields and |\bibinfo| tagging in a
% special variant of \texttt{\filename}; Arthur Ogawa then incorporated
% them into the main file, and overhauled much of the coding to make it
% more legible and rational.
%
% I especially wish to thank Mark Doyle and the American Physical
% Society for supporting the work on \texttt{custom-bib}~4.0.
%
% And finally, all of us must thank Oren Patashnik for providing \btx;
% without its flexibility and programmability (in spite of the complexity
% of the language) the master bibliographic styles would not be possible at
% all.
%
% \section{The Options}\label{sec:options}
% Here I present a list of all the \dtx{} options that are
% available in this file {\tt\filename}.
% The normal user can skip this section since he will probably make use
% of the menus via \texttt{makebst}. These are described in
% Section~\ref{sec:menu}. The menus provide much more informative prompts
% than the heavily abbreviated option names listed here. In other words,
% the options described in this section are meant for internal (programmer)
% usage, while the normal interface for the user is the menus.
%
% I have tried to avoid
% conflicts with mutually exclusive options by always letting one dominate if
% more than one has been specified. Such options have the same prefix, such
% as \texttt{nm-rev} and \texttt{nm-init}.
% If one uses \texttt{makebst} to produce the
% \dtx{} batch job, then it is impossible to give mutually
% exclusive options unless one edits the batch file oneself afterwards.
% (Anything is possible with computer freaks!)
%
% Most mutually exclusive options have the same prefix before the hyphen.
%
% \newenvironment{opt}{%
% \begin{list}{}{\labelwidth2cm \leftmargin2.5cm \labelsep1em \rightmargin0pt
% \def\makelabel##1{\ttfamily##1 \hfill}}}{\end{list}}
% \textbf{Citation style:} whether or not a numerical or author--year system
% is to be used.
% \begin{opt}
% \item[--] default is numerical, standard \LaTeX, as for {\tt
% plain.bst}.\\
% |\bibitem{key}...|
% \item[cite] special for listing entire databases; the cite key is used
% as the label so it may be listed.\\
% |\bibitem[key]{key}...|
% \item[ay] for author--year style of citations. Various forms of |\bibitem|
% are provided under this option, to support different types
% of \LaTeX{} styles for interfacing with the author--year system.
% \item[alph] for \texttt{alpha.bst} style of citations; essentially numerical
% but an abbreviation of the author names plus year is used as
% the label. First three letters of single author, or first letters
% of first three authors.
% \item[alf-1] with \texttt{alph}, uses first three letters of first author's
% name, regardless of how many authors.
% \item[alf-f] with \texttt{alph}, uses first author's whole name.
% \end{opt}
%
% For numerical style, one can select the HTML option, to output a
% hypertext file instead of a \LaTeX\ one.
%
% \begin{opt}
% \item[--] normal \LaTeX\ output;
% \item[html] for HTML output, one reference per paragraph
% \item[htlist] (with \texttt{html}) outputs to a numbered list;
% \item[htdes] (with \texttt{html}) outputs description list, with the key.
% \end{opt}
%
% If \texttt{ay} has been selected, then the type of author--year interface
% is selectable. Some of these, like \texttt{natbib} and \texttt{harvard}
% exist in two versions because of updates in these systems.
% \begin{opt}
% \item[--] default is the system I invented for my \texttt{natbib.sty}.\\
% |\bibitem[author(year)]{key}...|
% \item[nat] for extended format of \texttt{natbib.sty} version 5.3\\
% |\bibitem[author(year)full author]{key}...|
% \item[alk] for the \texttt{apalike.sty} of Oren Patashnik and related
% systems\\
% |\bibitem[author, year]{key}...|
% \item[har] for the Harvard family of styles (with \texttt{harvard.sty}).\\
% |\harvarditem[short]{long}{year}{key}...|
% \item[harnm] for the extended Harvard family, containing some extra commands
% used by \LaTeXe\ version 2.0.3 of \texttt{harvard.sty}
% \item[ast] for astronomy family of styles (with \texttt{astron.sty}).\\
% |\bibitem[\protect\astroncite{author}{year}]{key}...|
% \item[cay] for the Chicago family of styles (with \texttt{chicago.sty}).\\
% |\bibitem[\protect\citeauthoryear{long}{short}{year}]{key}...|
% \item[nmd] for the `named' variant of Chicago (with \texttt{named.sty}).\\
% |\bibitem[\protect\citeauthoryear{author}{year}]{key}...|
% \item[cn] for the ``author--date'' group of styles (with {\tt
% authordate1-4.sty})\\
% |\bibitem[\protect\citename{author, }year]{key}...|
% \end{opt}
%
% \textbf{Sequence:} the order in which the references are listed.
% \begin{opt}
% \item[--] default is alphabetical by all authors, date, title
% \item[seq-yr] order by year (ascending), authors, title
% \item[seq-yrr] order by year (descending), authors, title
% \item[seq-no] sequence by citation order
% \item[seq-lab] (author--year) by label, date, title (means that Daly
% precedes Daly and Williams, precedes Daly et al.)
% \item[seq-key] (author--year) like \texttt{seq-lab} except that for
% identical authors and year, the cite keyword is used
% instead of the title
% \item[vonx] ignore \emph{von} part of name when ordering (default is
% to consider \emph{von} as part of the whole surname)
% \end{opt}
%
% \textbf{Language selection:} the translations of certain explicit words.
% \begin{opt}
% \item[--] default is English, for \textsl{and}, \textsl{chapter},
% \textsl{editor}, etc.;
% \item[babel] replace words with \LaTeX{} commands that are defined
% in the file \texttt{babelbst.tex};
% \item[lang] adds the \texttt{language} field for switching language
% for one reference only by means of the \verb!\setlanguage!
% command in \texttt{babel}.
% \end{opt}
%
% If one of the external language definition files is used, then the name of
% its language should be in the list of active options. Many other language
% names are already included as options in this main file simply for the
% purpose of adding a comment at the start of the \texttt{.bst} file.
%
% The \texttt{language} field is intended to allow the hyphenation patterns
% to be switched temporarily so that titles can be set in the original
% language.
%
% \textbf{Annotation:}
% annotations are added either by means of the \texttt{annote} field, or
% with a \texttt{.tex} file of the same name as the citation key.
% \begin{opt}
% \item[--] no annotations
% \item[annote] annotations enabled, with \texttt{annote} field.
% \end{opt}
%
% \textbf{Missing names:}
% If the author and/or editor is missing, the standard \texttt{.bst} files
% use the \texttt{key} field in place of the names for purposes of ordering the
% entries.
%
% For author--year styles, the \texttt{key} field is even inserted in the
% reference list and in the label in place of the authors. Optionally, one can
% suppress the year in this case, which causes \texttt{natbib} (version~7)
% to print only that key text as a code designation for the work.
%
% \begin{opt}
% \item[--] year is inserted in the labels when \texttt{key} replaces authors
% \item[keyxyr] year is left blank in this case
% \end{opt}
%
% \textbf{Names formatting:} how initials and surnames are to be combined.
% \begin{opt}
% \item[--] default is full names, given names first
% \item[nm-revf] full names, surname first
% \item[nm-init] initials plus surname
% \item[nm-rev] surname plus initials
% \item[nm-rev1] surname plus initials (1st name only) then initials
% plus surname
% \item[nm-revv1] same as \texttt{nm-rev1} but with full names
% \item[nm-rv] as \texttt{nm-rev}, but initials without dots
% \item[nm-rvv] as \texttt{nm-rev}, but initials without spaces
% \item[nm-rvx] as \texttt{nm-rev}, but initials without dots or spaces
% \item[nm-rvcx] as \texttt{nm-rvx}, but with comma after surname
% \item[ed-rev] editors' names in collections are reversed the same as authors'
% \item[ed-au] editors are formatted with same routine as authors; this
% is an alias for \texttt{ed-rev}, which is kept only for
% compatibility
% \item[aunm-semi] a semi-colon is placed between author names instead of
% a comma
% \item[aunm-sl] a slash is placed between author names instead of a comma
% \item[nmdash] repeated author/editor names replaced by dash
% \item[nmd-2] with \texttt{nmdash}, uses 2 em dashes
% \item[nmd-3] with \texttt{nmdash}, uses 3 em dashes
% \item[jnrlab] include the junior part of name in citations (normally
% appears only in reference listing)
% \item[jnrlst] with one of the \texttt{nm-rev} type options, puts the
% junior part last, after the (reversed) first name
% \end{opt}
%
% \textbf{Number of names:} normally all names listed (in reference list)
% \begin{opt}
% \item[nmlm] limit number of names
% \item[x1...x90] (with \texttt{nmlm}) maximum number of names to appear;
% for over 9, give the tens and units separately, as
% \texttt{x20,x5} for 25
% \item[m1...m90] (with \texttt{nmlm}) minimum number before \textsl{et al.}
% written;
% no check for consistency is taken; one \texttt{x} and
% one \texttt{m} number must be given, and {\tt x}$\le${\tt m}
% \end{opt}
%
% \textbf{Names font:} in the reference list
% \begin{opt}
% \item[--] default is names in normal typeface
% \item[nmft] names are in some special font
% \item[nmfted] editors' names in collections also get special fonts
% \item[nmft-sc] names in small caps
% \item[nmft-it] names in italics
% \item[nmft-bf] names in bold
% \item[nmft-def] names in user defined font |\bibnamefont{}|.
% \item[nmand-rm] `and' in normal font, not same as authors'.
% \item[fnm-rm] (with \texttt{nmft}) first names are in regular font
% \item[fnm-def] (with \texttt{nmft}) first names are in user defined
% font |\bibfnamefont{}|.
% \item[--] first names are in same font as the surnames.
% \end{opt}
%
% \textbf{Citation font:} what is written by the |\cite| command
% \begin{opt}
% \item[--] default is no special font
% \item[lab-it] cited names in italics
% \item[lab-sc] cited names in small caps
% \item[lab-bf] cited names in bold face
% \item[lab-def] cited names in user defined font |\bibnamefont{}|.
% \item[and-rm] word `and' in cited names in normal font
% \item[xlab-it] extra label (letter after year) in italics
% \end{opt}
%
% \textbf{Block punctuation:} between logical sections (not mutually
% exclusive)
% \begin{opt}
% \item[--] default is period after each logical section, including end
% \item[blk-com] use commas, except at very end (changes \textsl{In} to
% \textsl{in})
% \item[blk-tit] like \texttt{blk-com} except period follows titles of
% articles and books
% \item[blk-tita] like \texttt{blk-com} except period follows article title
% \item[tit-col] with \texttt{blk-tit} or \texttt{blk-tita}, for colon instead of period
% \item[com-semi] with \texttt{blk-com}, uses semi-colon instead of comma
% \item[com-blank] with \texttt{blk-com}, uses blanks instead of comma
% \item[in-col] puts a colon after \textsl{In} or \textsl{in} for edited works
% \item[in-it] puts word \textsl{in} in italics (may be used with
% \texttt{in-col})
% \item[in-x] suppresses the word \textsl{in} for edited works
% \item[fin-bare] no punctuation at the very end
% \item[au-col] puts a colon after the author/editor block
% \item[blknt] puts period before note
% \end{opt}
%
% \textbf{Date:} if missing
%
% \begin{opt}
% \item[--] Missing date replaced by ???? (author--year)
% \item[blkyear] Missing date left blank, even in label.
% \end{opt}
%
% \textbf{Date:} position and enclosure
%
% \begin{opt}
% \item[--] default is date at end, before notes; for author--year,
% date consists only of year, no month
% \item[dt-jnl] date at end as for default, except for journal articles
% where it follows the journal name as part of specification
% \item[dt-end] date goes after any notes
% \item[dt-beg] date goes after authors' names
% \item[yr-par] date in parentheses ()
% \item[yr-brk] date in brackets []
% \item[yr-com] date preceded by comma and space
% \item[yr-col] date preceded by colon and space
% \item[yr-per] date preceded by period and space
% \item[yr-blk] date preceded by space
% \item[dtrev] date as year month instead of month year
% \item[dtbf] date bold face
% \item[aymth] include month even for author-year
% \item[xmth] suppress month for numerical mode
% \item[yrp-x] suppresses punctuation following month, year when date
% is just after authors
% \item[yrp-col] adds colon and space after date when just after authors
% \item[yrp-semi] adds semi-colon and space after date when just after authors
% \item[yrp-per] adds period and space after date
% \item[yrpp-xsp] removes blank following year punctuation
% \item[note-yr] permits text (like ``in press'') in the \texttt{year} field
% \end{opt}
%
% \textbf{Article in journal:} style of title, volume, pages
% \begin{opt}
% \item[--] default is: Title. \textit{Journal}, vol(num):p1--p2
% \item[injnl] adds word \textsl{in} before journal name, same style as
% for incollections
% \item[volp-sp] as above, but with a space, vol(num):~p1--p2
% \item[volp-semi] semi-colon instead of colon: vol(num);~p1--p2
% \item[volp-com] comma and space instead of colon: vol(num),~p1--p2
% \item[volp-blk] only space instead of colon: vol(num)~p1--p2
% \item[vol-bf] volume in bold
% \item[vol-it] volume in italics
% \item[vol-2bf] volume and number bold
% \item[vnum-x] no number for journals, only volume
% \item[vnum-sp] space between, as vol (num)
% \item[vnum-cm] replace vol(num) with vol, num
% \item[vnum-nr] replace vol(num) with vol, no. num
% \item[vnum-h] replace vol(num) with vol, \#num
% \item[vnum-b] replace vol(num) with vol num
% \item[jdt-v] year in parentheses attached to volume: vol(year) num
% \item[jdt-vs] as above, with space: vol (year) num
% \item[jdt-p] year precedes pages: vol(num), (year) p1--p2
% \item[jdt-pc] as above, with comma: vol(num), (year), p1--p2
% \item[jpg-1] only starting page given
% \item[pgsep-c] page numbers over 10,000 have comma
% \item[pgsep-s] page numbers over 10\,000 have space
% \item[pgsep-p] page numbers over 10.000 have period
% \item[jwdpg] include `page' or `pp' for articles
% \item[jwdvol] include `volume' or `vol' for articles
% \item[jnm-x] no punctuation after journal name
% \item[tit-it] article title in italics
% \item[tit-qq] article title in quotes
% \item[bt-rm] booktitle in upright font, not italic (this will be issued
% with \texttt{btit-rm} normally; separate options allow for
% more control if wanted
% \item[bt-qq] booktitle of incollection and inproceedings in quotes
% \item[qt-s] (with \texttt{tit-qq}) single instead of double quotes
% \item[qt-g] (with \texttt{tit-qq}) guillemets instead of quotes
% \item[qx] (with \texttt{tit-qq}) comma outside quotes
% \item[jtit-x] no article title (applies only to journals and
% collections)
% \item[atit-u] article title capitalized as in entry, default is
% sentence capitalization (first word and words following
% colons)
% \item[jxper] abbreviated journal names have periods removed, as
% `Phys Rev'
% \item[jttl-rm] name of journal not in italics
% \item[pp-last] pages appear at end, before any notes
% \end{opt}
%
% \textbf{Number and series:} for collections and inproceedings
%
% This is a confusing issue. The standard wants to print something like
% ``number 123 in Collected Works'', and issues a warning if there is a number
% without a series. However, for many such works, there is an identification
% number for the collection, such as ESA~SP-123. Giving this as the number
% without a series results in ``number ESA~SP-123'' and a warning. Setting the
% series to this code number produces desired results, but is illogical.
%
% Another problem is that this code number should often should appear just
% before the publisher name,
% whereas the standard places it elsewhere.
%
% \begin{opt}
% \item[--] default, number must have series, \textsl{number} is printed
% \item[num-xser] default behaviour if both number and series present, but if
% only number is there, it is printed without the word \textsl{number} and
% without a warning
% \item[numser] moves the number/series to just before the publisher/organization
% \item[ser-vol] for a book in a series with volume number, appears as ``\textit{Series-Name}, vol.~23''
% rather than ``vol.~23 of \textit{Series-Name}''
% \item[ser-ed] for incollection, inproceedings, the series and volume appear between
% the booktitle and the editors
% \end{opt}
%
%
% \textbf{Thesis title:} formatted like a book or article
% \begin{opt}
% \item[--] default is like a book title
% \item[thtit-a] titles of PhD and Master theses formatted like articles
% \item[thtit-x] no thesis title
% \end{opt}
%
% \textbf{Technical Report title:} formatted like book or article
% \begin{opt}
% \item[--] default is like an article title
% \item[trtit-b] titles of technical reports formatted like books
% \item[trnum-it] \textsl{technical report} and number italic
% \end{opt}
%
% \textbf{Books:} title font style, pages, and address location
% \begin{opt}
% \item[--] default is italicized
% \item[btit-rm] book title plain
% \item[bkpg-par] pages in books places in parentheses
% \item[bkpg-x] pages in books bare without word \textsl{pages}
% \item[add-pub] publisher's address before name, colon separated
% \item[pub-par] publisher and address in parentheses
% \item[pub-date] publisher with address and date in parentheses
% \item[pub-xc] with \texttt{pub-date}, suppresses comma before date
% \item[pub-xpar] with \texttt{pub-date} to suppress parentheses
% \item[pre-pub] publisher placed before chapter and page information
% \item[pre-edn] edition before publisher
% \item[pg-bk] add number of pages for books and booklets
% \item[pg-pre] with \texttt{pg-bk}, total pages comes before publisher
% \end{opt}
%
% \textbf{Abbreviations:} of various words, default is no abbreviations
% \begin{opt}
% \item[pp] abbreviate \textsl{page(s)} as \textsl{p.} and \textsl{pp.}
% \item[ppx] no word \textsl{page(s)} or abbreviation
% \item[ed] abbreviate \textsl{editor(s)} as \textsl{ed.} and
% \textsl{eds.}
% \item[ednx] abbreviates \textsl{edition} as \textsl{ed.} instead
% of \textsl{edn.}
% \item[abr] abbreviate \textsl{volume}, \textsl{edition},
% \textsl{technical report}, etc.
% \item[mth-bare] months abbreviated without dots
% \item[jabr] abbreviate names of prestored journals
% \item[ord] write edition numbers as 1st, 2nd, instead as words.
% \item[xedn] suppress conversion of editions (for English) to avoid
% overflowing some \btx\ installations
% \end{opt}
%
% \textbf{Editor:} alternative for \emph{in edited} book, inbook, or proceedings.
% \begin{opt}
% \item[--] ``in \emph{names}, editors, \emph{title}''
% \item[edpar] ``in \emph{names} (editors), \emph{title}''
% \item[edparc] ``in \emph{names}, (editors) \emph{title}''
% \item[edparxc] ``in \emph{names} (editors) \emph{title}''
% \item[bkedcap] capitalizes ``Editor''
% \end{opt}
%
% \textbf{Editor:} alternative for \emph{in edited} incollection or inproceedings.
% If none of these are selected, they are treated the same as an edited book.
% \begin{opt}
% \item[--] ``in \emph{names}, editors, \emph{title}''
% \item[edby] ``in \emph{title}, edited by \emph{names}''
% \item[edby-par] ``in \emph{title} (edited by \emph{names})''
% \item[edby-parc] ``in \emph{title}, (edited by \emph{names})''
% \item[edcap] (with \texttt{edby-par}) capitalizes ``Edited by'' or
% ``Editor''
% \item[edbyx] (with \texttt{edby} or \texttt{edby-par}) replaces text
% \textsl{edited by} by \textsl{editor(s)} before the names,
% \item[edbyw] same as \texttt{edbyx} but with word \textsl{editor} only in
% parentheses
% \item[edbyy] (with \texttt{edby} or \texttt{edby-par}) replaces text
% \textsl{edited by} by \textsl{editor(s)} after the names,
% as ``in \emph{title}, \emph{names}, editors''.
% \end{opt}
%
% \textbf{ISBN, ISSN numbers:} include or not
% \begin{opt}
% \item[--] default is no ISBN number, ignore this field,
% \item[isbn] include an ISBN number as optional entry for books, booklets,
% incollections, inproceedings
% \item[issn] include an ISSN number for periodicals
% \end{opt}
%
% \textbf{URL address:} include or not, and how
% \begin{opt}
% \item[--] ignore URL field,
% \item[url] process URL field,
% \item[url-blk] (with \texttt{url}) URL text as regular blocked item,
% \item[url-nt] URL text treated as a note
% \item[url-nl] URL text added as new line below reference (Harvard style)
% \end{opt}
%
% \textbf{DOI number:} include or not
% \begin{opt}
% \item[--] default is not to include the Digital Object Identifier
% \item[doi] include the DOI number
% \item[agu-doi] place DOI number AGU style, as part of page designation
%
% \end{opt}
%
% \textbf{REV\TeX\ data fields:} for use with \texttt{revtex.bst}.
% \begin{opt}
% \item[--] Do not include extra fields for REV\TeX
% \item[revdata] Include fields \texttt{collaboration}, \texttt{eid},
% \texttt{numpages} for REV\TeX.
% \end{opt}
%
% \textbf{Eprint field:} used by REV\TeX\ but can be used on its own.
% \begin{opt}
% \item[--] Do not include \texttt{eprint} and \texttt{archive} fields
% \item[eprint] Include \texttt{eprint} and \texttt{archive} fields.
% \end{opt}
%
% \textbf{Reference component tagging:} apply structure to the |\bibitem| contents.
% \begin{opt}
% \item[--] no tagging.
% \item[bibinfo] apply tags like |\bibinfo|, and |\eprint| to the fields of data
% in the content of the |\bibitem| statement.
% \end{opt}
%
% \textbf{Emphasis:} defines what `italicized' really means
% \begin{opt}
% \item[--] default is |\em| (can switch between |\it|
% and |\rm|
% \item[em-it] use |\it| instead (always italic)
% \item[em-x] no emphasis
% \item[em-ul] underline for emphasis (with or without \texttt{ulem})
% \end{opt}
%
% \textbf{Special punctuation:}
% \begin{opt}
% \item[amper] use \& in place of \textsl{and}
% \item[varand] use command |\BIBand| in place of \textsl{and}
% \item[and-xcom] no comma before last \textsl{and} of an author list
% (citations and references)
% \item[and-com] add comma before \textsl{and} even for two authors (in list of
% references)
% \item[and-com-ed] the same as \texttt{and-com} but for editors in
% collections
% \item[xand] no \textsl{and} in an author list (references)
% \item[etal-it] \textsl{et al.} in italics
% \item[etal-rm] \textsl{et al.} in roman even if authors in different font
% \end{opt}
%
% \textbf{Font commands:}
% \begin{opt}
% \item[--] use Plain \TeX\ (also \LaTeX~2.09) font commands
% \item[nfss] use |\textbf|, |\textit|, |\emph| in place of |\bf|, |\it|,
% and |\em|; only works then with \LaTeXe
% \end{opt}
%
% \textbf{Plain \TeX\ compatibility:}
% \begin{opt}
% \item[--] use \LaTeXe\ commands for testing, redefining commands
% \item[plntx] use \TeX\ for maximum compatibility
% \end{opt}
%
%
% \section{The Menu Information}\label{sec:menu}
% Here I describe the options and menu information for this particular
% master file \texttt{\filename}. To construct a \dtx{} driver file
% to generate a desired \texttt{.bst} file, simply process \texttt{makebst.tex}
% with \TeX\ or \LaTeX, and give
% \begin{quote}\tt\filename\end{quote}
% when prompted for the name of the master file. Then answer the questions
% in the menus that follow. The menu information is extracted from here.
%
% All the menu information is nested between \dtx{} guard options
% |%<*options>| \dots\ |%</options>|, and the last command is
% |\endoptions|. The rest of the file is nested between
% \begin{quote}
% |%<*!options&!driver&!bblbst>| \dots\ |</!options&!driver&!bblbst>|
% \end{quote}
% in order to exclude it if \dtx{} is used to
% extract the menu information, the documentation driver, or the
% \texttt{babelbst.tex} file.
%
% The main coding is divided into two sections, the \emph{head} and
% \emph{tail}; in between come any external language or journal name
% support files. The head part is marked with the \dtx{} guard option
% |<!tail>| and the tail with |<!head>|. This roundabout means of doing
% things makes it possible to process \texttt{\filename} with \texttt{.dbj}
% files that were generated for the older \texttt{genbst.mbs} file by
% simply changing the name of the source file as shown in
% Section~\ref{sec:update}. If both \texttt{head} and \texttt{tail} (and
% \texttt{exlang}) options are omitted, as they are in the older
% \texttt{.dbj} files, \texttt{\filename} is processed completely in one
% pass. To include external files, two passes are needed, one for each
% part, with the external file(s) coming in between.
%
% Note too that if the internal language commands are taken (i.e., if
% \texttt{exlang} option is not given) then the default language is
% English, which is tested for as |<!babel>|. This too permits the simple
% update of older \texttt{.dbj}, at least for English.
%
% \subsection*{Selecting Language}
% Explicit words in the bibliography style, such as \textsl{and},
% \textsl{editor}, etc.,
% are represented by functions \texttt{bbl.and}, \texttt{bbl.editor}, and so on.
% By default these functions translate to the normal English text, but
% other languages are also possible.
%
% The definitions of these functions for other languages are contained in
% external files. At this point, we can make use of features in
% \texttt{makebst} (version~3.0 or later) to ask for the name of such a
% definition file, and store it in |\cfile|. If no external file is
% specified, then the internal definitions are taken, for which there are
% two possibilities: English or \LaTeX{} commands (Babel).
%
% The commands |\MBswitch|, |\mes|, |\MBaskfile|, |\wr|, |\pc|, |\spsp| are
% defined in \texttt{makebst.tex}.
%
% If |\MBswitch| does not exist, then the version of \texttt{makebst}
% cannot support external files.
%
% \begin{macrocode}
%<*options>
\expandafter\ifx\csname beginoptiongroup\endcsname\relax
\mes{^^J******************^^J%
!!!!!! VERSION CLASH !!!!!!!!!^^J%
This mbs file requires makebst version 4.0 or more^^J%
You must update makebst to run it with this mbs file^^J%
No docstrip batch file can be produced on this run^^J%
******************}
\let\temp\endinput\else\let\temp\relax\fi\temp
\newif\ifnumerical
\newif\ifmytemp
\mes{<<< For more information about the meanings of^^J%
<<< the various options, see the section on ^^J%
<<< Menu Information in the .mbs file documentation.}
\umes{EXTERNAL FILES:}
\expandafter\ifx\csname MBswitch\endcsname\relax
\mes{^^J**************^^J%
Makebst version is less than 3.0^^J%
Cannot add external file for language definition^^J%
**************}
\umes{No included files.}%
\def\cfile{}\def\jfile{}%
\else
\MBaskfile{^^JName of language definition file}(\mroot.\mext)i\cfile
\edef\ctemp{\mroot.\mext}
\ifx\ctemp\cfile\def\cfile{}\fi
\umes{Name of language file: \string\cfile=\cfile.}%
% \end{macrocode}
%
% A second type of external file that can be added is one containing names
% of journals that are to be prestored into the \texttt{.bst} file.
% Several file names are allowed here, with the root names separated by
% commas, and with the common extension added at the end. To assist later
% parsing of the names, an additional comma is added before the extension.
%
% Note that in this case |\MBaskfile| treats the file(s) as output, i.e.,
% it does not check if the file(s) actually exist.
%
% The macro |\Mgetnext| allows the root names to be extracted from the
% list of file names.
% \begin{macrocode}
\def\jfile{}
\ask{\yn}{^^JInclude file(s) for extra journal names? (NO)}
\mytempfalse
\if!\yn!\else\if\yn n\else\if\yn N\else\mytemptrue\fi\fi\fi
\ifmytemp
\MBaskfile{^^JFile to include}(physjour,geojour,photjour.mbs)o\jfile
\edef\jfile{\froot,.\fext}
\umes{Name of included files: \string\jfile=\jfile.}%
\else
\umes{No included files.}%
\fi
\fi%MBswitch
\def\Mgetnext#1,#2.#3??{\def\froot{#1}\def\Mrest{#2}\def\fext{#3}}
% \end{macrocode}
%
% If no external files are specified, then both |\cfile| and |\jfile| are
% empty. In this case, do \emph{not} set the options \texttt{head} and
% \texttt{tail}, which control the \dtx{} passes through
% \texttt{filename}. Now only one pass is made.
%
% If there is an external definition file, or if an external list of
% journal names, then some extra text must be
% written to fit in with that already written by \texttt{makebst}. This is
% explained in that documentation. The |\MBswitch| command turns the curly
% braces |{..}| into normal characters, and the parentheses |(..)| take on
% their grouping functionality. This permits unbalances braces to be
% written to the output file.
%
% \begin{macrocode}
\if!\cfile\jfile!\else
\begingroup\MBswitch
\wr(\spsp head,\string\MBopta})
\if!\cfile!\else
\wr(\string\from{\cfile}{\string\MBopta})
\fi
\if!\jfile!\else
\let\jxfile\jfile
\loop
% \end{macrocode}
%
% Parse the list of journal name files, adding a new |\from| for each one.
%
% \begin{macrocode}
\expandafter\Mgetnext\jxfile??
\wr(\string\from{\froot.\fext}{\string\MBopta})
\edef\jxfile(\Mrest.\fext)
\if!\Mrest!\def\Mtst(1)\else\def\Mtst()\fi
\if!\Mtst!
\repeat
\fi
\wr(\string\from{\mroot.\mext}{tail,\string\MBopta}})
\wr(\string\def\string\MBopta{\pc)
\endgroup
\fi
% \end{macrocode}
%
% Ask whether
% explicit English words wanted or \LaTeX{} commands whose definitions are
% to be found in the file \texttt{babelbst.tex}.
%
% \begin{macrocode}
\beginoptiongroup{INTERNAL LANGUAGE SUPPORT
(if no external language file)}%
{\if!\cfile!\relax*\fi}%
\optdef{*}{}{English}{words used explicitly}
\optdef{b}{babel}{Babel}
{(words replaced by commands defined in babelbst.tex)}
\getans
\endoptiongroup
\if!\cfile!\relax\else
\wr{\spsp\spsp exlang,\pc: External language file}
\fi
% \end{macrocode}
%
% \subsection*{Author--year or numerical}
% The first question is whether a numerical or author--year citation style
% is to be used. If the latter, the supporting system is my {\tt
% natbib.sty}, which expects |\bibitem| to have an optional argument
% containing the short form of the authors, plus year in parentheses.
% E.g.,
% \begin{quote}
% |\bibitem[Daly et al.(1990)]{key}...|
% \end{quote}
% There is now a newer version of \texttt{natbib.sty} (v5.3) that
% supports an optional full author list too, as
% \begin{quote}
% |\bibitem[Daly et al.(1990)Daly, Keppler, and Williams]{key}...|
% \end{quote}
% Other systems are also supported, such as the Harvard family of
% bibliography styles (with \texttt{harvard.sty}), which have entries in the
% form
% \begin{quote}
% |\harvarditem[Daly et al.]{Daly, Keppler,|\\
% | and Williams}{1990}{key}...|
% \end{quote}
% or the astronomy family (with \texttt{astron.sty}) with entries like
% \begin{quote}
% |\bibitem[\protect\astroncite{Daly et al.}{1990}]{key}...|
% \end{quote}
% or the Chicago family (with \texttt{chicago.sty}) with entries like
% \begin{quote}
% |\bibitem[\protect\citeautheryear{Daly, Keppler, and|\\
% | Williams}{Daly et al.}{1990}]{key}...|
% \end{quote}
% or the `named' variant of Chicago (with \texttt{named.sty}) with entries like
% \begin{quote}
% |\bibitem[\protect\citeauthoryear{Daly et al.}{1990}]{key}...|
% \end{quote}
% or the so-called ``author--date'' group (with \texttt{authordate1-4.sty})
% with entries of the form
% \begin{quote}
% |\bibitem[\protect\citename{Daly et al.}1990]{key}...|
% \end{quote}
% Finally, there is the \texttt{apalike} format of Oren Patashnik, for use
% with \texttt{apalike.sty} that has entries of the form
% \begin{quote}
% |\bibitem[Daly et al., 1990]{key}...|
% \end{quote}
%
% In addition to numerical or author--year citation styles, there is also a
% \texttt{cite} style available in which the label is the same as the cite
% key. This is for listing entire contents of databases with the cite key
% visible.
%
% A flag |\ifnumerical| is established because some of the following menu
% features depend on which system is to be used.
%
% The \texttt{alph} option produces labels as in \texttt{alpha.bst}; options
% \texttt{alf-1} and \texttt{alf-f} modify these. Standard is: first three
% letters of the single author (Dal90 for Daly, 1990) and first letters of
% first three authors (DK90 for Daly and Kopka, 1990). Alternatives are first
% three letters of the first author, no matter how many authors there are, and
% full name of first author.
% \begin{macrocode}
\beginoptiongroup{STYLE OF CITATIONS:}{}
\optdef{*}{}{Numerical}{as in standard LaTeX}
\optdef{a}{ay}{Author-year}{with some non-standard interface}
\optdef{b}{alph}{Alpha style, Jon90 or JWB90}{for single or multiple authors}
\optdef{o}{alph,alf-1}{Alpha style, Jon90}{even for multiple authors}
\optdef{f}{alph,alf-f}{Alpha style, Jones90}{(full name of first author)}
\optdef{c}{cite}{Cite key}{(special for listing contents of bib file)}
\getans
\endoptiongroup
\if\ans a\numericalfalse\else\numericaltrue\fi
\if\ans b\mytempfalse \else\mytemptrue \fi
\beginoptiongroup{HTML OUTPUT
(if non author-year citations)}
{\ifnumerical*\fi}
\optdef{*}{}{Normal LaTeX}{output}
\optdef{h}{html}{Hypertext}{output, in HTML code, in paragraphs}
\optdef{n}{html,htlist}{Hypertext list}{with sequence numbers}
\optdef{k}{html,htdes}{Hypertext with keys}{for viewing databases}
\getans
\endoptiongroup
\beginoptiongroup{AUTHOR--YEAR SUPPORT SYSTEM
(if author-year citations)}
{\ifnumerical\else*\fi}
\optdef{*}{nat}{Natbib}{for use with natbib v5.3 or later}
\optdef{o}{}{Older Natbib}{without full authors citations}
\optdef{l}{alk}{Apalike}{for use with apalike.sty}
\optdef{h}{har}{Harvard}{system with harvard.sty}
\optdef{a}{ast}{Astronomy}{system with astron.sty}
\optdef{c}{cay}{Chicago}{system with chicago.sty}
\optdef{n}{nmd}{Named}{system with named.sty}
\optdef{d}{cn}{Author-date}{system with authordate1-4.sty}
\getans
% \end{macrocode}
% The \texttt{harvard} family has been extended for \LaTeXe, and the new
% \texttt{.bst} files allow the word \textsl{and} and the brackets around years
% to be variable with commands. These features may be added too.
% The URL field used to be exclusively part of Harvard, but now exists
% independently of it too.
%
% \begin{macrocode}
\beginoptiongroup{HARVARD EXTENSIONS INCLUDED
(if Harvard support selected)}
{\if\ans h*\fi}%
\optdef{*}{harnm}{With Harvard extensions}{for LaTeX2e version of harvard.sty}
\optdef{n}{}{Older Harvard}{style, for LaTeX 2.09}
\getans
\endoptiongroup
\endoptiongroup
% \end{macrocode}
%
% \subsection*{Language switching}
% A \texttt{language} field can be present to specify the original language of
% the reference; with \verb!\setlanguge!, the hyphenation patterns are set for
% setting the title in that language.
% \begin{macrocode}
\beginoptiongroup{LANGUAGE FIELD}{}
\optdef{*}{}{No language field}{}
\optdef{l}{lang}{Add language field}{to switch hyphenation patterns temporarily}
\getans
\endoptiongroup
% \end{macrocode}
%
% \subsection*{Annotations}
% Annotations to a reference are additional information not normally printed
% out in the list of references. They are used for listing databases.
% The coding here was offered by Soren Dayton.
% \begin{macrocode}
\beginoptiongroup{ANNOTATIONS:}{}
\optdef{*}{}{No annotations}{will be recognized}
\optdef{a}{annote}{Annotations}{in annote field or in .tex file of citekey name}
\getans
\endoptiongroup
% \end{macrocode}
%
% \subsection*{Ordering of the listed references}
% Choices here depend on citation style. The default in both cases is
% alphabetical order of all authors. For numerical style, one may also
% choose an unsorted order, which means the order is the same as the original
% citations. This corresponds to \texttt{unsrt.bst}. Order of citation is
% also offered for author--year for \texttt{natbib}-type styles that can
% also be used for numerical listings.
%
% Another possibility is to order first by year, then authors. This too only
% makes sense for numerical citations. However, it is offered for author--year
% in the event that a \texttt{natbib}-type style is used for numerical
% listings.
%
% For the alpha style, the ordering is by label only, so no option is
% offered here (|\ifnumerical| is \meta{true} and |\ifmytemp| is \meta{false}).
%
% For author--year, the second choice is by label. (The label is the
% optional |\bibitem| argument, and is what is printed in place of the
% |\cite| command.) With this option, all the papers with the same first
% author are ordered so that the one-author papers come first, followed by
% the two-author papers, followed by the multiple-author papers. This is a
% more sensible system for author--year citations, and is demanded by some
% journals (like JGR).
%
% One problem that can arise here is when two or more references have the
% same set of authors and year; normally they are then ordered by the
% title, ignoring initial words like \textsl{the} and \textsl{a}, with the
% letters a, b,
% c, \dots, added to the year. This can mean that a set of references with
% a natural sequence will be put into a different order. An alternative is
% to order them by the citation keyword instead of by title. This of course
% assumes that the keywords in this case reflect that natural sequence.
% \begin{macrocode}
\let\ans\relax
\beginoptiongroup{ORDERING OF REFERENCES
(if non-author/year and non-alph)}
{\ifnumerical\ifmytemp*\fi\fi}%
\optdef{*}{}{Alphabetical}{by all authors}
\optdef{c}{seq-no}{Citation order}{(unsorted, like unsrt.bst)}
\optdef{d}{seq-yr}{Year ordered}{and then by authors}
\optdef{r}{seq-yrr}{Reverse year ordered}{and then by authors}
\getans
\endoptiongroup
%
\beginoptiongroup{ORDERING OF REFERENCES
(if author-year citations)}
{\ifnumerical\else*\fi}%
\optdef{*}{}{Alphabetical}{by all authors}
\optdef{l}{seq-lab}{By label}%
{(Jones before Jones and James before Jones et al)}
\optdef{k}{seq-key}{By label and cite key}{instead of label and title, as above}
\optdef{d}{seq-yr}{Year ordered}{and then by authors (for publication lists)}
\optdef{r}{seq-yrr}{Reverse year ordered}{and then by authors (most recent first)}
\optdef{c}{seq-no}{Citation order}{(unsorted, only meaningful for numericals)}
\getans
\endoptiongroup
% \end{macrocode}
% The standard \btx\ styles consider the \emph{von} part of the name to be a
% fixed part of the surname. European usage tends to alphabetize ignoring these
% honorifics.
% \begin{macrocode}
\beginoptiongroup{ORDER ON VON PART
(if not citation order)}
{\if\ans c\else*\fi}%
\optdef{*}{}{Sort on von part}{(de la Maire before Defoe)}
\optdef{x}{vonx}{Sort without von part}{(de la Maire after Mahone)}
\getans
\endoptiongroup
% \end{macrocode}
%
% \subsection*{Formatting author names}
% The default is that the full names of the authors are listed, given names
% first, unabbreviated. Of course, if only the initials have been given in
% the \texttt{.bib} file, then that is all that can appear in the list. Other
% possibilities are to use initials (even if full names in the \texttt{.bib}
% file) either before or after the surnames. A specialty of the journals of
% the American Geophysical Union is to have only the first name with
% reversed initials.
%
% If the reference is part of a larger work with editors, then the editor
% names appear later in the reference text, usually as ``edited by \dots''
% or as ``\emph{names} (editors)''. In these cases, the editor names are
% not usually reversed (surname first) even if the authors' names are.
% An option is provided to format such editor names exactly as the authors'.
% \begin{macrocode}
\beginoptiongroup{AUTHOR NAMES:}{}
\optdef{*}{ed-au}{Full, surname last}{(John Frederick Smith)}
\optdef{f}{nm-revf}{Full, surname first}{(Smith, John Frederick)}
\optdef{i}{nm-init,ed-au}{Initials + surname}{(J. F. Smith)}
\optdef{r}{nm-rev}{Surname + initials}{(Smith, J. F.)}
\optdef{s}{nm-rv}{Surname + dotless initials}{(Smith J F)}
\optdef{x}{nm-rvx}{Surname + pure initials}{(Smith JF)}
\optdef{y}{nm-rvcx}{Surname + comma + pure initials}{(Smith, JF)}
\optdef{z}{nm-rvv}{Surname + spaceless initials}{(Smith J.F.)}
\optdef{a}{nm-rev1}{Only first name reversed, initials}%
{(AGU style: Smith, J. F., H. K. Jones)}
\optdef{b}{nm-revv1}{First name reversed, with full names}%
{(Smith, John Fred, Harry Kab Jones)}
\getans
\endoptiongroup
\mytempfalse
\if\ans f\mytemptrue\fi
\if\ans r\mytemptrue\fi
\if\ans s\mytemptrue\fi
\if\ans x\mytemptrue\fi
\if\ans y\mytemptrue\fi
\if\ans a\mytemptrue\fi
\if\ans b\mytemptrue\fi
\beginoptiongroup{EDITOR NAMES IN COLLECTIONS
(if author names reversed)}
{\ifmytemp*\fi}
\if\ans r
\optdef{*}{}{Editor names NOT reversed}{as edited by J. J. Smith}
\fi
\if\ans s
\optdef{*}{}{Editor names NOT reversed}{as edited by J J Smith}
\fi
\if\ans a
\optdef{*}{}{Editor names NOT reversed}{as edited by J. J. Smith}
\fi
\if\ans x
\optdef{*}{}{Editor names NOT reversed}{as edited by JJ Smith}
\fi
\if\ans f
\optdef{*}{}{Editor names NOT reversed}{as edited by John James Smith}
\fi
\if\ans y
\optdef{*}{}{Editor names NOT reversed}{as edited by J.J. Smith}
\fi
\if\ans b
\optdef{*}{}{Editor names NOT reversed}{as edited by John James Smith}
\fi
\optdef{r}{ed-rev}{Editor names reversed}{just like authors'}
\getans
\beginoptiongroup{POSITION OF JUNIOR
(if author names reversed)}
{}
\optdef{*}{jnrlst}{Junior comes last}{as Smith, John, Jr.}
\optdef{m}{}{Junior between}{as Smith, Jr., John}
\getans
\endoptiongroup
\endoptiongroup
\beginoptiongroup{JUNIOR PART IN THE CITATION
(if author-year citations)}
{\ifnumerical\else*\fi}%
\optdef{*}{}{No `junior' part in the citations}{but in the ref listing}
\optdef{j}{jnrlab}{`Junior' in citations}{as well as in ref listing}
\getans
\endoptiongroup
\beginoptiongroup{PUNCTUATION BETWEEN AUTHOR NAMES:}{}
\optdef{*}{}{Author names separated by commas}{}
\optdef{s}{aunm-semi}{Names separated by semi-colon}{}
\optdef{h}{aunm-sl}{Names separated by slash}{/}
\getans
\endoptiongroup
\beginoptiongroup{ADJACENT REFERENCES WITH REPEATED NAMES:}{}
\optdef{*}{}{Author/editor names always present}{}
\optdef{d}{nmdash}{Repeated author/editor names replaced by dash}{}
\optdef{2}{nmdash,nmd-2}{Repeated author/editor names replaced by 2 dashes}{}
\optdef{3}{nmdash,nmd-3}{Repeated author/editor names replaced by 3 dashes}{}
\getans
\endoptiongroup
% \end{macrocode}
%
% \subsection*{Number of authors}
% Normally the complete list of authors as given in the \texttt{.bib} file is
% presented in the reference list. However, some journals prefer to limit
% them to a maximum. If there are more than this maximum number of author
% names, then a minimum number plus \textsl{et al.} are listed.
%
% Because no test for consistency of the numbers is carried out in the
% \texttt{.bst} file itself (it might be possible, but I found it too complex),
% this is done here.
% \begin{macrocode}
\beginoptiongroup{NUMBER OF AUTHORS:}{}
\optdef{*}{}{All authors}{included in listing}
\optdef{l}{nmlm}{Limited authors}{(et al replaces missing names)}
\getans
\endoptiongroup
\if\ans l
\loop
\ask{\num}{Maximum number of authors (1-99)}
\ifnum\num>99\relax
\mes{*** Must be between 1 and 99}
\repeat
\def\parsenum#1#2{\if#2\relax\wr{\spsp\spsp x#1,\pc: Maximum of #1\space authors}
\else\wr{\spsp\spsp x#10,x#2,\pc: Maximum of #1#2\space authors}\fi}
\expandafter\parsenum\num\relax
\mes{\spsp You have selected maximum \num\space authors}
\edef\numx{\num}
\loop
\ask{\num}{Minimum number (before et al given) (1-\numx)}
\ifnum\num>\numx
\mes{*** Must be between 1 and \numx}
\repeat
\def\parsenum#1#2{\if#2\relax\wr{\spsp\spsp m#1,\pc: Minimum of #1\space authors}
\else\wr{\spsp\spsp m#10,m#2,\pc: Minimum of #1#2\space authors}\fi}
\expandafter\parsenum\num\relax
\mes{\spsp You have selected minimum \num\space authors}
\fi
% \end{macrocode}
%
% \subsection*{Typeface of names}
% The author names in the list of references normally appear in the current
% typeface. This may be changed to small caps, bold, or italics.
%
% Alternatively, the surnames only can be formatted, with the first names in the
% regular font. One can also specify that the words `and' and `et~al.'\ should be
% in the regular font, or that `et~al.'\ be italic.
%
% Another possibility is that the names be put into a command |\bibnamefont{..}|,
% which must be defined in the \LaTeX\ document. By default, this command does
% not format its argument. There is also a |\bibfnamefont| command for the first
% names, to be user-defined.
%
% Editor names in a collection or in a book will not normally have these
% fonts applied to them; this may be additionally selected.
%
% \begin{macrocode}
\beginoptiongroup{TYPEFACE FOR AUTHORS IN LIST OF REFERENCES:}{}
\optdef{*}{}{Normal font for author names}{}
\optdef{s}{nmft,nmft-sc}{Small caps authors}{(\string\sc)}
\optdef{i}{nmft,nmft-it}{Italic authors}{(\string\it\space or \string\em)}
\optdef{b}{nmft,nmft-bf}{Bold authors}{(\string\bf)}
\optdef{u}{nmft,nmft-def}{User defined author font}{(\string\bibnamefont)}
\getans
\endoptiongroup
\mytempfalse
\if\ans i\mytemptrue\fi
\if\ans s\mytemptrue\fi
\if\ans b\mytemptrue\fi
\if\ans u\mytemptrue\fi
\beginoptiongroup{FONT FOR FIRST NAMES
(if non-default font for authors)}
{\ifmytemp*\fi}%
\optdef{*}{}{First names same font as surnames}{}
\optdef{r}{fnm-rm}{First names in normal font}{}
\optdef{u}{fnm-def}{First names in user defined font}{(\string\bibfnamefont)}
\getans
\beginoptiongroup{EDITOR NAMES IN INCOLLECTION ETC:}{}
\optdef{*}{}{Editors incollection normal font}{}
\optdef{a}{nmfted}{Editors incollection like authors}{font}
\getans
\endoptiongroup
\beginoptiongroup{FONT FOR `AND' IN LIST:}{}
\optdef{*}{}{`And' in author font}{(JONES AND JAMES)}
\optdef{r}{nmand-rm}{`And' in normal font}{(JONES and JAMES)}
\getans
\endoptiongroup
\endoptiongroup
% \end{macrocode}
%
% \subsection*{Names in Citation label}
% This applies to author--year style only. The label is the text written
% by the |\cite| command, and for author--year style, this is something like
% `Daly et al.\ (1990b)'. One may select italics for the authors and for the
% extra label attached to the year. The year always remains plain.
%
% This parallels the font selection for the names in the list of references
% except that there no choice for the first names, since only surnames
% are used in the labels. A user-defined |\citefontname| may also
% be selected, but this \emph{must} be defined by the user since there
% will be no default definition for it.
%
% If a font is selected for the cited authors, then the word `and' may be
% optionally put in the normal font.
%
% It is not possible to select the type of brackets for the year, since
% this is determined by the \LaTeX{} style option that manages the
% author--year citations. This is not standard \LaTeX, so that there are a
% number of private style files for achieving this.
% \begin{macrocode}
\beginoptiongroup{FONT OF CITATION LABELS IN TEXT
(if author-year citations)}
{\ifnumerical\else*\fi}%
\optdef{*}{}{Cited authors plain}{as result of \string\cite\space command}
\optdef{i}{lab,lab-it}{Cited authors italic}{}
\optdef{s}{lab,lab-sc}{Cited authors small caps}{}
\optdef{b}{lab,lab-bf}{Cited authors bold}{}
\optdef{u}{lab,lab-def}{User defined citation font}{(\string\citenamefont)}
\getans
\mytempfalse
\if\ans i\mytemptrue\fi
\if\ans s\mytemptrue\fi
\if\ans b\mytemptrue\fi
\if\ans u\mytemptrue\fi
\beginoptiongroup{FONT FOR `AND' IN CITATIONS
(if non-default font for citation lables)}
{\ifmytemp*\fi}%
\optdef{*}{}{Cited `and' in author font}{}
\optdef{r}{and-rm}{Cited `and' in normal font}{}
\getans
\endoptiongroup
\beginoptiongroup{FONT OF EXTRA LABEL
(The extra letter on the year)}{}
\optdef{*}{}{Extra label plain}{}
\optdef{i}{xlab-it}{Extra label italic}{}
\getans
\endoptiongroup
\endoptiongroup
% \end{macrocode}
%
% \subsection*{Label for missing author names}
%
% If the author and/or editor is missing, the standard \texttt{.bst} files
% use the \texttt{key} field in place of the names for purposes of ordering the
% entries.
%
% For author--year styles, the \texttt{key} field is even inserted in the
% reference list and in the label in place of the authors. Optionally, one can
% suppress the year in this case, which causes \texttt{natbib} (version~7)
% to print only that key text as a code designation for the work. Thus if
% \texttt{KEY = "CS1-345"} and there are no authors, then |\citep| produces
% (CS1-345) and |\citet| simply CS1-345. That is, they behave like
% |\citeauthor|. If \texttt{natbib} did not recognize the blank year, one would
% get (CS1-345, ) and CS1-345 (). (Earlier versions of \texttt{natbib} crash on
% a blank year.)
% \begin{macrocode}
\beginoptiongroup{LABEL WHEN AUTHORS MISSING
(if author-year citations)}
{\ifnumerical\else*\fi}%
\optdef{*}{keyxyr}{Year blank when KEY replaces missing author}{(for natbib 7.0)}
\optdef{y}{}{Year included when KEY replaces missing author}{}
\getans
\endoptiongroup
% \end{macrocode}
%
% \subsection*{Missing date}
% A missing date can be set to ???? or simply left blank. In the latter case,
% \texttt{natbib} version~7 will print only the authors without any year
% punctuation or brackets.
%
% \begin{macrocode}
\beginoptiongroup{MISSING DATE
(if author-year citations)}
{\ifnumerical\else*\fi}%
\optdef{*}{}{Missing date set to ????}{in label and text}
\optdef{b}{blkyear}{Missing date left blank}{}
\getans
\endoptiongroup
% \end{macrocode}
%
% \subsection*{Position of date}
% This applies to author--year style only. It makes sense to put the date
% immediately after the author list, since the two items (author and year)
% are the identifiers of the reference. Default position is at the
% end of the references, before any notes. It is also possible to place
% it even after the notes.
%
% Medical journals have a system where the date is part of the journal
% specification, as Lancet 1994;45(2):34--40. Otherwise the date appears at
% the end.
% \begin{macrocode}
\beginoptiongroup{DATE POSITION:}{}
\optdef{*}{}{Date at end}{}
\optdef{b}{dt-beg}{Date after authors}{}
\optdef{j}{dt-jnl}{Date part of journal spec.}{(as 1994;45:34-40) else at end}
\optdef{e}{dt-end}{Date at very end}{after any notes}
\getans
\endoptiongroup
\if\ans b\mytemptrue\else\if\ans j\mytemptrue\else\mytempfalse\fi\fi
% \end{macrocode}
%
% \subsection*{Format of date}
% The year may be enclosed in parentheses, brackets, or preceded by a
% colon. If none of these are selected, the date (month plus year) appears.
% For author--year, the date normally consists only of the year, no month,
% but this may be overridden.
%
% If the date comes just after the authors, then one might want special
% punctuation following it, like a colon, or space only. The latter is
% probably desirable if the date is brackets or parentheses.
%
% The date can even be put into bold face.
% \begin{macrocode}
\beginoptiongroup{DATE FORMAT
(if non author-year citations)}
{\ifnumerical*\fi}%
\optdef{*}{}{Plain month and year}{without any brackets}
\optdef{p}{yr-par}{Date in parentheses}{as (May 1993)}
\optdef{b}{yr-brk}{Date in brackets}{as [May 1993]}
\optdef{c}{yr-col}{Date preceded by colon}{as `: May 1993'}
\optdef{d}{yr-per}{Date preceded by period}{as `. May 1993'}
\optdef{m}{yr-com}{Date preceded by comma}{as `, May 1993'}
\optdef{s}{yr-blk}{Date preceded by space}{only, as ` May 1993'}
\getans
\beginoptiongroup{SUPPRESS MONTH:}{}
\optdef{*}{}{Date is month and year}{}
\optdef{x}{xmth}{Date is year only}{}
\getans
\endoptiongroup
\beginoptiongroup{REVERSED DATE
(if including month)}
{\if\ans x\else*\fi}%
\optdef{*}{}{Date as month year}{}
\optdef{r}{dtrev}{Date as year month}{}
\getans
\endoptiongroup
\endoptiongroup
\beginoptiongroup{DATE FORMAT
(if author-year citations)}
{\ifnumerical\else*\fi}%
\optdef{*}{}{Year plain}{without any brackets}
\optdef{p}{yr-par}{Year in parentheses}{as (1993)}
\optdef{b}{yr-brk}{Year in brackets}{as [1993]}
\optdef{c}{yr-col}{Year preceded by colon}{as `: 1993'}
\optdef{d}{yr-per}{Year preceded by period}{as `. 1993'}
\optdef{m}{yr-com}{Date preceded by comma}{as `, 1993'}
\optdef{s}{yr-blk}{Year preceded by space}{only, as ` 1993'}
\getans
\beginoptiongroup{INCLUDE MONTHS:}{}
\optdef{*}{}{Date is year only}{without the month}
\optdef{m}{aymth}{Include month in date}{}
\getans
\endoptiongroup
\beginoptiongroup{REVERSED DATE
(if including month)}
{\if\ans m*\fi}%
\optdef{*}{}{Date as month year}{}
\optdef{r}{dtrev}{Date as year month}{}
\getans
\endoptiongroup
\endoptiongroup
\beginoptiongroup{DATE PUNCTUATION
(if date not at end)}
{\ifmytemp*\fi}%
\optdef{*}{}{Date with standard block punctuation}{(comma or period)}
\optdef{c}{yrp-col}{Colon after date}{as 1994:}
\optdef{s}{yrp-semi}{Semi-colon after date}{as 1994;}
\optdef{p}{yrp-per}{Period after date}{even when blocks use commas}
\optdef{x}{yrp-x}{No punct. after date}{}
\getans
\beginoptiongroup{BLANK AFTER DATE:}{}
\optdef{*}{}{Space after date}{and punctuation}
\optdef{x}{yrpp-xsp}{No space after date}{as 1994:45}
\getans
\endoptiongroup
\endoptiongroup
\beginoptiongroup{DATE FONT:}{}
\optdef{*}{}{Date in normal font}{}
\optdef{b}{dtbf}{Date in bold face}{}
\getans
\endoptiongroup
% \end{macrocode}
%
% Normally in author--year citations, the \texttt{year} entry is truncated
% to the last 4 characters, which should be the 4 digits of the year. Some
% users have requested the possibility of suppressing this truncation so
% that they may put text in the \texttt{year} field, such as ``in press.''
% Another use for it is when years are given as ``1968--72''. Actually,
% I have no idea why the year should be truncated at all.
% \begin{macrocode}
\beginoptiongroup{TRUNCATE YEAR
(if author-year citations)}
{\ifnumerical\else*\fi}%
\optdef{*}{note-yr}{Year text full}{as 1990--1993 or `in press'}
\optdef{t}{}{Year truncated}{to last 4 digits}
\getans
\endoptiongroup
% \end{macrocode}
%
% \subsection*{Article title in journal}
% The title of an article in a journal or in a collection (a book, or
% conference proceedings) may appear plain, in italics, within single
% or double quotes or even in guillemets. The last is best with T1 coding; a
% poor man's version for OT1 is provided; \LaTeXe\ is required in both cases.
%
% Furthermore, it may have sentence capitalization (first
% word and word following colon) or be capitalized as in the \texttt{.bib} file
% entry. That is why it is recommended to capitalize the entry text as it
% should appear when fully capitalized, putting words that are always
% capitalized in braces. Example:
% \begin{quote}
% |TITLE="The Results of the {Giotto} Mission"|
% \end{quote}
% which produces either ``The results of the Giotto mission'' or ``The
% Results of the Giotto Mission'', depending on option.
%
% Additionally, the article titles may be fully suppressed.
% \begin{macrocode}
\beginoptiongroup{TITLE OF ARTICLE:}{}
\optdef{*}{}{Title plain}{with no special font}
\optdef{i}{tit-it}{Title italic}{(\string\em)}
\optdef{q}{tit-qq,qt-s}{Title and punctuation in single quotes}{(`Title,' ..)}
\optdef{d}{tit-qq}{Title and punctuation in double quotes}{(``Title,'' ..)}
\optdef{g}{tit-qq,qt-g}{Title and punctuation in guillemets}{(<<Title,>> ..)}
\optdef{x}{tit-qq,qt-s,qx}{Title in single quotes}{(`Title', ..)}
\optdef{y}{tit-qq,qx}{Title in double quotes}{(``Title'', ..)}
\optdef{z}{tit-qq,qt-g,qx}{Title in guillemets}{(<<Title>>, ..)}
\getans
\endoptiongroup
\mytempfalse
\if\ans q\mytemptrue\fi
\if\ans d\mytemptrue\fi
\if\ans g\mytemptrue\fi
\if\ans x\mytemptrue\fi
\if\ans y\mytemptrue\fi
\if\ans z\mytemptrue\fi
\beginoptiongroup{COLLECTION/PROCEEDINGS TITLES
(if quoted title)}
{\ifmytemp*\fi}%
\optdef{*}{bt-qq}{Quote collection and proceedings titles}{too}
\optdef{x}{}{Collection and proceedings titles not in quotes}{}
\getans
\endoptiongroup
\beginoptiongroup{CAPITALIZATION OF ARTICLE TITLE:}{}
\optdef{*}{}{Sentence style}{(capitalize first word and those in braces)}
\optdef{t}{atit-u}{Title style}{(just as in bib entry)}
\getans
\endoptiongroup
\beginoptiongroup{ARTICLE TITLE PRESENT:}{}
\optdef{*}{}{Article title present}{in journals and proceedings}
\optdef{x}{jtit-x}{No article title}{}
\getans
\endoptiongroup
% \end{macrocode}
%
% \subsection*{Journal names}
% Abbreviated journal names normally contain periods; the periods may be
% removed with this option. In fact, only letters, numbers, and spacing are
% retained.
% \begin{macrocode}
\beginoptiongroup{JOURNAL NAMES:}{}
\optdef{*}{}{Periods in journal names}{are retained, as `Phys. Rev.'}
\optdef{x}{jxper}{Dotless journal names}{as `Phys Rev'}
\getans
\endoptiongroup
% \end{macrocode}
% Journal name is normally printed in italics; can be left in normal font.
% \begin{macrocode}
\beginoptiongroup{JOURNAL NAME FONT:}{}
\optdef{*}{}{Journal name italics}{}
\optdef{r}{jttl-rm}{Journal name normal}{font}
\getans
\endoptiongroup
% \end{macrocode}
%
% \subsection*{Title of Theses and Technical Reports}
% The title of a these (PhD or Master's) is normally treated the same
% as that of a book. Optionally, it may be formatted like that of
% an article.
%
% The title of a technical report is normally treated the same as that
% of an article. Optionally, it may be formatted like that of a book.
%
% \begin{macrocode}
\beginoptiongroup{THESIS TITLE:}{}
\optdef{*}{}{Thesis titles like books}{}
\optdef{a}{thtit-a}{Thesis title like article}{}
\optdef{x}{thtit-x}{No thesis title}{}
\getans
\endoptiongroup
\beginoptiongroup{TECHNICAL REPORT TITLE:}{}
\optdef{*}{}{Tech. report title like articles}{}
\optdef{b}{trtit-b}{Tech. report title like books}{}
\getans
\endoptiongroup
\beginoptiongroup{TECHNICAL REPORT NUMBER:}{}
\optdef{*}{}{Tech. report and number plain}{as `Tech. Rep. 123'}
\optdef{i}{trnum-it}{Tech. report and number italic}%
{as `{\string\it\space Tech. Rep. 123'}}
\getans
\endoptiongroup
% \end{macrocode}
%
% \subsection*{Journal reference}
% Great diversity of opinion exists as to how a journal reference is to be
% formatted. It consists of a volume, possibly a number, and page limits.
% The number is really only necessary if the page numbers within one volume
% start at 1 for each physical `number'. Since journals are often bound
% together in one volume later, it makes more sense to number the pages
% continuously through the whole volume.
%
% I am only aware of one journal that used to reset the pagination for each
% `number', in which case the number was part of the page designation.
% I had erroneously provided an option \texttt{vnum-pg} to achieve this, but I
% now realize that instead, for this one journal, the database entries must
% contain \texttt{pages="(2)33--2(55)"}. This option has been removed at
% version 3.84.
%
% A number of styles for journal specifications are
% \begin{quote}
% \begin{tabular}{l@{\qquad}l}
% 21(2):33--55 & 21, no.\ 2: 33--55\\
% \textbf{21}(2):33--55 & \textbf{21}, \#2, 33--55\\
% \textit{21}(2), 33--55 & \textit{21} (2); 33--55 \\
% 21(2) (1995) 33--55 & 21(1995), 33-55\\
% 21(2) 33--55 & vol.~21 (2), pp.~33--55
% \end{tabular}
% \end{quote}
%
% Here both start and stop page numbers have been given; often only the
% start page is wanted.
%
% It is also possible to include the year as part of the journal specification,
% in which case the year is always in parentheses, attached snugly or with space
% to the volume, or preceding the pages.
%
% \begin{macrocode}
\beginoptiongroup{JOURNAL VOLUME:}{}
\optdef{*}{}{Volume plain}{as vol(num)}
\optdef{i}{vol-it}{Volume italic}{as {\string\em\space vol}(num)}
\optdef{b}{vol-bf}{Volume bold}{as {\string\bf\space vol}(num)}
\optdef{d}{vol-2bf}{Volume and number bold}{as {\string\bf\space vol(num)}}
\getans
\endoptiongroup
% \end{macrocode}
%
% The form of the `number' is also given: in parentheses, with `no.',
% with \#, or omitted. The \texttt{vnum-b} option is meant to be used
% with \texttt{jdt-v} and \texttt{jdt-vs} but could be used alone.
% \begin{macrocode}
\beginoptiongroup{JOURNAL VOL AND NUMBER:}{}
\optdef{*}{}{Journal vol(num)}{as 34(2)}
\optdef{s}{vnum-sp}{Journal vol (num)}{as 34 (2)}
\optdef{c}{vnum-cm}{Journal vol, num}{as 34, 2}
\optdef{n}{vnum-nr}{Journal vol, no. num}{as 34, no. 2}
\optdef{h}{vnum-h}{Journal vol, \string\# number}{as 34, \string\#2}
\optdef{b}{vnum-b}{Journal vol number}{as 34 2}
\optdef{x}{vnum-x}{Journal vol, without number}{as 34}
\getans
\endoptiongroup
\beginoptiongroup{VOLUME PUNCTUATION:}{}
\optdef{*}{}{Volume with colon}{as vol(num):ppp}
\optdef{s}{volp-sp}{Volume with colon and space}{as vol(num): ppp}
\optdef{h}{volp-semi}{Volume with semi-colon}{as vol(num); ppp}
\optdef{c}{volp-com}{Volume with comma}{as vol(num), ppp}
\optdef{b}{volp-blk}{Volume with blank}{as vol(num) ppp}
\getans
\endoptiongroup
\beginoptiongroup{YEAR IN JOURNAL SPECIFICATION:}{}
\optdef{*}{}{Journal year like others}{as given by date position}
\optdef{v}{jdt-v}{Journal vol(year)}{as 34(1995)}
\optdef{s}{jdt-vs}{Journal vol (year)}{as 34 (1995)}
\optdef{p}{jdt-p}{Year with pages}{as 34(2), (1995) 1345--1387}
\optdef{c}{jdt-pc}{Year, comma, pages}{as 34(2), (1995), 1345--1387}
\getans
\endoptiongroup
\beginoptiongroup{PAGE NUMBERS:}{}
\optdef{*}{}{Start and stop page numbers}{given}
\optdef{f}{jpg-1}{Only start page number}{}
\getans
\endoptiongroup
\beginoptiongroup{LARGE PAGE NUMBERS:}{}
\optdef{*}{}{No separators for large page numbers}{}
\optdef{c}{pgsep-c}{Comma inserted over 9999}{as 11,234}
\optdef{s}{pgsep-s}{Thin space inserted over 9999}{as 11 234}
\optdef{p}{pgsep-p}{Period inserted over 9999}{as 11.234}
\getans
\endoptiongroup
\beginoptiongroup{WORD `PAGE' IN ARTICLES:}{}
\optdef{*}{}{Article pages numbers only}{as 234-256}
\optdef{p}{jwdpg}{Include `page' in articles}{as pp. 234--256}
\getans
\endoptiongroup
% \end{macrocode}
%
% Some journals want page numbers at the end, even for books, proceedings, as
% well as for journals.
% \begin{macrocode}
\beginoptiongroup{POSITION OF PAGES:}{}
\optdef{*}{}{Pages given mid text}{as is normal}
\optdef{e}{pp-last}{Pages at end}{but before any notes}
\getans
\endoptiongroup
\beginoptiongroup{WORD `VOLUME' IN ARTICLES:}{}
\optdef{*}{}{Article volume as number only}{as 21}
\optdef{p}{jwdvol}{Include `volume' in articles}{as vol. 21}
\getans
\endoptiongroup
% \end{macrocode}
%
% Fiddle with the format and location of the number/series for collections and
% inproceedings.
% \begin{macrocode}
\beginoptiongroup{NUMBER AND SERIES FOR COLLECTIONS:}{}
\optdef{*}{num-xser}{Allows number without series}{and suppresses word "number"}
\optdef{s}{}{Standard BibTeX}{as: "number 123 in Total Works"; error if number and no series}
\getans
\endoptiongroup
\beginoptiongroup{POSITION OF NUMBER AND SERIES:}{}
\optdef{*}{}{After chapter and pages}{as in standard BibTeX}
\optdef{t}{numser}{Just before publisher}{or organization}
\getans
\endoptiongroup
% \end{macrocode}
%
% Fiddle with the format and location of series and volume with books and collections.
% \begin{macrocode}
\beginoptiongroup{VOLUME AND SERIES FOR BOOKS/COLLECTIONS:}{}
\optdef{*}{}{Vol. 23 of Series}{as in standard BibTeX}
\optdef{s}{ser-vol}{Series, vol. 23}{}
\getans
\endoptiongroup
\beginoptiongroup{POSITION OF VOLUME AND SERIES FOR INCOLLECTIONS:}{}
\optdef{*}{}{Series and volume after the editors}{}
\optdef{e}{ser-ed}{Series and volume after booktitle}{and before editors}
\getans
\endoptiongroup
% \end{macrocode}
%
% It is possible to decide whether the journal name should be
% separated from the following specifications with a blank or comma.
% \begin{macrocode}
\beginoptiongroup{JOURNAL NAME PUNCTUATION:}{}
\optdef{*}{}{Comma after journal}{name}
\optdef{x}{jnm-x}{Space after journal}{name}
\getans
\endoptiongroup
% \end{macrocode}
%
% \subsection*{Books}
% The title of a book (as opposed to an article in a book or journal) is
% normally italicized. This may be set to the regular font.
%
% The page numbers in books may be set in parentheses, as (pp.\ 345--350).
% \begin{macrocode}
\beginoptiongroup{BOOK TITLE:}{}
\optdef{*}{}{Book title italic}{(\string\em)}
\optdef{p}{btit-rm,bt-rm}{Book title plain}{(no font command)}
\getans
\endoptiongroup
\beginoptiongroup{PAGES IN BOOKS:}{}
\optdef{*}{}{Pages in book plain}{as pp. 50-55}
\optdef{p}{bkpg-par}{Pages in book in parentheses}{as (pp. 50-55)}
\optdef{x}{bkpg-x}{Pages in book bare}{as 50-55}
\getans
\endoptiongroup
\beginoptiongroup{TOTAL PAGES OF A BOOK:}{}
\optdef{*}{}{Total book pages not printed}{}
\optdef{p}{pg-bk}{For book: 345 pages}{or pp.}
\optdef{a}{pg-bk,pg-pre}{Total book pages before publisher}{}
\getans
\endoptiongroup
% \end{macrocode}
% Some psychology journals wish to have the publisher's address preceding
% the name, separated by colon, as
% \begin{quote}New York: Wiley and Sons\end{quote}
%
% Some journals (e.g.\ Nature) put publisher in parentheses with date,
% as (Wiley and Sons, New York, 1983). These normally put the date in
% parentheses at the end anyway, so this is a merging of the two sets of
% parentheses.
% \begin{macrocode}
\beginoptiongroup{PUBLISHER ADDRESS:}{}
\optdef{*}{}{Publisher, address}{as Harcourt, New York}
\optdef{a}{add-pub}{Address: Publisher}{as New York: Harcourt}
\getans
\endoptiongroup
\beginoptiongroup{PUBLISHER IN PARENTHESES:}{}
\optdef{*}{}{Publisher as normal block}{without parentheses}
\optdef{p}{pub-par}{Publisher in parentheses}{}
\optdef{d}{pub-date}{Publisher and date in parentheses}{(Oxford, 1994)}
\optdef{c}{pub-date,pub-xc}{Publisher and date in parentheses, no comma}{(Oxford 1994)}
\optdef{f}{pub-date,pub-xpar}{Publisher and date without parentheses}{Oxford, 1994}
\optdef{k}{pub-date,pub-xpar,pub-xc}{Publisher and date, no parentheses, no comma}{Oxford 1994}
\getans
\endoptiongroup
\beginoptiongroup{PUBLISHER POSITION:}{}
\optdef{*}{}{Publisher after chapter, pages}{}
\optdef{p}{pre-pub}{Publisher before chapter, pages}{}
\optdef{e}{pre-edn}{Publisher after edition}{}
\getans
\endoptiongroup
% \end{macrocode}
%
% \subsection*{ISBN, ISSN, DOI numbers}
% Books normally possess an ISBN number. This may be included as an
% optional entry for \texttt{book}, \texttt{inbook}, \texttt{booklet},
% \texttt{incollection}, \texttt{proceedings}, \texttt{inproceedings}.
% However, it should be suppressed for \texttt{inbook} etc.\ when
% there is a crossref to another book with the ISBN number.
%
% Periodicals contain an ISSN number. Add this to \texttt{article}, or
% course, but also to \texttt{inproceedings} and \texttt{proceedings}, since
% they are sometimes printed in a periodical.
%
% Journal articles that appear online are given a DOI number, something more
% robust than a URL that can change as machines are upgraded.
% The American Geophysical Union (AGU) uses the DOI as part of the
% page number substitution for electronic journals, placing the number
% where the pages would normally appear.
% \begin{macrocode}
\beginoptiongroup{ISBN NUMBER:}{}
\optdef{*}{isbn}{Include ISBN}{for books, booklets, etc.}
\optdef{x}{}{No ISBN}{}
\getans
\endoptiongroup
\beginoptiongroup{ISSN NUMBER:}{}
\optdef{*}{issn}{Include ISSN}{for periodicals}
\optdef{x}{}{No ISSN}{}
\getans
\endoptiongroup
\beginoptiongroup{DOI NUMBER:}{}
\optdef{*}{doi}{Include DOI}{as "doi: number"}
\optdef{a}{agu-doi,doi}{Insert DOI AGU style}{as part of page number}
\optdef{x}{}{No DOI}{}
\getans
\endoptiongroup
% \end{macrocode}
%
% \subsection*{Editor of book without author}
%
% This is normally
% \begin{quote}
% J. K. James, editor
% \end{quote}
% but may also be
% \begin{quote}
% J. K. James, (editor)\\
% J. K. James (editor),
% \end{quote}
% Alternatively, the word \textsl{editor} may be capitalized and/or
% abbreviated.
%
% \begin{macrocode}
\beginoptiongroup{`EDITOR' AFTER NAMES (EDITED BOOKS WITHOUT AUTHORS):}{}
\optdef{*}{}{Word `editor' after name}{}
\optdef{a}{edpar}{`Name (editor),'}{in parentheses, after name, comma after}
\optdef{b}{edpar,bkedcap}{`Name (Editor),'}{as above, editor upper case}
\optdef{c}{edparc}{`Name, (editor)'}{in parentheses, after name, comma between}
\optdef{d}{edparc,bkedcap}{`Name, (Editor)'}{as above, editor upper case}
\optdef{e}{edparxc}{`Name (editor)'}{in parentheses, after name, no commas}
\optdef{f}{edparxc,bkedcap}{`Name (Editor)'}{as above, editor upper case}
\getans
\endoptiongroup
% \end{macrocode}
%
% \subsection*{Edited by}
% For an article within an edited collection, the normal form is
% \begin{quote}
% In J. K. James, editor, \emph{Title of Collection} \dots
% \end{quote}
% Alternative forms are
% \begin{quote}
% In J. K. James (editor), \emph{Title} \dots\\
% In \emph{Title}, edited by J. K. James \dots\\
% In \emph{Title} (Edited by J. K. James) \dots
% \end{quote}
% If none of the \texttt{edby} variations is used, then the same system is
% used as for edited books, i.e. \texttt{edpar} applies.
% \begin{macrocode}
\beginoptiongroup{EDITOR IN COLLECTIONS:}{}
\optdef{*}{}{Same as for edited book}{(names before booktitle)}
\optdef{b}{edby}{In booktitle, edited by .. }{(where .. is names)}
\optdef{p}{edby-par}{In booktitle (edited by ..)}{}
\optdef{c}{edby-parc}{In booktitle, (edited by ..)}{}
\optdef{e}{edby,edbyx}{In booktitle, editor ..}{}
\optdef{f}{edby,edbyw}{In booktitle, (editor) ..}{}
\optdef{k}{edby-par,edbyx}{In booktitle (editor..)}{}
\optdef{g}{edby-parc,edbyx}{In booktitle, (editor..)}{}
\optdef{j}{edby,edbyy}{In booktitle, .., editor}{}
\optdef{m}{edby-par,edbyy}{In booktitle (.., editor)}{}
\getans
\endoptiongroup
\mytempfalse
\if\ans p\mytemptrue\fi
\if\ans k\mytemptrue\fi
\if\ans c\mytemptrue\fi
\if\ans f\mytemptrue\fi
\beginoptiongroup{CAPITALIZE `EDITOR' OR `EDITED BY'
(if editor capitalizable)}
{\ifmytemp*\fi}%
\optdef{*}{}{`(editor,..)' or `(edited by..)'}{in lower case}
\optdef{c}{edcap}{`(Editor,..)' or `(Edited by..)'}{in upper case}
\getans
\endoptiongroup
% \end{macrocode}
%
% \subsection*{Block punctuation}
% Blocks are logical sections of the reference specification, such as the
% author block, the journal block, editor block, etc. These are normally
% separated by periods, but alternatively a comma may be used. Another
% choice is to use commas except after titles where a period is given.
%
% \LaTeX\ offers an \texttt{openbib} option, which means that the blocks
% are not only new sentences, but new lines as well. This can only
% function when the default option here is taken, for then the command
% |\newblock| is placed between the blocks. This command is normally
% defined to do nothing, but \LaTeX\ redefines it to issue a new line
% when open bibliographies are wanted.
% \begin{macrocode}
\beginoptiongroup{PUNCTUATION BETWEEN SECTIONS (BLOCKS):}{}
\optdef{*}{}{\string\newblock\space after blocks}
{(periods or new lines with openbib option)}
\optdef{c}{blk-com}{Comma between blocks}{}
\optdef{s}{blk-com,com-semi}{Semi-colon between blocks}{}
\optdef{b}{blk-com,com-blank}{Blanks between blocks}{}
\optdef{t}{blk-tit}{Period after titles of articles, books, etc}{else commas}
\optdef{u}{blk-tit,tit-col}{Colon after titles of articles, books, etc}{else commas}
\optdef{a}{blk-tita}{Period after titles of articles}{else commas}
\optdef{d}{blk-tita,tit-col}{Colon after titles of articles}{else commas}
\getans
\endoptiongroup
\mytempfalse
\if\ans c\mytemptrue\fi
\if\ans s\mytemptrue\fi
\if\ans b\mytemptrue\fi
\if\ans t\mytemptrue\fi
\if\ans a\mytemptrue\fi
\beginoptiongroup{PUNCTUATION BEFORE NOTES
(if not using \string\newblock)}
{\ifmytemp*\fi}%
\optdef{*}{}{Notes have regular punctuation}{like all other blocks}
\optdef{p}{blknt}{Notes preceded by period}{}
\getans
\endoptiongroup
\beginoptiongroup{PUNCTUATION AFTER AUTHORS:}{}
\optdef{*}{}{Author block normal}{with regular block punctuation}
\optdef{c}{au-col}{Author block with colon}{}
\getans
\endoptiongroup
% \end{macrocode}
%
% \subsection*{\textsl{In} with colon}
% When referring to works in a collection, one begins the block describing
% that collection with \textsl{In}. Optionally, one may add a colon.
% \begin{macrocode}
\beginoptiongroup{PUNCTUATION AFTER `IN':}{}
\optdef{*}{}{Space after `in'}{for incollection or inproceedings}
\optdef{c}{in-col}{Colon after `in'}{(as `In: ...')}
\optdef{i}{in-it}{Italic `in'}{and space}
\optdef{d}{in-col,in-it}{Italic `in' and colon}{}
\optdef{x}{in-x}{No word `in'}{for edited works}
\getans
\endoptiongroup
\beginoptiongroup{`IN' WITH JOURNAL NAMES
(if using 'in' with collections)}
{\if\ans x\else*\fi}
\optdef{*}{}{No `in' before journal name}{}
\optdef{i}{injnl}{Add `in' before journal name}{in style for incollection}
\getans
\endoptiongroup
% \end{macrocode}
%
% \subsection*{Final punctuation}
% The punctuation at the end of the reference is normally a period. This
% may be suppressed.
% \begin{macrocode}
\beginoptiongroup{FINAL PUNCTUATION:}{}
\optdef{*}{}{Period at very end}{of the listed reference}
\optdef{x}{fin-bare}{No period at end}{}
\getans
\endoptiongroup
% \end{macrocode}
%
% \subsection*{Abbreviations}
% A number of words may be abbreviated: pages, editors, volume, chapter,
% and so on. The first two may be independently set to abbreviation, the
% rest with a single option.
%
% Additionally, the edition numbers may be
% output as words (first, second, etc.) or as numbers (1st, 2nd, etc.).
% (Recall that the input in the \texttt{.bib} file is always as English
% words.)
% \begin{macrocode}
\beginoptiongroup{ABBREVIATE WORD `PAGES'
(if not using external language file)}
{\if!\cfile!\relax*\fi}%
\optdef{*}{}{`Page(s)'}{(no abbreviation)}
\optdef{a}{pp}{`Page' abbreviated}{as p. or pp.}
\optdef{x}{ppx}{`Page' omitted}{}
\getans
\beginoptiongroup{ABBREVIATE WORD `EDITORS':}{}
\optdef{*}{}{`Editor(s)'}{(no abbreviation)}
\optdef{a}{ed}{`Editor' abbreviated}{as ed. or eds.}
\getans
\endoptiongroup
\beginoptiongroup{OTHER ABBREVIATIONS:}{}
\optdef{*}{}{No abbreviations}{of volume, edition, chapter, etc}
\optdef{a}{abr}{Abbreviations}{of such words}
\getans
\endoptiongroup
\beginoptiongroup{ABBREVIATION FOR `EDITION'
(if abbreviating words)}
{\if\ans a*\fi}%
\optdef{*}{}{`Edition' abbreviated as `edn'}{}
\optdef{a}{ednx}{`Edition' abbreviated as `ed'}{}
\getans
\beginoptiongroup{MONTHS WITH DOTS:}{}
\optdef{*}{}{Months with dots}{as Jan.}
\optdef{x}{mth-bare}{Months without dots}{as Feb Mar}
\getans
\endoptiongroup
\endoptiongroup
\beginoptiongroup{EDITION NUMBERS:}{}
\optdef{*}{xedn}{Editions as in database}{saving much processing memory}
\optdef{w}{}{Write out editions}{as first, second, third, etc}
\optdef{n}{ord}{Numerical editions}{as 1st, 2nd, 3rd, etc}
\getans
\endoptiongroup
\endoptiongroup
% \end{macrocode}
%
% The above choices about abbreviations are made only if the internal
% languages are taken (English or \texttt{babel}). For an external language
% definition file, these choices, along with possible other ones, are made
% in the external file, which is read in at this point.
% \begin{macrocode}
\umes{Reading external language file \string\cfile=\cfile}%
\if!\cfile!\relax\else
\input\cfile
\fi
% \end{macrocode}
%
% This file contains the standard set of stored journal names present in
% the basic bibliography style files. If other files containing journal
% names are to be included, they may only contain the options \texttt{jabr}
% or \texttt{jaa} since these options are selected here. No option
% menus from the journal-name files will be read in.
% \begin{macrocode}
\beginoptiongroup{STORED JOURNAL NAMES:}{}
\optdef{*}{}{Full journal names}{for prestored journals}
\optdef{a}{jabr}{Abbreviated journal names}{}
\optdef{s}{jabr,jaa}{Abbreviated with astronomy shorthands}{like ApJ and AJ}
\getans
\endoptiongroup
% \end{macrocode}
%
% \subsection*{Variations on \textsl{and}}
% It is possible to replace the word \textsl{and} with an ampersand \&, and to
% specify whether a comma is to precede \textsl{and} in a list of more than two
% names.
%
% A variable \textsl{and} may be provided for with the command |\BIBand|
% in place of the word. In this case, the command must be defined in the
% document file or some other package called. (This is intended for situations
% where an ampersand is wanted in parenthetical citations, but the word in
% textual ones.)
%
% \begin{macrocode}
\beginoptiongroup{AMPERSAND:}{}
\optdef{*}{}{Use word `and'}{in author lists}
\optdef{a}{amper}{Use ampersand}{in place of `and'}
\optdef{v}{varand}{Use \string\BIBand}{in place of `and'}
\getans
\endoptiongroup
\beginoptiongroup{COMMA BEFORE `AND':}{}
\optdef{*}{}{Comma before `and'}{as `Tom, Dick, and Harry'}
\optdef{n}{and-xcom}{No comma before `and'}{as `Tom, Dick and Harry'}
\optdef{c}{and-com}{Comma even with 2 authors}{as `Tom, and Harry'}
\getans
\endoptiongroup
\beginoptiongroup{COMMA BEFORE `AND' EVEN FOR COLLECTION EDITORS
(if using comma before `and' with authors)}
{\if\ans c*\fi}%
\optdef{*}{and-com-ed}{Comma with 2 editors}{in collections}
\optdef{x}{}{Two editors without comma}{as `Tom and Harry'}
\getans
\endoptiongroup
\beginoptiongroup{NO `AND' IN REFERENCE LIST:}{}
\optdef{*}{}{With `and'}{before last author in reference list}
\optdef{x}{xand}{No `and'}{as `Tom, Dick, Harry'}
\getans
\endoptiongroup
% \end{macrocode}
%
% \subsection*{Font of \textsl{et al}}
% One can chose that \textsl{et~al.}\ be put into italics.
% Or, if the authors are in a different font from the regular one, the
% \textsl{et~al.}\ can still be Roman.
% \begin{macrocode}
\beginoptiongroup{FONT OF `ET AL':}{}
\optdef{*}{}{Plain et al}{}
\optdef{i}{etal-it}{Italic et al}{}
\optdef{r}{etal-rm}{Roman et al}{even when authors something else}
\getans
\endoptiongroup
% \end{macrocode}
%
% \subsection*{Additional Data Fields}\label{sec:revtex}
% \changes{3.89d1}{1999 July 20}{AO: add the revdata option group}
% The American Physical Society's REV\TeX\ package contains \btx\ support
% with a \texttt{bst} file generated from a variant of
% \texttt{\filename}. The extra fields are also available here.
% \begin{itemize}
% \item \textbf{collaboration}: A collaboration name associated with a
% reference.
% \item \textbf{eprint}: The e-print citation for the reference (Los Alamos
% or otherwise). E-print numbers can be turned into hyperlinks to the
% online article. The output is\\
% \hspace*{2em}|\eprint{|\textit{eprint-spec}|}|
% \item \textbf{archive}: is an optional argument for |\eprint|, as\\
% \hspace*{2em}|\eprint[|\textit{archive-des}|]{|\textit{eprint-spec}|}|\\
% The \textit{archive-des} is some code such as \texttt{arXiv} that is
% translated to a base URL by a class or package file. The default definition
% of |\eprint| ignores \textit{archive-des} and prints \textit{eprint-spec}
% as a URL.
% \item \textbf{url}: A URL associated with the reference. Can be turned
% into a hyperlink.
% \end{itemize}
%
% A collaboration appears as part of the author list and the other two
% appear at the end of the citaton. The URL field can be selected
% independently of this option.
%
% In addition there are new fields for journals like Phys.\ Rev.~D that
% no longer use page numbers.
% \begin{itemize}
% \item \textbf{eid}: Electronic article identifier.
% \item \textbf{numpages}: Number of pages in an article. For use in
% conjunction with the \textbf{eid} field when page counts are
% desired. Deprecated when submitting to Phys.\ Rev.
%
% The \texttt{eprint} (with \texttt{archive}) and \texttt{url} fields may be
% included independently of the other REV\TeX\ fields.
%
% The \texttt{eid} field is now always included, although it is optional for
% the bibliography entries. This electronic identifier is a replacement for the
% page number in electronic journals: it is the sequence number in the printed
% volume. If present, it will be used in place of the page number.
%
% \end{itemize}
%
% \begin{macrocode}
\beginoptiongroup{ADDITIONAL REVTeX DATA FIELDS:}{}
\optdef{*}{}{No additional fields}{for REVTeX}
\optdef{r}{revdata,eprint,url,url-blk}{Include REVTeX data fields}
{collaboration, eid, eprint, archive, numpages, url}
\getans
\mytemptrue
\if\ans r\mytempfalse\fi
\beginoptiongroup{E-PRINT DATA FIELD:
(without REVTeX fields)}
{\ifmytemp*\fi}
\optdef{*}{}{Do not include eprint field}{}
\optdef{e}{eprint}{Include eprint and archive fields}{for electronic publications}
\getans
\endoptiongroup
% \end{macrocode}
%
% \subsection*{URL address}
% For electronic documents with an Internet address, add a URL entry.
% Harvard already has this, but here it is done for all styles.
% The URL text will be set with the \verb!\url! command in the \texttt{url}
% package by Donald Arseneau. This package must be loaded for the command
% to work right. It allows line breaks at punctuations. Otherwise,
% \verb!\texttt! is used instead, with no line breaks. The URL text is preceded
% by \verb!\urlprefix! which defaults to ``URL '' but may be redefined by the
% user to be whatever s/he wants. The final space must be included.
%
% Note: selecting the REV\TeX\ fields automatically includes this, so the
% offer only is made if REV\TeX\ has been rejected.
%
% \begin{macrocode}
\beginoptiongroup{URL ADDRESS:
(without REVTeX fields)}{\ifmytemp*\fi}
\optdef{*}{}{No URL}{for electronic (Internet) documents}
\optdef{u}{url,url-blk}{Include URL}{as regular item block}
\optdef{n}{url,url-nt}{URL as note}{}
\optdef{l}{url,url-nl}{URL on new line}{after rest of reference}
\getans
\endoptiongroup
\endoptiongroup
% \end{macrocode}
%
% \subsection*{Reference Component Tagging}
% \changes{3.89d1}{1999 July 20}{AO: add the bibinfo option group}
% If reference component tagging is enabled, we
% apply tags like |\bibinfo| and |\eprint| to the fields of data
% in the content of the |\bibitem| statement. We also ensure that
% these commands have a default meaning within the scope of the |thebibliography|
% environment. The default definitions simply print the field and ignore the
% tag. However, other programs or packages might make use of the tag
% information to separate authors from title, for example.
%
% \begin{macrocode}
\beginoptiongroup{REFERENCE COMPONENT TAGS:}{}
\optdef{*}{}{No reference component tags}
{in the \string\bibitem\space entries}
\optdef{b}{bibinfo}{Reference component tags}
{like \string\bibinfo\space in the content of \string\bibitem}
\getans
\endoptiongroup
% \end{macrocode}
%
% \subsection*{Define emphasis}
% In everything that been mentioned so far, italicization should be
% understood to mean `emphasize' in the \LaTeX{} sense. This means that the
% command |\em| is used. This is not the same as |\it|, which is always
% italics. Rather, with |\em|, the font style switches between |\rm| and
% |\it| depending on the context. Here one may choose to true italics, or
% to switch off italics altogether.
% \begin{macrocode}
\beginoptiongroup{EMPHASIS:
(affects all so-called italics)}{}
\optdef{*}{}{Use emphasis}{ie, \string\em, allows font switching}
\optdef{i}{em-it}{Use true italics}{ie, \string\it, absolute italics}
\optdef{x}{em-x}{No italics}{at all}
\optdef{u}{em-ul}{Underlining}{in place of italics, best with ulem package}
\getans
\endoptiongroup
% \end{macrocode}
%
% \subsection*{Plain \TeX\ compatibility}
% Bold face, italics, and emphasis are made with the \LaTeXe\ commands,
% which makes them incompatible with the obsolete \LaTeX2.09, and with
% Plain \TeX. There are also some extra testing for existing commands
% that best work with \LaTeXe\ syntax.
%
% If the bibliography style file is to be fully compatible with Plain \TeX,
% do not select the option \texttt{nfss} but do take \texttt{plntx}.
% \begin{macrocode}
\beginoptiongroup{COMPATIBILITY WITH PLAIN TEX:}{}
\optdef{*}{nfss}{Use LaTeX commands}{which may not work with Plain TeX}
\optdef{t}{plntx}{Use only Plain TeX}{commands for fonts and testing}
\getans
\endoptiongroup
% \end{macrocode}
%
% Terminate the options list. If a language definition file has been called,
% then we have a closing brace too many, so add another dummy opening brace.
% \begin{macrocode}
\if!\cfile\jfile!\else
\begingroup\MBswitch
\wr(,{\pc)
\endgroup
\fi
\endoptions
%</options>
% \end{macrocode}
% \StopEventually{\PrintChanges}
%
% \section{The Bibliographic Coding}
%
% \begin{macrocode}
%<*!options&!driver&!bblbst>
%<*!tail>
% For use with BibTeX version 0.99a or later
%-------------------------------------------------------------------
%<*(!nmft&(nmft-it|nmft-sc|nmft-bf|nmft-def))|(!lab&(lab-it|lab-bf|lab-sc|lab-def))>
% WARNING WARNING WARNING WARNING WARNING WARNING WARNING WARNING
% The input dbj file contains one of the options
%<nmft-it|nmft-sc|nmft-bf|nmft-def> % nmft-it, nmft-bf, nmft-sc, or nmft-def
%<lab-it|lab-sc|lab-bf|lab-def> % lab-it, lab-bf, lab-sc, or lab-def
% without the corresponding general option(s):
%<nmft-it|nmft-sc|nmft-bf|nmft-def> % nmft
%<lab-it|lab-sc|lab-bf|lab-def> % lab
% (You may be using an older dbj with a newer version of merlin.mbs)
% Please edit your dbj file to add the general option(s) and reprocess.
%
%</(!nmft&(nmft-it|nmft-sc|nmft-bf|nmft-def))|(!lab&(lab-it|lab-bf|lab-sc|lab-def))>
%<*!exlang>
%<!babel> % This bibliography style file is intended for texts in ENGLISH
%<*babel>
% This bibliography style file requires a file named babelbst.tex
% containing the definitions of word commands like \bbleditor, etc.
%</babel>
%</!exlang>
%<*exlang>
% This bibliography style file is intended for texts in
%<bahasa> % BAHASA
%<brazilian> % BRAZILIAN
%<catalan> % CATALAN
%<croatian> % CROATIAN
%<czech> % CZECH
%<danish> % DANISH
%<dansk> % DANSK
%<dutch> % DUTCH
%<english> % ENGLISH
%<esperanto> % ESPERANTO
%<finnish> % FINNISH
%<french> % FRENCH
%<galacian> % GALACIAN
%<german> % GERMAN
%<hungarian> % HUNGARIAN
%<italian> % ITALIAN
%<norwegian> % NORWEGIAN
%<norsk> % NORWEGIAN
%<polski> % POLISH
%<polish> % POLISH
%<portuguese> % PORTUGUESE
%<romanian> % ROMANIAN
%<russian> % RUSSIAN
%<slovak> % SLOVAK
%<slovenian> % SLOVENIAN
%<slovene> % SLOVENIAN
%<spanish> % SPANISH
%<swedish> % SWEDISH
%<turkish> % TURKISH
%</exlang>
%<*!html>
%<*ay>
% This is an author-year citation style bibliography. As such, it is
% non-standard LaTeX, and requires a special package file to function properly.
% Such a package is natbib.sty by Patrick W. Daly
%<*alk>
% or: apalike.sty by Oren Patashnik
% The form of the \bibitem entries is
% \bibitem[Jones et al., 1990]{key}...
%</alk>
%<*!(har|ast|alk|cay|nmd|cn)>
% The form of the \bibitem entries is
% \bibitem[Jones et al.(1990)]{key}...
%<nat> % \bibitem[Jones et al.(1990)Jones, Baker, and Smith]{key}...
% The essential feature is that the label (the part in brackets) consists
% of the author names, as they should appear in the citation, with the year
% in parentheses following. There must be no space before the opening
% parenthesis!
%<nat> % With natbib v5.3, a full list of authors may also follow the year.
% In natbib.sty, it is possible to define the type of enclosures that is
% really wanted (brackets or parentheses), but in either case, there must
% be parentheses in the label.
% The \cite command functions as follows:
% \citet{key} ==>> Jones et al. (1990)
%<nat> % \citet*{key} ==>> Jones, Baker, and Smith (1990)
% \citep{key} ==>> (Jones et al., 1990)
%<nat> % \citep*{key} ==>> (Jones, Baker, and Smith, 1990)
% \citep[chap. 2]{key} ==>> (Jones et al., 1990, chap. 2)
% \citep[e.g.][]{key} ==>> (e.g. Jones et al., 1990)
% \citep[e.g.][p. 32]{key} ==>> (e.g. Jones et al., p. 32)
% \citeauthor{key} ==>> Jones et al.
%<nat> % \citeauthor*{key} ==>> Jones, Baker, and Smith
% \citeyear{key} ==>> 1990
%</!(har|ast|alk|cay|nmd|cn)>
%<*har>
% or: harvard.sty by Peter Williams and Thorsten Schnier
%<harnm> % (needs natbib v5.3 or harvard v2.0.3)
% The form of the bibitem entries is
% \harvarditem[Jones et al.]{Jones, Baker, and Smith}{1990}{key}...
%</har>
%<*cay>
% or: chicago.sty
% The form of the bibitem entries is
% \bibitem[\protect\citeauthoryear{Jones, Baker, and Smith}
% {Jones et al.}{1990}{key}...
%</cay>
%<*nmd>
% or: named.sty
% The form of the bibitem entries is
% \bibitem[\protect\citeauthoryear{Jones et al.}{1990}]{key}...
%</nmd>
%<*ast>
% or: astron.sty
% The form of the bibitem entries is
% \bibitem[\protect\astroncite{Jones et al.}{1990}]{key}...
%</ast>
%<*cn>
% or: authordate1-4.sty
% The form of the bibitem entries is
% \bibitem[\protect\citename{Jones et al.}1990]{key}...
%</cn>
%</ay>
%<*!ay>
%<*!alph&!cite>
% This is a numerical citation style, and as such is standard LaTeX.
%</!alph&!cite>
%<*alph>
% This is a labelled citation style similar to the standard alpha.bst,
% where labels are of the form Dal90 or DBK89.
%</alph>
%<*cite&!alph>
% This is a special pseudo-numerical bibliography style, intended to be
% used to list all the entries in a bib database
%</cite&!alph>
% It requires no extra package to interface to the main text.
% The form of the \bibitem entries is
%<!alph&!cite> % \bibitem{key}...
%<alph> % \bibitem[label]{key}...
%<!alph&cite> % \bibitem[key]{key}...
%<*!cite|alph>
% Usage of \cite is as follows:
%<*!alph&!cite>
% \cite{key} ==>> [#]
% \cite[chap. 2]{key} ==>> [#, chap. 2]
% where # is a number determined by the ordering in the reference list.
%</!alph&!cite>
%<*alph>
% \cite{key} ==>> [label]
% \cite[chap. 2]{key} ==>> [label, chap. 2]
% The order in the reference list is by label.
%</alph>
%<*seq-no&!alph>
% The order in the reference list is that by which the works were originally
% cited in the text, or that in the database.
%</seq-no&!alph>
%<*!seq-no&!alph>
% The order in the reference list is alphabetical by authors.
%</!seq-no&!alph>
%</!cite|alph>
%</!ay>
%</!html>
%<*html>
% This bibliographic style file produces HTML output instead of LaTeX.
% The LaTeX special characters are not translated, so that the output
% (which has the .bbl ending still) will have to be further massaged,
% and renamed with .html or .htm. The title and heading may also need
% to be revised.
%
%<htlist&!htdes> % The output is a numbered list.
%<htdes> % The output is an unnumbered list with the keys printed
%<htdes> % before each entry.
%<!htlist&!htdes> % The output is lists each entry as one paragraph.
%</html>
%---------------------------------------------------------------------
% \end{macrocode}
%
% \begin{macro}{`ENTRY'}
% \changes{1.5(2.3)}{1994 Sep 16}{Add URL entry type for \texttt{harnm} option}
% The new \texttt{harvard.sty} of \LaTeXe{} includes an entry URL, or
% rather it is included in the new \texttt{.bst} files for it. Add it
% here too, but only for option \texttt{harnm}.
%
% \changes{3.0}{1995 Mar 1}{Add optional entries \texttt{isbn}}
% Books normally have an ISBN number.
% This entry is (optionally) included, modelled after that in
% \texttt{xbtxbst.doc}.
% \changes{3.89d1}{1999 July 20}{AO: add the \texttt{revdata} data}
%
% \begin{macrocode}
ENTRY
{ address
%<annote> annote
%<eprint> archive
author
booktitle
chapter
%<revdata> collaboration
%<doi> doi
edition
editor
eid
%<eprint> eprint
howpublished
institution
%<isbn> isbn
%<issn> issn
journal
key
%<lang> language
month
note
number
%<revdata> numpages
organization
pages
publisher
school
series
title
type
%<url|harnm|revdata> url
volume
year
}
{}
%<!ay&!alph> { label }
%<!ay&alph> { label extra.label sort.label }
%<ay> { label extra.label sort.label short.list }
% \end{macrocode}
% \end{macro}
%
% \begin{macrocode}
INTEGERS { output.state before.all mid.sentence after.sentence after.block }
% \end{macrocode}
%
% \begin{macro}{`init.state.consts'}
% \begin{macrocode}
FUNCTION {init.state.consts}
{ #0 'before.all :=
#1 'mid.sentence :=
#2 'after.sentence :=
#3 'after.block :=
}
% \end{macrocode}
% \end{macro}
%
% |s| and |t| are general-purpose scratch registers whose value does not persist
% past the end of a function. They also do not appear to be used to communicate
% between functions or to be clobbered within a sub-function call. Hopefully.
% \begin{macrocode}
STRINGS { s t}
% \end{macrocode}
%
% \begin{macro}{`output.nonnull'}
% \begin{macrocode}
FUNCTION {output.nonnull}
{ 's :=
output.state mid.sentence =
%<!blk-com|(!com-semi&!com-blank)> { ", " * write$ }
%<blk-com&com-semi> { "; " * write$ }
%<blk-com&!com-semi&com-blank> { " " * write$ }
{ output.state after.block =
{ add.period$ write$
newline$
%<!html> "\newblock " write$
}
{ output.state before.all =
'write$
{ add.period$ " " * write$ }
if$
}
if$
mid.sentence 'output.state :=
}
if$
s
}
% \end{macrocode}
% \end{macro}
%
% \begin{macro}{`output'}
% \begin{macrocode}
FUNCTION {output}
{ duplicate$ empty$
'pop$
'output.nonnull
if$
}
% \end{macrocode}
% \end{macro}
%
% \begin{macro}{`output.check'}
% \begin{macrocode}
FUNCTION {output.check}
{ 't :=
duplicate$ empty$
{ pop$ "empty " t * " in " * cite$ * warning$ }
'output.nonnull
if$
}
% \end{macrocode}
% \end{macro}
%
% \begin{macro}{`fin.entry'}
% \changes{3.87}{1998 Jul 23}{Add annotation}
% \changes{3.89d1}{1999 July 20}{AO: make ``babel compatible''}
% I have often been asked to add an annotation function. This suggestion is
% from Soren Dayton; it inputs a file with the same name as the cite key, or
% uses the text in the \texttt{annote} field. It will only work with \LaTeXe.
% \begin{macrocode}
FUNCTION {fin.entry}
%<*!fin-bare>
{ add.period$
write$
%</!fin-bare>
%<*fin-bare>
{ duplicate$ empty$
'pop$
'write$
if$
%</fin-bare>
%<html&htdes> "</dd>" write$
%<html&!htdes&htlist> "</li>" write$
%<html&!htdes&!htlist> "</p>" write$
newline$
%<*annote>
%<*!html>
annote missing$
{ "\bibAnnoteFile{" cite$ * "}" * write$ newline$ }
{ "\bibAnnote{" cite$ * "}{" * annote * "}" * write$ newline$
}
if$
%</!html>
%<*html>
"<blockquote><strong>Key:</strong> "
cite$ * write$
annote missing$
{ newline$ }
{ "<br><strong>Annotation:</strong>" write$ newline$
annote write$ newline$
}
if$
"</blockquote>" write$ newline$
%</html>
%</annote>
}
% \end{macrocode}
% \end{macro}
%
% \begin{macro}{`new.block'}
% \begin{macrocode}
FUNCTION {new.block}
{ output.state before.all =
'skip$
{ after.block 'output.state := }
if$
}
% \end{macrocode}
% \end{macro}
%
% \begin{macro}{`new.sentence'}
% \begin{macrocode}
FUNCTION {new.sentence}
{ output.state after.block =
'skip$
{ output.state before.all =
'skip$
{ after.sentence 'output.state := }
if$
}
if$
}
% \end{macrocode}
% \end{macro}
%
% \begin{macro}{`add.blank'}
% \changes{1.5(2.3)b}{1995 Jan 10}{Add function}
% When text is printed with \texttt{output} or
% \texttt{output.check}, the \texttt{output.state} is set such that
% a comma will precede the next output text. For special effects, we want to
% suppress this comma, inserting a blank instead. Hence the
% \texttt{output.state} is changed to \texttt{before.all}, meaning no
% punctuation is to be inserted.
% \begin{macrocode}
FUNCTION {add.blank}
{ " " * before.all 'output.state :=
}
% \end{macrocode}
% \end{macro}
%
% \begin{macro}{`add.colon'}
% \changes{3.4}{1995 Sep 28}{Add macro}
% \changes{3.83}{1997 Feb 5}{Simplify: just tack on colon}
% \begin{macrocode}
%<*au-col|tit-col>
FUNCTION {add.colon}
{ duplicate$ empty$
'skip$
{ ":" * add.blank }
if$
}
%</au-col|tit-col>
% \end{macrocode}
% \end{macro}
%
% \begin{macro}{`no.blank.or.punct'}
% \changes{3.2}{1995 May 19}{Add function}
% \changes{3.2}{1995 May 30}{Present only for option \texttt{yrpp-xsp}}
% Another frill is to suppresss both blanks and punctuation. The |\hspace|
% permits a line break at this point.
% \begin{macrocode}
%<*yrpp-xsp>
FUNCTION {no.blank.or.punct}
%<*!html>
{ "\hspace{0pt}" * before.all 'output.state :=
}
%</!html>
%<html>{ before.all 'output.state := }
%</yrpp-xsp>
% \end{macrocode}
% \end{macro}
%
% \begin{macro}{`date.block'}
% \changes{3.0}{1995 Mar 9}{Add function}
% \changes{3.81}{1996 Jun 25}{Add option \texttt{yrp-per}}
% The \texttt{date.block} function is used for special punctuating effects
% after the date.
% \begin{macrocode}
FUNCTION {date.block}
{
%<*!yrp-x>
%<yrp-col> ":" *
%<*!yrp-col>
%<yrp-semi> ";" *
%<*!yrp-semi>
%<!blk-com&!blk-tit&!blk-tita> new.block
%<(blk-com|blk-tit|blk-tita)&!yrp-per> skip$
%<(blk-com|blk-tit|blk-tita)&yrp-per> new.sentence
%</!yrp-semi>
%</!yrp-col>
%</!yrp-x>
%<*yrp-x|yrp-col|yrp-semi>
%<!yrpp-xsp> add.blank
%<yrpp-xsp> no.blank.or.punct
%</yrp-x|yrp-col|yrp-semi>
}
% \end{macrocode}
% \end{macro}
%
% \begin{macro}{`not'}
% \begin{macrocode}
FUNCTION {not}
{ { #0 }
{ #1 }
if$
}
% \end{macrocode}
% \end{macro}
%
% \begin{macro}{`and'}
% \begin{macrocode}
FUNCTION {and}
{ 'skip$
{ pop$ #0 }
if$
}
% \end{macrocode}
% \end{macro}
%
% \begin{macro}{`or'}
% \begin{macrocode}
FUNCTION {or}
{ { pop$ #1 }
'skip$
if$
}
% \end{macrocode}
% \end{macro}
%
% \begin{macro}{`non.stop'}
% \changes{1.4(2.2)a}{1994 Sep 8}{Add to test if last character
% is punctuation: . ! ?}
% This function (my invention) tests if the last character in the string
% on the stack is \texttt{. ! ?} by using \texttt{add.period\$}. It is to
% be used for conditional italic correction or adding commas.
% \begin{macrocode}
%<*!tit-it&tit-qq>
FUNCTION {non.stop}
{ duplicate$
"}" * add.period$
#-1 #1 substring$ "." =
}
%</!tit-it&tit-qq>
% \end{macrocode}
% \end{macro}
%
% \begin{macro}{`remove.dots'}
% \changes{4.00}{1999 Oct 8}{Add macro}
% This macro removes any periods from the string on the stack. To be used
% for undotting journal names, months, and juniors. Previously
% \texttt{purify\$} was used for this, but that removes more than just
% dots.
% \begin{macrocode}
%<*nm-rv|nm-rvx|nm-rvcx|mth-bare|jxper>
STRINGS {z}
FUNCTION {remove.dots}
{ 'z :=
""
{ z empty$ not }
{ z #1 #1 substring$
z #2 global.max$ substring$ 'z :=
duplicate$ "." = 'pop$
{ * }
if$
}
while$
}
%</nm-rv|nm-rvx|nm-rvcx|mth-bare|jxper>
% \end{macrocode}
% \end{macro}
%
% \begin{macro}{`new.block.checka'}
% \begin{macrocode}
%<*!ay>
FUNCTION {new.block.checka}
{ empty$
'skip$
'new.block
if$
}
%</!ay>
% \end{macrocode}
% \end{macro}
%
% \begin{macro}{`new.block.checkb'}
% \begin{macrocode}
FUNCTION {new.block.checkb}
{ empty$
swap$ empty$
and
'skip$
'new.block
if$
}
% \end{macrocode}
% \end{macro}
%
% \begin{macro}{`new.sentence.checka'}
% \begin{macrocode}
%<*!ay>
FUNCTION {new.sentence.checka}
{ empty$
'skip$
'new.sentence
if$
}
%</!ay>
% \end{macrocode}
% \end{macro}
%
% \begin{macro}{`new.sentence.checkb'}
% \begin{macrocode}
%<*!ay>
FUNCTION {new.sentence.checkb}
{ empty$
swap$ empty$
and
'skip$
'new.sentence
if$
}
%</!ay>
% \end{macrocode}
% \end{macro}
%
% \begin{macro}{`field.or.null'}
% \begin{macrocode}
FUNCTION {field.or.null}
{ duplicate$ empty$
{ pop$ "" }
'skip$
if$
}
% \end{macrocode}
% \end{macro}
%
% \begin{macro}{`emphasize'}
% Emphasis can be either italic or the alternating font. The font command
% may be NFSS or regular \LaTeX~2.09 declarations.
%\changes{1.3(2.1)}{1994 Jul 1}{Add \texttt{nfss} option}
%\changes{3.84}{1997 Oct 20}{Add \texttt{em-ul} option}
% \begin{macrocode}
FUNCTION {emphasize}
%<*!em-x>
{ duplicate$ empty$
{ pop$ "" }
%<html> { "<i>" swap$ * "</i>" * }
%<*!html>
%<em-ul> { "\uline{" swap$ * "}" * }
%<*!em-ul>
%<*!nfss>
%<!em-it> { "{\em " swap$ * "\/}" * }
%<em-it> { "{\it " swap$ * "\/}" * }
%</!nfss>
%<*nfss>
%<!em-it> { "\emph{" swap$ * "}" * }
%<em-it> { "\textit{" swap$ * "}" * }
%</nfss>
%</!em-ul>
%</!html>
if$
}
%</!em-x>
%<em-x>{ skip$ }
% \end{macrocode}
% \end{macro}
%
% \begin{macro}{`bolden'}
% The bold font command may be NFSS or the regular \LaTeX~2.09 declaration.
%\changes{1.3(2.1)}{1994 Jul 1}{Add \texttt{nfss} option}
% \begin{macrocode}
%<*nmft-bf|vol-bf|vol-2bf|lab-bf|dtbf>
FUNCTION {bolden}
{ duplicate$ empty$
{ pop$ "" }
%<html> { "<b>" swap$ * "</b>" * }
%<*!html>
%<!nfss> { "{\bf " swap$ * "}" * }
%<nfss> { "\textbf{" swap$ * "}" * }
%</!html>
if$
}
%</nmft-bf|vol-bf|vol-2bf|lab-bf|dtbf>
% \end{macrocode}
% \end{macro}
%
% \begin{macro}{`scaps'}
% To put text into small caps.
%\changes{3.0}{1995 Mar 3}{Add function}
% \begin{macrocode}
%<*lab-sc|nmft-sc>
FUNCTION {scaps}
{ duplicate$ empty$
{ pop$ "" }
%<html> { skip$ }
%<*!html>
%<!nfss> { "{\sc " swap$ * "}" * }
%<nfss> { "\textsc{" swap$ * "}" * }
%</!html>
if$
}
%</lab-sc|nmft-sc>
% \end{macrocode}
% \end{macro}
%
% \begin{macro}{`roman.list'}
% \changes{3.4}{1995 Sep 28}{Add function}
% \changes{3.85}{1998 Feb 6}{Remove function}
% \begin{macro}{`roman.cite'}
% \changes{3.8}{1996 Mar 16}{Add function}
% \changes{3.85}{1998 Feb 6}{Remove function}
% \end{macro}
% \end{macro}
%
% \begin{macro}{`bib.name.font'}
% \changes{3.85}{1998 Feb 6}{Add macro}
% \begin{macro}{`bib.fname.font'}
% \changes{3.85}{1998 Feb 6}{Add macro}
% \begin{macro}{`cite.name.font'}
% \changes{3.85}{1998 Feb 6}{Add macro}
% Define functions for formatting the author/editor names, one for the
% surnames (\texttt{bib.name.font}) and one for the first names
% (\texttt{bib.fname.font}). These could be identical, or the latter is
% deactivated if first names are not to be formatted, only the last names.
%
% For citations, we have \texttt{cite.name.font}. Here only surnames appear.
%
% It is also possible to have a user-defined font command for each, which the
% user must define in his work. These are |\bibnamefont{}| and |\bibfnamefont{}|,
% and some defaults are provided that simply repeat the arguments. Two commands
% are needed if \texttt{nmft-def} and \texttt{fnm-def} are both given.
%
% If neither \texttt{fnm-def} nor \texttt{fnm-rm} are given, then the first names
% are formatted the same as the surnames.
% \begin{macrocode}
%<*nmft>
FUNCTION {bib.name.font}
%<nmft-it>{ emphasize }
%<!nmft-it&nmft-bf>{ bolden }
%<!nmft-it&!nmft-bf&nmft-sc>{ scaps }
%<*!nmft-it&!nmft-bf&!nmft-sc&nmft-def>
{ duplicate$ empty$
{ pop$ "" }
%<!html> { "\bibnamefont{" swap$ * "}" * }
%<html> { skip$ }
if$
}
%</!nmft-it&!nmft-bf&!nmft-sc&nmft-def>
FUNCTION {bib.fname.font}
%<!fnm-rm&!fnm-def>{ bib.name.font }
%<fnm-rm>{ skip$ }
%<*!fnm-rm&fnm-def>
{ duplicate$ empty$
{ pop$ "" }
%<!html> { "\bibfnamefont{" swap$ * "}" * }
%<html> { skip$ }
if$
}
%</!fnm-rm&fnm-def>
%</nmft>
% \end{macrocode}
%
% \begin{macrocode}
%<*lab>
FUNCTION {cite.name.font}
%<lab-it>{ emphasize }
%<!lab-it&lab-bf>{ bolden }
%<!lab-it&!lab-bf&lab-sc>{ scaps }
%<*!lab-it&!lab-bf&!lab-sc&lab-def>
{ duplicate$ empty$
{ pop$ "" }
%<!html> { "\citenamefont{" swap$ * "}" * }
%<html> { skip$ }
if$
}
%</!lab-it&!lab-bf&!lab-sc&lab-def>
%</lab>
% \end{macrocode}
% \end{macro}
% \end{macro}
% \end{macro}
%
% \begin{macro}{`tie.or.space.prefix'}
% \changes{3.89d1}{1999 July 20}{AO: replace \texttt{tie.or.space.connect} with
% more flexible function}
% The function \texttt{tie.or.space.prefix} determines whether
% the top item on the stack requires a tie character and
% slips that (or a space character if not) ahead of it.
% At this point a font switch or other function can be applied to
% the top item on the stack, and the appropriate space found
% just ahead of it on the stack.
%
% The sequence \texttt{tie.or.space.prefix} \texttt{*} \texttt{*} is a common idiom
% for joining the top two stack objects with a tie or space
% depending on the length of the top object.
%
% Another idiom is to apply \texttt{tie.or.space.prefix}, apply a font switch,
% and then swap and join. In this case the tie or space follows the object.
% \begin{macrocode}
FUNCTION {tie.or.space.prefix}
{ duplicate$ text.length$ #3 <
{ "~" }
{ " " }
if$
swap$
}
% \end{macrocode}
% \end{macro}
%
% \begin{macro}{`capitalize'}
% \changes{3.0}{1995 Mar 7}{Add capitalizing function}
% Capitalizing is easy for regular languages, but for \texttt{babel},
% some trickery stuff is needed; definitions of |\capitalize| and
% |\Capitalize| are written to the \texttt{.bbl} file.
% \begin{macrocode}
FUNCTION {capitalize}
%<!babel>{ "u" change.case$ "t" change.case$ }
%<babel>{ "\capitalize" swap$ * }
% \end{macrocode}
% \end{macro}
%
% \begin{macro}{`space.word'}
% \changes{2.0}{1994 Jan 31}{Add function to space out words; necessary
% for the multilingual functions.}
% The function \texttt{space.word} adds a space before and after the word or
% words currently on the stack. This was added for the \texttt{bbl.}$nnn$
% functions, that contain only a word without spacing, but replace explicit
% text in the originals that were spaced out. Its seems more flexible to
% define the word functions to be without spacing.
% \begin{macrocode}
FUNCTION {space.word}
{ " " swap$ * " " * }
% \end{macrocode}
% \end{macro}
%
% \begin{macrocode}
% Here are the language-specific definitions for explicit words.
% Each function has a name bbl.xxx where xxx is the English word.
% \end{macrocode}
%
% \begin{macrocode}
%<*!exlang>
% \end{macrocode}
%
% \begin{macro}{`bbl.xxx'}
% \changes{2.0}{1994 Jan 31}{Replace all explicit words with functions
% of the form \texttt{bbl.xxx}.}
% \changes{3.6}{1996 Jan 15}{Add option \texttt{varand}}
% \changes{3.83}{1997 Feb 25}{Add option \texttt{ednx}}
% \changes{3.83}{1997 Jun 9}{Make \texttt{\char`\\BIBand} protected}
% \changes{3.87}{1998 Aug 17}{Add \texttt{bbl.etal}}
% \changes{3.89d1}{1999 July 20}{AO: add \texttt{bbl.eidpp}}
% These are the default English words. There is no default language
% option: one of \texttt{english} or \texttt{babel} must be given.
% \begin{macrocode}
%<*!babel>
% The language selected here is ENGLISH
FUNCTION {bbl.and}
%<!varand|html>{ "and"}
%<varand&!html>{ "\protect\BIBand{}"}
FUNCTION {bbl.etal}
{ "et~al." }
FUNCTION {bbl.editors}
%<!ed>{ "editors" }
%<ed>{ "eds." }
FUNCTION {bbl.editor}
%<!ed>{ "editor" }
%<ed>{ "ed." }
FUNCTION {bbl.edby}
{ "edited by" }
FUNCTION {bbl.edition}
%<!abr>{ "edition" }
%<abr&!ednx>{ "edn." }
%<abr&ednx>{ "ed." }
FUNCTION {bbl.volume}
%<!abr>{ "volume" }
%<abr>{ "vol." }
FUNCTION {bbl.of}
{ "of" }
FUNCTION {bbl.number}
%<!abr>{ "number" }
%<abr>{ "no." }
FUNCTION {bbl.nr}
{ "no." }
FUNCTION {bbl.in}
{ "in" }
FUNCTION {bbl.pages}
%<!pp&!ppx>{ "pages" }
%<pp>{ "pp." }
%<!pp&ppx>{ "" }
FUNCTION {bbl.page}
%<!pp&!ppx>{ "page" }
%<pp>{ "p." }
%<!pp&ppx>{ "" }
%<*revdata>
FUNCTION {bbl.eidpp}
{ "pages" }
%</revdata>
FUNCTION {bbl.chapter}
%<!abr>{ "chapter" }
%<abr>{ "chap." }
FUNCTION {bbl.techrep}
%<!abr>{ "Technical Report" }
%<abr>{ "Tech. Rep." }
FUNCTION {bbl.mthesis}
{ "Master's thesis" }
FUNCTION {bbl.phdthesis}
{ "Ph.D. thesis" }
%<*!xedn>
FUNCTION {bbl.first}
%<!ord>{ "First" }
%<ord>{ "1st" }
FUNCTION {bbl.second}
%<!ord>{ "Second" }
%<ord>{ "2nd" }
FUNCTION {bbl.third}
%<!ord>{ "Third" }
%<ord>{ "3rd" }
FUNCTION {bbl.fourth}
%<!ord>{ "Fourth" }
%<ord>{ "4th" }
FUNCTION {bbl.fifth}
%<!ord>{ "Fifth" }
%<ord>{ "5th" }
FUNCTION {bbl.st}
{ "st" }
FUNCTION {bbl.nd}
{ "nd" }
FUNCTION {bbl.rd}
{ "rd" }
FUNCTION {bbl.th}
{ "th" }
%</!xedn>
%<*!abr>
MACRO {jan} {"January"}
MACRO {feb} {"February"}
MACRO {mar} {"March"}
MACRO {apr} {"April"}
MACRO {may} {"May"}
MACRO {jun} {"June"}
MACRO {jul} {"July"}
MACRO {aug} {"August"}
MACRO {sep} {"September"}
MACRO {oct} {"October"}
MACRO {nov} {"November"}
MACRO {dec} {"December"}
%</!abr>
%<*abr>
MACRO {jan} {"Jan."}
MACRO {feb} {"Feb."}
MACRO {mar} {"Mar."}
MACRO {apr} {"Apr."}
MACRO {may} {"May"}
MACRO {jun} {"Jun."}
MACRO {jul} {"Jul."}
MACRO {aug} {"Aug."}
MACRO {sep} {"Sep."}
MACRO {oct} {"Oct."}
MACRO {nov} {"Nov."}
MACRO {dec} {"Dec."}
%</abr>
%</!babel>
% \end{macrocode}
%
% Here are the definitions for \texttt{babel} option, i.e., explicit
% translations are not used, but rather only \LaTeX{} macros that must be
% defined in the file \texttt{babelbst.tex}. This could allow automatic
% language selection.
% \begin{macrocode}
%<*babel>
% The BABEL language selection is made here; definitions in babelbst.tex.
FUNCTION {bbl.and}
{ "\bbland{}"}
FUNCTION {bbl.etal}
{ "\bbletal{}"}
FUNCTION {bbl.editors}
%<!ed>{ "\bbleditors{}" }
%<ed>{ "\bbleds{}" }
FUNCTION {bbl.editor}
%<!ed>{ "\bbleditor{}" }
%<ed>{ "\bbled{}" }
FUNCTION {bbl.edby}
{ "\bbledby{}" }
FUNCTION {bbl.edition}
%<!abr>{ "\bbledition{}" }
%<abr>{ "\bbledn{}" }
FUNCTION {bbl.volume}
%<!abr>{ "\bblvolume{}" }
%<abr>{ "\bblvol{}" }
FUNCTION {bbl.of}
{ "\bblof{}" }
FUNCTION {bbl.number}
%<!abr>{ "\bblnumber{}" }
%<abr>{ "\bblno{}" }
FUNCTION {bbl.nr}
{ "\bblno{}" }
FUNCTION {bbl.in}
{ "\bblin{}" }
FUNCTION {bbl.pages}
%<!pp&!ppx>{ "\bblpages{}" }
%<pp>{ "\bblpp{}" }
%<!pp&ppx>{ "" }
FUNCTION {bbl.page}
%<!pp&!ppx>{ "\bblpage{}" }
%<pp>{ "\bblp{}" }
%<!pp&ppx>{ "" }
FUNCTION {bbl.chapter}
%<!abr>{ "\bblchapter{}" }
%<abr>{ "\bblchap{}" }
FUNCTION {bbl.techrep}
%<!abr>{ "\bbltechreport{}" }
%<abr>{ "\bbltechrep{}" }
FUNCTION {bbl.mthesis}
{ "\bblmthesis{}" }
FUNCTION {bbl.phdthesis}
{ "\bblphdthesis{}" }
%<*revdata>
FUNCTION {bbl.eidpp}
{ "\bbleidpp{}" }
%</revdata>
%<*!xedn>
FUNCTION {bbl.first}
%<!ord>{ "\bblfirst{}" }
%<ord>{ "\bblfirsto{}" }
FUNCTION {bbl.second}
%<!ord>{ "\bblsecond{}" }
%<ord>{ "\bblsecondo{}" }
FUNCTION {bbl.third}
%<!ord>{ "\bblthird{}" }
%<ord>{ "\bblthirdo{}" }
FUNCTION {bbl.fourth}
%<!ord>{ "\bblfourth{}" }
%<ord>{ "\bblfourtho{}" }
FUNCTION {bbl.fifth}
%<!ord>{ "\bblfifth{}" }
%<ord>{ "\bblfiftho{}" }
FUNCTION {bbl.st}
{ "\bblst{}" }
FUNCTION {bbl.nd}
{ "\bblnd{}" }
FUNCTION {bbl.rd}
{ "\bblrd{}" }
FUNCTION {bbl.th}
{ "\bblth{}" }
%</!xedn>
MACRO {jan} {"\bbljan{}"}
MACRO {feb} {"\bblfeb{}"}
MACRO {mar} {"\bblmar{}"}
MACRO {apr} {"\bblapr{}"}
MACRO {may} {"\bblmay{}"}
MACRO {jun} {"\bbljun{}"}
MACRO {jul} {"\bbljul{}"}
MACRO {aug} {"\bblaug{}"}
MACRO {sep} {"\bblsep{}"}
MACRO {oct} {"\bbloct{}"}
MACRO {nov} {"\bblnov{}"}
MACRO {dec} {"\bbldec{}"}
%</babel>
% \end{macrocode}
%
% \begin{macro}{`eng.ord'}
% \changes{2.0}{1994 Jan 31}{Add function to format English ordinals.}
% This function adds English endings for ordinals 1, 2, 3. However, if
% the second last digit is 1, then the ending is `th' for all last digits.
% So far, all other languages included do not have this problem, and it is
% sufficient to add the \textsl{th} equivalent. This might change with further
% languages.
%
% This function must be included with \texttt{babel} too, since that includes
% English. This means that the language definition files must also provide
% for |\bblst|, |\bblnd|, and |\bblrd|, setting them all equal to |\bblth|.
%
% \begin{macrocode}
%<*(english|!exlang)&!xedn>
FUNCTION {eng.ord}
{ duplicate$ "1" swap$ *
#-2 #1 substring$ "1" =
{ bbl.th * }
{ duplicate$ #-1 #1 substring$
duplicate$ "1" =
{ pop$ bbl.st * }
{ duplicate$ "2" =
{ pop$ bbl.nd * }
{ "3" =
{ bbl.rd * }
{ bbl.th * }
if$
}
if$
}
if$
}
if$
}
%</(english|!exlang)&!xedn>
% \end{macrocode}
% \end{macro}
%
% \begin{macrocode}
%</!exlang>
% \end{macrocode}
%
% \begin{macrocode}
%</!tail>
% \end{macrocode}
%
% \begin{macrocode}
%<*!head>
% \end{macrocode}
% \end{macro}
%
% \begin{macrocode}
%<*!jabr>
MACRO {acmcs} {"ACM Computing Surveys"}
MACRO {acta} {"Acta Informatica"}
MACRO {cacm} {"Communications of the ACM"}
MACRO {ibmjrd} {"IBM Journal of Research and Development"}
MACRO {ibmsj} {"IBM Systems Journal"}
MACRO {ieeese} {"IEEE Transactions on Software Engineering"}
MACRO {ieeetc} {"IEEE Transactions on Computers"}
MACRO {ieeetcad}
{"IEEE Transactions on Computer-Aided Design of Integrated Circuits"}
MACRO {ipl} {"Information Processing Letters"}
MACRO {jacm} {"Journal of the ACM"}
MACRO {jcss} {"Journal of Computer and System Sciences"}
MACRO {scp} {"Science of Computer Programming"}
MACRO {sicomp} {"SIAM Journal on Computing"}
MACRO {tocs} {"ACM Transactions on Computer Systems"}
MACRO {tods} {"ACM Transactions on Database Systems"}
MACRO {tog} {"ACM Transactions on Graphics"}
MACRO {toms} {"ACM Transactions on Mathematical Software"}
MACRO {toois} {"ACM Transactions on Office Information Systems"}
MACRO {toplas} {"ACM Transactions on Programming Languages and Systems"}
MACRO {tcs} {"Theoretical Computer Science"}
%</!jabr>
% \end{macrocode}
%
% \changes{4.00}{1999 Oct 8}{Revise journal abbreviations}
% Journal abbreviations have been revised from the original Patashnik
% ones with help of Conrado Badenas and the IUA recommendations.
% \begin{macrocode}
%<*jabr>
MACRO {acmcs} {"ACM Comput. Surv."}
MACRO {acta} {"Acta Inf."}
MACRO {cacm} {"Commun. ACM"}
MACRO {ibmjrd} {"IBM J. Res. Dev."}
MACRO {ibmsj} {"IBM Syst.~J."}
MACRO {ieeese} {"IEEE Trans. Software Eng."}
MACRO {ieeetc} {"IEEE Trans. Comput."}
MACRO {ieeetcad}
{"IEEE Trans. Comput. Aid. Des."}
MACRO {ipl} {"Inf. Process. Lett."}
MACRO {jacm} {"J.~ACM"}
MACRO {jcss} {"J.~Comput. Syst. Sci."}
MACRO {scp} {"Sci. Comput. Program."}
MACRO {sicomp} {"SIAM J. Comput."}
MACRO {tocs} {"ACM Trans. Comput. Syst."}
MACRO {tods} {"ACM Trans. Database Syst."}
MACRO {tog} {"ACM Trans. Graphic."}
MACRO {toms} {"ACM Trans. Math. Software"}
MACRO {toois} {"ACM Trans. Office Inf. Syst."}
MACRO {toplas} {"ACM Trans. Progr. Lang. Syst."}
MACRO {tcs} {"Theor. Comput. Sci."}
%</jabr>
% \end{macrocode}
%
% \begin{macro}{`bibinfo.check'}
% \changes{3.89d1}{1999 July 20}{AO:
% add functions \texttt{bibinfo.check}, \texttt{bibinfo.warn},
% and \texttt{format.eprint}}
% Define functions that encapsulate the argument
% in a \TeX\ macro that allows for further processing when the
% bibliography is processed, or allows for a separate computer
% program to parse the |\bibitem| contents.
%
% The following table summarizes how each of the \btx{} entries
% is accessed for output; these are the points where
% the \texttt{format.bibinfo} or \texttt{bibinfo.check} functions
% are called.
% \subsubsection*{Trapped via \texttt{format.bibinfo}}
% \begin{description}
% \item[ \texttt{author} ]\texttt{format.names}
% \item[ \texttt{collaboration} ]\texttt{format.authors}
% \item[ \texttt{doi} ]\texttt{format.doi}
% \item[ \texttt{editor} ]\texttt{format.editors} (\texttt{book}, \texttt{inbook}, \texttt{proceedings}), \texttt{format.names.ed} (\texttt{format.in.ed.booktitle})
% \item[ \texttt{eid} ]\texttt{format.journal.eid} (\texttt{format.vol.num.pages}, article) checks the output from \texttt{format.journal.pages}
% \item[ \texttt{isbn} ]\texttt{format.isbn}
% \item[ \texttt{issn} ]\texttt{format.issn}
% \item[ \texttt{journal} ]\texttt{format.article.crossref}, article
% \item[ \texttt{numpages} ]\texttt{format.journal.eid}
% \item[ \texttt{organization} ]\texttt{format.organization.address} (\texttt{inproceedings}, \texttt{proceedings}), \texttt{manual}
% \item[ \texttt{pages} ]\texttt{format.book}.pages (\texttt{book}, \texttt{booklet}), \texttt{format.pages} (\texttt{format.journal.pages}, \texttt{format.chapter.pages}, \texttt{article}, \texttt{inbook}, \texttt{incollection}, \texttt{inproceedings})
% \item[ \texttt{publisher} ]\texttt{format.publisher.address} (like \texttt{output.check}, \texttt{inproceedings}, \texttt{proceedings})
% \item[ \texttt{title} ]\texttt{format.title}, \texttt{format.btitle}, \texttt{misc}, \texttt{presort}, \texttt{bib.sort.order}
% \item[ \texttt{volume} ]\texttt{format.bvolume}, \texttt{format.vol.num.pages}, \texttt{format.book.crossref}
% \item[ \texttt{year} ]in optional argument of \texttt{\char`\\bibitem}, \texttt{format.date} (as part of date), \texttt{format.year}, \texttt{format.org.or.pub}
% \item[ \texttt{booktitle} ]\texttt{format.in.ed.booktitle} (\texttt{incollection}, \texttt{inproceedings}), \texttt{format.incoll.inproc.crossref}
% \item[ \texttt{howpublished} ]\texttt{booklet}, \texttt{misc}
% \item[ \texttt{edition} ]\texttt{convert.edition.format.edition}
% \item[ \texttt{institution} ]\texttt{techreport}
% \item[ \texttt{school} ]\texttt{mastersthesis}, \texttt{phdthesis}
% \item[ \texttt{address} ]\texttt{format.org.or.pub}, \texttt{booklet}, \texttt{manual}, \texttt{mastersthesis}, \texttt{phdthesis}, \texttt{techreport}
% \item[ \texttt{chapter} ]\texttt{format.chapter.pages}
% \item[ \texttt{number} ]\texttt{format.number.series}, \texttt{format.vol.num.pages}, \texttt{format.tr.number}
% \item[ \texttt{series} ]\texttt{format.bvolume}, \texttt{format.number.series}, \texttt{format.book.crossref}
% \item[ \texttt{type} ]\texttt{format.chapter.pages}, \texttt{format.thesis.type}, \texttt{format.tr.number}
% \item[ \texttt{month} ]\texttt{format.date}
% \item[ \texttt{note} ]\texttt{format.note}
% \item[ \texttt{annote} ]\texttt{fin.entry}
% \end{description}
%
% \subsubsection*{Encapsulated via \texttt{\char`\\url}}
% \begin{description}
% \item[ \texttt{url} ]\texttt{format.url} (\texttt{\char`\\harvardurl}, \texttt{\char`\\url}), \texttt{format.url} (\texttt{\char`\\url}), \texttt{format.note} (\texttt{\char`\\url})
% \end{description}
%
% \subsubsection*{Encapsulated via \texttt{\char`\\eprint}}
% \begin{description}
% \item[ \texttt{eprint} ]\texttt{format.eprint}
% \item[ \texttt{archive} ]\texttt{format.eprint}
% \end{description}
%
% \subsubsection*{Not encapsulated:}
% \begin{description}
% \item[ \texttt{key} ]cite key
% \item[ \texttt{language} ]operand of \texttt{\char`\\selectlanguage}
% \end{description}
%
% \subsubsection*{\texttt{bibinfo} tag, but not a \btx{} field}
% \begin{description}
% \item[ \texttt{date} ]\texttt{format.date}
% \end{description}
%
% Provides robust access to fields, checking against \texttt{missing\$}
% and \texttt{empty\$}. A \dtx{} option allows giving
% a warning if either is the case.
%
% If not, it encapsulates the argument in a \TeX\ macro |\bibinfo|.
% The encapsulation is enabled by the \texttt{bibinfo} \dtx{} option:
% if turned off, it simply pops the unneeded object.
%
% \texttt{field} \texttt{string} \texttt{->} \texttt{encapsulated-field}
%
% \texttt{empty} \texttt{string} \texttt{->} \texttt{empty}
% Side effect: warning.
% \begin{macrocode}
FUNCTION {bibinfo.check}
{ swap$
duplicate$ missing$
{
%<bibinfo.warning> swap$ "missing " swap$ * " in " * cite$ * warning$ pop$
%<!bibinfo.warning> pop$ pop$
""
}
{ duplicate$ empty$
{
%<bibinfo.warning> swap$ "empty " swap$ * " in " * cite$ * warning$
%<!bibinfo.warning> swap$ pop$
}
{ swap$
%<bibinfo> "\bibinfo{" swap$ * "}{" * swap$ * "}" *
%<!bibinfo> pop$
}
if$
}
if$
}
% \end{macrocode}
% \end{macro}
%
% \begin{macro}{`bibinfo.warn'}
% Replaces \texttt{output.check}
% with \texttt{bibinfo.warn} followed by \texttt{output}.
%
% \texttt{field} \texttt{string} \texttt{->} \texttt{encapsulated-field}
%
% \texttt{empty} \texttt{string} \texttt{->} \texttt{empty}
%
% Side effect: warning if the field is empty.
% Note: if the \dtx{} option \texttt{bibinfo} is not in effect,
% then no encapsulation is done.
% \begin{macrocode}
FUNCTION {bibinfo.warn}
{ swap$
duplicate$ missing$
{
swap$ "missing " swap$ * " in " * cite$ * warning$ pop$
""
}
{ duplicate$ empty$
{
swap$ "empty " swap$ * " in " * cite$ * warning$
}
{ swap$
%<bibinfo> "\bibinfo{" swap$ * "}{" * swap$ * "}" *
%<!bibinfo> pop$
}
if$
}
if$
}
% \end{macrocode}
% \end{macro}
%
% \begin{macro}{`format.eprint'}
% \changes{4.00}{2000 Jan 21}{Add optional archive field}
% The access function for the \texttt{eprint} field.
%
% If the \texttt{bibinfo} \dtx{} option is selected, then this function
% encapsulates the argument in a \TeX\ macro |\eprint|.
%
% \texttt{->} \texttt{encapsulated-URL}
% \begin{macrocode}
%<*eprint>
FUNCTION {format.eprint}
{ eprint duplicate$ empty$
'skip$
{ "\eprint"
archive empty$
'skip$
{ "[" * archive * "]" * }
if$
"{" * swap$ * "}" *
}
if$
}
%</eprint>
% \end{macrocode}
% \end{macro}
%
% \begin{macro}{`write.url'}
% \changes{1.5(2.3)}{1994 Sep 16}{Add \texttt{write.url} for option
% \texttt{harnm}}
% \changes{3.87}{1998 Jul 23}{Apply to non-Harvard styles}
% \changes{4.03}{2002 Jan 14}{Fix bug when both harnm and url-nl given}
% This function taken over from \texttt{agsm.sty}, the main \texttt{harvard}
% bib style. For non-Harvard styles that want to add the URL on a new line
% after the reference, use this function too, but defined slightly
% differently.
% \begin{macrocode}
%<*(harnm|url-nl)&!revdata>
FUNCTION {write.url}
%<*!html>
{ url empty$
{ skip$ }
%<harnm> { "\newline\harvardurl{" url * "}" * write$ newline$ }
%<!harnm&url-nl> { "\newline\urlprefix\url{" url * "}" * write$ newline$ }
if$
}
%</!html>
%<*html>
{ url empty$
{ skip$ }
{ "<br><a href=" quote$ * url * quote$
* ">" * url * "</a>" * write$ newline$ }
if$
}
%</html>
%</(harnm|url-nl)&!revdata>
% \end{macrocode}
% \end{macro}
%
% \begin{macro}{`format.url'}
% \changes{3.87}{1998 Jul 22}{Add function for regular URLs}
% A non-harvard version of URL is also made for regular styles.
% This is used only if the URL text is added as a regular item to the
% reference information, blocked if necessary. Alternatives are on a new line
% (Harvard-like) or in the note.
% \begin{macrocode}
%<*(url-blk&!harnm)|revdata>
FUNCTION {format.url}
{ url empty$
{ "" }
%<!html> { "\urlprefix\url{" url * "}" * }
%<html> { "<a href=" quote$ * url * quote$
%<html> * ">" * url * "</a>" * }
if$
}
%</(url-blk&!harnm)|revdata>
% \end{macrocode}
% \end{macro}
%
% \begin{macro}{`format.names'}
% \changes{1.5(2.3)}{1994 Sep 16}{Add \texttt{harvard} command for `and' with
% new option \texttt{harnm}}
% \changes{3.0}{1995 Feb 27}{Add option \texttt{nm-revf}}
% \changes{3.0}{1995 Mar 15}{Add option \texttt{nm-rvx}}
% \changes{3.2}{1995 Jun 7}{Add option \texttt{nm-rvv}}
% \changes{3.6}{1995 Dec 7}{Jr to go at end with \texttt{nm-rev1} (AGU style)}
% \changes{3.6}{1995 Dec 8}{Add option \texttt{nmand-rm}}
% \changes{3.6}{1996 Jan 30}{Add option \texttt{etal-rm}}
% \changes{3.7}{1996 Feb 5}{Add option \texttt{aunm-semi}}
% \changes{3.82}{1996 Dec 16}{Add option \texttt{nm-revv1} (AGU style with full
% names)}
% \changes{3.85}{1996 Feb 6}{Recode author font; allow first names different}
% \changes{3.88}{1999 Feb 25}{Add option \texttt{aunm-sl}}
% \changes{3.89}{1999 May 20}{Reset \texttt{t}; might still be ``others''
% from last format function}
% \changes{3.89d1}{1999 July 20}{AO: encapsulate author name for later processing;
% trap empty author list;
% bring common braces to outer level for easier understanding of code.}
% \changes{4.00}{1999 Oct 7}{Add option \texttt{jnrlst} to put Jr. last}
% \changes{4.13}{2004 Feb 9}{Add option \texttt{nm-rvcx}}
% The \texttt{harvard} package now (version 2.0.3, for \LaTeXe) uses
% |\harvardand| in place of the word \textsl{and} so that it can be changed
% at run time. This is allowed for with the option \texttt{harnm}, which
% need not be used only with the \texttt{har} option.
% This seems like a useless feature for \texttt{.bst} files made from
% this multilanguage source. However, it is included anyway, which means
% if \texttt{harnm} option selected, one must redefine |\harvardand|
% in the document for the language being used.
%
% The location of the junior part for reversed name is not obvious. Prior
% to version 4.0, I always had it attached to the last name, as
% Smith, Jr, John, put it probably is better as Smith, John, Jr. For the
% AGU \texttt{nm-rev1} I always did it this way, probably because I had a
% good AGU example to follow. Dilemma: do I just change them all or add an
% option to do it? The option will maintain consistency with older
% versions, but this could also be considered a bug fix rather than a new
% feature. Solution: use the option, since I have found other \texttt{.bst}
% files from Beebe and Harvard that put junior between surname and first
% name.
%
% |bibinfo| is a variable used to store a string telling it whether the
% names being formatted are authors or editors, since this function is called
% for both purposes. Every call to this function must push the string onto the stack
% just before the call.
% \begin{macrocode}
STRINGS { bibinfo}
INTEGERS { nameptr namesleft numnames }
% \end{macrocode}
%
% Stack note: if the names argument is a non-nil list, this function returns
% one object on the stack, the formatted list of names.
%
% \texttt{names`string} \texttt{bibinfo`string} \texttt{->} \texttt{author-list`string}
% \begin{macrocode}
FUNCTION {format.names}
{ 'bibinfo :=
duplicate$ empty$ 'skip$ {
's :=
"" 't :=
#1 'nameptr :=
s num.names$ 'numnames :=
numnames 'namesleft :=
{ namesleft #0 > }
{ s nameptr
% \end{macrocode}
% Here is the author formatting when the names are not set in any special
% font, or when the entire name set in a single special font.
% \begin{macrocode}
%<*!(nmft&(fnm-rm|fnm-def))>
%<*!nm-rev1&!nm-revv1>
%<nm-init> "{f.~}{vv~}{ll}{, jj}"
%<*!nm-init>
%<nm-rev&!jnrlst> "{vv~}{ll}{, jj}{, f.}"
%<nm-rev&jnrlst> "{vv~}{ll}{, f.}{, jj}"
%<*!nm-rev>
%<nm-rv&!jnrlst> "{vv~}{ll}{ jj}{ f{~}}"
%<nm-rv&jnrlst> "{vv~}{ll}{ f{~}}{ jj}"
%<*!nm-rv>
%<nm-rvx&!jnrlst> "{vv~}{ll}{ jj}{ f{}}"
%<nm-rvx&jnrlst> "{vv~}{ll}{ f{}}{ jj}"
%<*!nm-rvx>
%<nm-rvcx&!jnrlst> "{vv~}{ll}{, jj}{, f{}}"
%<nm-rvcx&jnrlst> "{vv~}{ll}{, f{}}{, jj}"
%<*!nm-rvcx>
%<nm-rvv&!jnrlst> "{vv~}{ll}{ jj}{ f{.}.}"
%<nm-rvv&jnrlst> "{vv~}{ll}{ f{.}.}{ jj}"
%<*!nm-rvv>
%<nm-revf&!jnrlst> "{vv~}{ll}{, jj}{, ff}"
%<nm-revf&jnrlst> "{vv~}{ll}{, ff}{, jj}"
%<*!nm-revf>
"{ff~}{vv~}{ll}{, jj}"
%</!nm-revf>
%</!nm-rvv>
%</!nm-rvcx>
%</!nm-rvx>
%</!nm-rv>
%</!nm-rev>
%</!nm-init>
%</!nm-rev1&!nm-revv1>
%<*nm-rev1>
duplicate$ #1 >
{ "{f.~}{vv~}{ll}{, jj}" }
%<!jnrlst> { "{vv~}{ll}{, jj}{, f.}" }
%<jnrlst> { "{vv~}{ll}{, f.}{, jj}" }
if$
%</nm-rev1>
%<*!nm-rev1&nm-revv1>
duplicate$ #1 >
{ "{ff~}{vv~}{ll}{, jj}" }
%<!jnrlst> { "{vv~}{ll}{, jj}{, ff}" }
%<jnrlst> { "{vv~}{ll}{, ff}{, jj}" }
if$
%</!nm-rev1&nm-revv1>
format.name$
%<nm-rv|nm-rvx> remove.dots
%<nmft&nmand-rm> bib.name.font
%</!(nmft&(fnm-rm|fnm-def))>
% \end{macrocode}
% Here is the author formatting when the first and last names are
% set in (possibly different) special fonts.
%
% \changes{4.00}{1999 Oct 7}{Junior part always in first name font}
% The junior part is optionally between the reversed names, or after them.
% \begin{macrocode}
%<*nmft&(fnm-rm|fnm-def)>
%<*!nm-rev1&!nm-revv1>
%<*nm-init>
"{f.}" format.name$ duplicate$ empty$ 'skip$
{ tie.or.space.prefix bib.fname.font swap$ * }
if$
s nameptr
"{vv~}{ll}" format.name$ bib.name.font *
s nameptr
"{jj}" format.name$ duplicate$ empty$ 'skip$
{ bib.fname.font ", " swap$ * }
if$
%</nm-init>
%<*!nm-init>
%<*nm-rev>
"{vv~}{ll}" format.name$ bib.name.font
s nameptr
%<!jnrlst> "{jj, }{f.}"
%<jnrlst> "{f.}{, jj}"
format.name$ duplicate$ empty$ 'skip$
{ bib.fname.font ", " swap$ * }
if$
%</nm-rev>
%<*!nm-rev>
%<*nm-rv>
"{vv~}{ll}" format.name$ bib.name.font
s nameptr
%<!jnrlst> "{jj }{f{~}}"
%<jnrlst> "{f{~}}{ jj}"
format.name$ duplicate$ empty$ 'skip$
{ remove.dots bib.fname.font " " swap$ * }
if$
%</nm-rv>
%<*!nm-rv>
%<*nm-rvx>
"{vv~}{ll}" format.name$ bib.name.font
s nameptr
%<!jnrlst> "{jj }{f{}}"
%<jnrlst> "{f{}}{ jj}"
format.name$ duplicate$ empty$ 'skip$
{ remove.dots bib.fname.font " " swap$ * }
if$
%</nm-rvx>
%<*!nm-rvx>
%<*nm-rvcx>
"{vv~}{ll}" format.name$ bib.name.font
s nameptr
%<!jnrlst> "{jj, }{f{}}"
%<jnrlst> "{f{}}{, jj}"
format.name$ duplicate$ empty$ 'skip$
{ remove.dots bib.fname.font ", " swap$ * }
if$
%</nm-rvcx>
%<*!nm-rvcx>
%<*nm-rvv>
"{vv~}{ll}" format.name$ bib.name.font
s nameptr
%<!jnrlst> "{jj }{f{.}.}"
%<jnrlst> "{f{.}.}{ jj}"
format.name$ duplicate$ empty$ 'skip$
{ bib.fname.font " " swap$ * }
if$
%</nm-rvv>
%<*!nm-rvv>
%<*nm-revf>
"{vv~}{ll}" format.name$ bib.name.font
s nameptr
%<!jnrlst> "{jj, }{ff}"
%<jnrlst> "{ff}{, jj}"
format.name$ duplicate$ empty$ 'skip$
{ bib.fname.font ", " swap$ * }
if$
%</nm-revf>
%<*!nm-revf>
"{ff}" format.name$ duplicate$ empty$ 'skip$
{ tie.or.space.prefix bib.fname.font swap$ * }
if$
s nameptr
"{vv~}{ll}" format.name$ bib.name.font *
s nameptr
"{jj}" format.name$ duplicate$ empty$ 'skip$
{ bib.fname.font ", " swap$ * }
if$
%</!nm-revf>
%</!nm-rvv>
%</!nm-rvcx>
%</!nm-rvx>
%</!nm-rv>
%</!nm-rev>
%</!nm-init>
%</!nm-rev1&!nm-revv1>
%<*nm-rev1>
nameptr #1 >
{ "{f.}" format.name$ duplicate$ empty$ 'skip$
{ tie.or.space.prefix bib.fname.font swap$ * }
if$
s nameptr
"{vv~}{ll}" format.name$ bib.name.font *
s nameptr
"{jj}" format.name$ duplicate$ empty$ 'skip$
{ bib.fname.font ", " swap$ * }
if$
}
{ "{vv~}{ll}" format.name$ bib.name.font
s nameptr
%<!jnrlst> "{jj, }{f.}"
%<jnrlst> "{f.}{, jj}"
format.name$ duplicate$ empty$ 'skip$
{ bib.fname.font ", " swap$ * }
if$
}
if$
%</nm-rev1>
%<*!nm-rev1&nm-revv1>
nameptr #1 >
{ "{ff}" format.name$ duplicate$ empty$ 'skip$
{ tie.or.space.prefix bib.fname.font swap$ * }
if$
s nameptr
"{vv~}{ll}" format.name$ bib.name.font *
s nameptr
"{jj}" format.name$ duplicate$ empty$ 'skip$
{ bib.fname.font ", " swap$ * }
if$
}
{ "{vv~}{ll}" format.name$ bib.name.font
s nameptr
%<!jnrlst> "{jj, }{ff}"
%<jnrlst> "{ff}{, jj}"
format.name$ duplicate$ empty$ 'skip$
{ bib.fname.font ", " swap$ * }
if$
}
if$
%</!nm-rev1&nm-revv1>
*
%</nmft&(fnm-rm|fnm-def)>
bibinfo bibinfo.check
't :=
nameptr #1 >
{
%<*nmlm>
%<m1> nameptr #1
%<m2> nameptr #2
%<m3> nameptr #3
%<m4> nameptr #4
%<m5> nameptr #5
%<m6> nameptr #6
%<m7> nameptr #7
%<m8> nameptr #8
%<m9> nameptr #9
%<m0> nameptr #0
%<m10> #10 +
%<m20> #20 +
%<m30> #30 +
%<m40> #40 +
%<m50> #50 +
%<m60> #60 +
%<m70> #70 +
%<m80> #80 +
%<m90> #90 +
#1 + =
%<x1> numnames #1
%<x2> numnames #2
%<x3> numnames #3
%<x4> numnames #4
%<x5> numnames #5
%<x6> numnames #6
%<x7> numnames #7
%<x8> numnames #8
%<x9> numnames #9
%<x0> numnames #0
%<x10> #10 +
%<x20> #20 +
%<x30> #30 +
%<x40> #40 +
%<x50> #50 +
%<x60> #60 +
%<x70> #70 +
%<x80> #80 +
%<x90> #90 +
> and
{ "others" 't :=
#1 'namesleft := }
'skip$
if$
%</nmlm>
namesleft #1 >
%<!aunm-semi&!aunm-sl> { ", " * t * }
%<aunm-semi> { "; " * t * }
%<aunm-sl&!aunm-semi> { "/ " * t * }
{
%<(and-com|xand)&!aunm-semi&!aunm-sl> "," *
%<(and-com|xand)&aunm-semi> ";" *
%<(and-com|xand)&aunm-sl&!aunm-semi> "/" *
%<*!and-xcom&!and-com&!xand>
numnames #2 >
%<!aunm-semi&!aunm-sl> { "," * }
%<aunm-semi> { ";" * }
%<aunm-sl&!aunm-semi> { "/" * }
'skip$
if$
%</!and-xcom&!and-com&!xand>
s nameptr "{ll}" format.name$ duplicate$ "others" =
{ 't := }
{ pop$ }
if$
t "others" =
{
%<nmft&!nmand-rm&!(fnm-rm|fnm-def)&(etal-it|etal-rm)> bib.name.font
%<*!etal-it>
%<nmft&(nmand-rm|(fnm-rm|fnm-def))&!etal-rm> " " * bbl.etal bib.name.font *
%<!(nmft&(nmand-rm|(fnm-rm|fnm-def)))|etal-rm> " " * bbl.etal *
%</!etal-it>
%<etal-it> " " * bbl.etal emphasize *
%<nmft&!nmand-rm&!(fnm-rm|fnm-def)&!(etal-it|etal-rm)> bib.name.font
}
%<*!xand>
{
%<*!harnm>
%<!amper> bbl.and
%<amper> "\&"
%</!harnm>
%<harnm> "\harvardand{}"
%<nmft&!nmand-rm&(fnm-rm|fnm-def)> bib.name.font
space.word * t *
}
%</!xand>
%<xand> { " " * t * }
if$
}
if$
}
't
if$
nameptr #1 + 'nameptr :=
namesleft #1 - 'namesleft :=
}
while$
%<*nmft&!nmand-rm&!(fnm-rm|fnm-def)>
t "others" =
'skip$
{ bib.name.font }
if$
%</nmft&!nmand-rm&!(fnm-rm|fnm-def)>
} if$
}
% \end{macrocode}
% \end{macro}
%
% \begin{macro}{`format.names.ed'}
% \changes{1.6(2.4)}{1995 Feb 2}{Add option \texttt{ed-rev} to allow editor
% to be formatted just like authors'}
% \changes{3.0}{1995 Feb 27}{Option \texttt{nm-revf} to act just as default}
% \changes{3.83}{1997 Feb 25}{Add option \texttt{and-com-ed} to replace
% \texttt{and-com} for collection editors}
% \changes{3.85}{1996 Feb 6}{Recode author font; allow first names different}
% \changes{3.88}{1999 Feb 25}{Add option \texttt{ed-au}, synonomous with
% \texttt{ed-rev}}
% \changes{3.88}{1999 Mar 18}{Bug fix: \texttt{and-com-ed} used correctly}
% \changes{3.89d1}{1999 July 20}{AO: encapsulate editor for later processing;
% trap empty editor list}
% When editors are used in place of authors to identify the work, the
% names are always formatted just like authors'. However, in collections,
% where ``edited by'' or ``\emph{names} (editors)'' are given, it is
% normal not to reverse the names, even if the authors' are. The option
% \texttt{ed-rev} sees to it that editor names are always formatted exactly
% like those of authors, being reversed if necessary.
%
% The option \texttt{ed-au} is identical to \texttt{ed-rev}, but is more
% logical. It means editors (in incollections) are formatted exactly like
% authors, with all the font, reversing, and number limitations. This is
% selected automatically with \texttt{nm-init} and \texttt{nm-} default to save
% programming memory.
%
% The option \texttt{nm-revf} in this case acts the same as the default
% when no \texttt{nm-} option given: full names with surname last. Therefore
% it is not necessary to test for it at all, since it, like the default,
% has the lowest priority: any other \texttt{nm-} option clobbers it.
%
% The options \texttt{aunm-semi} and \texttt{aunm-sl} will put a semi-colon or
% slash between editor names, just as for authors, when \texttt{ed-rev} not
% selected, in keeping with the idea that in this case both authors and editors
% are to be formatted the same.
%
% This function either dispatches to \texttt{format.names} or executes code
% which is similar. In the latter case, names are always presented first
% followed by surname (``last name''); name limit processing (\texttt{nmlm}) is not executed;
% and endgame processing differs in being qualified by \texttt{nmfted}.
%
% Stack note: if the names (second) argument is a non-nil list, this function returns
% with one object on the stack, the formatted list of names.
%
% \texttt{names`string} \texttt{bibinfo`string} \texttt{->} \texttt{author-list`string}
% \begin{macrocode}
FUNCTION {format.names.ed}
{
%<ed-rev|ed-au> format.names
%<*!ed-rev&!ed-au>
'bibinfo :=
duplicate$ empty$ 'skip$ {
's :=
"" 't :=
#1 'nameptr :=
s num.names$ 'numnames :=
numnames 'namesleft :=
{ namesleft #0 > }
{ s nameptr
% \end{macrocode}
% Editor name is handled as a single object, with no separation of first and last name.
% \begin{macrocode}
%<*!(nmft&nmfted&(fnm-rm|fnm-def))>
%<nm-init|nm-rev|nm-rev1> "{f.~}{vv~}{ll}{, jj}"
%<*!nm-init&!nm-rev&!nm-rev1>
%<nm-revv1> "{ff~}{vv~}{ll}{, jj}"
%<*!nm-revv1>
%<nm-rv> "{f{~}~}{vv~}{ll}{ jj}"
%<*!nm-rv>
%<nm-rvx> "{f{}~}{vv~}{ll}{ jj}"
%<*!nm-rvx>
%<nm-rvcx> "{f{}~}{vv~}{ll}{ jj}"
%<*!nm-rvcx>
%<nm-rvv> "{f{.}.~}{vv~}{ll}{ jj}"
%<*!nm-rvv>
"{ff~}{vv~}{ll}{, jj}"
%</!nm-rvv>
%</!nm-rvcx>
%</!nm-rvx>
%</!nm-rv>
%</!nm-revv1>
%</!nm-init&!nm-rev&!nm-rev1>
format.name$
%<nm-rv|nm-rvx|nm-rvcx> remove.dots
%<nmft&nmfted&nmand-rm> bib.name.font
%</!(nmft&nmfted&(fnm-rm|fnm-def))>
% \end{macrocode}
% Editor first and last name handled separately.
% \begin{macrocode}
%<*(nmft&nmfted&(fnm-rm|fnm-def))>
%<*nm-init|nm-rev|nm-rev1>
"{f.}" format.name$ duplicate$ empty$ 'skip$
{ tie.or.space.prefix bib.fname.font swap$ * }
if$
s nameptr
"{vv~}{ll}" format.name$ bib.name.font *
s nameptr
"{jj}" format.name$ duplicate$ empty$ 'skip$
{ bib.fname.font ", " swap$ * }
if$
%</nm-init|nm-rev|nm-rev1>
%<*!nm-init&!nm-rev&!nm-rev1>
%<*nm-revv1>
"{ff}" format.name$ duplicate$ empty$ 'skip$
{ tie.or.space.prefix bib.fname.font swap$ * }
if$
s nameptr
"{vv~}{ll}" format.name$ bib.name.font *
s nameptr
"{jj}" format.name$ duplicate$ empty$ 'skip$
{ bib.fname.font ", " swap$ * }
if$
%</nm-revv1>
%<*!nm-revv1>
%<*nm-rv>
"{f{~}}" format.name$ duplicate$ empty$ 'skip$
{ tie.or.space.prefix bib.fname.font swap$ * }
if$
s nameptr
"{vv~}{ll}" format.name$ bib.name.font *
s nameptr
"{jj}" format.name$ duplicate$ empty$ 'skip$
{ remove.dots bib.fname.font " " swap$ * }
if$
%</nm-rv>
%<*!nm-rv>
%<*nm-rvx|nm-rvcx>
"{f{}}" format.name$ duplicate$ empty$ 'skip$
{ tie.or.space.prefix bib.fname.font swap$ * }
if$
s nameptr
"{vv~}{ll}" format.name$ bib.name.font *
s nameptr
"{jj}" format.name$ duplicate$ empty$ 'skip$
{ remove.dots bib.fname.font " " swap$ * }
if$
%</nm-rvx|nm-rvcx>
%<*!nm-rvx&!nm-rvcx>
%<*nm-rvv>
"{f{.}.}" format.name$ duplicate$ empty$ 'skip$
{ tie.or.space.prefix bib.fname.font swap$ * }
if$
s nameptr
"{vv~}{ll}" format.name$ bib.name.font *
s nameptr
"{jj}" format.name$ duplicate$ empty$ 'skip$
{ bib.fname.font " " swap$ * }
if$
%</nm-rvv>
%<*!nm-rvv>
"{ff}" format.name$ duplicate$ empty$ 'skip$
{ tie.or.space.prefix bib.fname.font swap$ * }
if$
s nameptr
"{vv~}{ll}" format.name$ bib.name.font *
s nameptr
"{jj}" format.name$ duplicate$ empty$ 'skip$
{ bib.fname.font ", " swap$ * }
if$
%</!nm-rvv>
%</!nm-rvx&!nm-rvcx>
%</!nm-rv>
%</!nm-revv1>
%</!nm-init&!nm-rev&!nm-rev1>
*
%</(nmft&nmfted&(fnm-rm|fnm-def))>
bibinfo bibinfo.check
't :=
nameptr #1 >
{
namesleft #1 >
%<!aunm-semi&!aunm-sl> { ", " * t * }
%<aunm-semi> { "; " * t * }
%<aunm-sl&!aunm-semi> { "/ " * t * }
{
%<(and-com-ed|xand)&!aunm-semi&!aunm-sl> "," *
%<(and-com-ed|xand)&aunm-semi> ";" *
%<(and-com-ed|xand)&aunm-sl&!aunm-semi> "/" *
%<*!and-xcom&!and-com-ed&!xand>
numnames #2 >
%<!aunm-semi&!aunm-sl> { "," * }
%<aunm-semi> { ";" * }
%<aunm-sl&!aunm-semi> { "/" * }
'skip$
if$
%</!and-xcom&!and-com-ed&!xand>
s nameptr "{ll}" format.name$ duplicate$ "others" =
{ 't := }
{ pop$ }
if$
t "others" =
{
%<nmft&nmfted&!nmand-rm&!(fnm-rm|fnm-def)&(etal-it|etal-rm)> bib.name.font
%<*!etal-it>
%<nmft&nmfted&(nmand-rm|(fnm-rm|fnm-def))&!etal-rm> " " * bbl.etal bib.name.font *
%<!(nmft&nmfted&(nmand-rm|(fnm-rm|fnm-def)))|etal-rm> " " * bbl.etal *
%</!etal-it>
%<etal-it> " " * bbl.etal emphasize *
%<nmft&nmfted&!nmand-rm&!(fnm-rm|fnm-def)&!(etal-it|etal-rm)> bib.name.font
}
%<*!xand>
{
%<*!harnm>
%<!amper> bbl.and
%<amper> "\&"
%</!harnm>
%<harnm> "\harvardand{}"
%<nmft&nmfted&!nmand-rm&(fnm-rm|fnm-def)> bib.name.font
space.word * t *
}
%</!xand>
%<xand> { " " * t * }
if$
}
if$
}
't
if$
nameptr #1 + 'nameptr :=
namesleft #1 - 'namesleft :=
}
while$
%<*nmft&nmfted&!nmand-rm&!(fnm-rm|fnm-def)>
t "others" =
'skip$
{ bib.name.font }
if$
%</nmft&nmfted&!nmand-rm&!(fnm-rm|fnm-def)>
} if$
%</!ed-rev&!ed-au>
}
% \end{macrocode}
% \end{macro}
%
% \begin{macro}{`format.key'}
% \begin{macrocode}
%<*ay>
FUNCTION {format.key}
{ empty$
{ key field.or.null }
{ "" }
if$
}
%</ay>
% \end{macrocode}
% \end{macro}
%
% \begin{macro}{`format.authors'}
%
% \changes{3.89d1}{1999 July 20}{AO: Add code to emit collaboration.}
% \begin{macrocode}
FUNCTION {format.authors}
{ author "author" format.names
%<*revdata>
duplicate$ empty$ 'skip$
{ collaboration "collaboration" bibinfo.check
duplicate$ empty$ 'skip$
{ " (" swap$ * ")" * }
if$
*
}
if$
%</revdata>
}
% \end{macrocode}
% \end{macro}
%
% \begin{macro}{`get.bbl.editor'}
% \changes{3.89d1}{1999 July 20}{AO: access function for editor text entity}
% Use this function universally when accessing the ``editor'' text entity.
% \begin{macrocode}
FUNCTION {get.bbl.editor}
{ editor num.names$ #1 > 'bbl.editors 'bbl.editor if$ }
% \end{macrocode}
% \end{macro}
%
% \begin{macro}{`format.editors'}
% \changes{3.0}{1995 Mar 20}{Add option \texttt{edpar}}
% \changes{3.83}{1997 Feb 4}{Add option \texttt{edparc}}
% \changes{3.89d1}{1999 July 20}{AO: encapsulate editors for further processing.}
% \changes{4.00}{1999 Oct 6}{Add option \texttt{edparxc}}
% The option \texttt{edpar} puts the word `editor' in parentheses.
% In \texttt{genbst.mbs}, this occurred automatically with the option
% \texttt{ed}, to abbreviate `editor' to `ed'. In \texttt{babel.mbs},
% this was not the case, because of complications with the word functions.
% Now this possibility is added as a special option, which means there is
% some inconsistency with older \texttt{.dbj} files that called \texttt{ed}:
% the abbreviated `ed' is not put in parentheses unless \texttt{edpar} is
% also called.
%
% Note that the code here is very similar to code in \texttt{format.in.ed.booktitle};
% the two should be kept coordinated.
% \begin{macrocode}
FUNCTION {format.editors}
{ editor "editor" format.names duplicate$ empty$ 'skip$
{
%<!edpar&!edparxc> "," *
" " *
get.bbl.editor
%<bkedcap> capitalize
%<edpar|edparc|edparxc> "(" swap$ * ")" *
*
}
if$
}
% \end{macrocode}
% \end{macro}
%
% \begin{macro}{`format.in.editors'}
% \changes{3.0}{1995 Mar 20}{Add option \texttt{edpar}}
% \changes{3.83}{1997 Feb 4}{Add option \texttt{edparc}}
% \changes{3.89d1}{1999 July 20}{AO: code subsumed into
% \texttt{format.in.ed.booktitle}}
% See the note about the option \texttt{edpar} above.
%
% \end{macro}
%
% \begin{macro}{`format.book.pages'}
% \changes{3.88}{1998 Dec 2}{Add function}
% \changes{3.89d1}{1999 July 20}{AO: encapsulate pages for further processing.}
% \begin{macrocode}
%<*pg-bk>
FUNCTION {format.book.pages}
{ pages "pages" bibinfo.check
duplicate$ empty$ 'skip$
{ " " * bbl.pages * }
if$
}
%</pg-bk>
% \end{macrocode}
% \end{macro}
%
% \begin{macro}{`format.isbn'}
% \changes{3.0}{1995 Mar 1}{Add function}
% \changes{3.89d1}{1999 July 20}{AO: encapsulate isbn for further processing}
% \begin{macrocode}
%<*isbn>
FUNCTION {format.isbn}
{ isbn "isbn" bibinfo.check
duplicate$ empty$ 'skip$
{
%<!blk-com&!blk-tit&!blk-tita> new.block
"ISBN " swap$ *
}
if$
}
%</isbn>
% \end{macrocode}
% \end{macro}
%
% \begin{macro}{`format.issn'}
% \changes{3.87}{1998 Aug 17}{Add function}
% \changes{3.89d1}{1999 July 20}{AO: encapsulate issn for further processing}
% \begin{macrocode}
%<*issn>
FUNCTION {format.issn}
{ issn "issn" bibinfo.check
duplicate$ empty$ 'skip$
{
%<!blk-com&!blk-tit&!blk-tita> new.block
"ISSN " swap$ *
}
if$
}
%</issn>
% \end{macrocode}
% \end{macro}
%
% \begin{macro}{`format.doi'}
% \changes{4.10}{2003 May 28}{Add function}
% \begin{macrocode}
%<*doi>
FUNCTION {format.doi}
{ doi "doi" bibinfo.check
duplicate$ empty$ 'skip$
{
%<!blk-com&!blk-tit&!blk-tita> new.block
%<!html> "\doi{" swap$ * "}" *
%<html> "doi:" swap$ *
}
if$
}
%</doi>
% \end{macrocode}
% \end{macro}
%
% \begin{macro}{`select.language'}
% \changes{3.87}{1998 Aug 17}{Add function}
% The \texttt{language} field code has been provided by Bernd Feige, of the
% University of Freiburg.
% \begin{macrocode}
%<*lang>
FUNCTION {select.language}
{ duplicate$ empty$
'pop$
{ language empty$
'skip$
{ "{\selectlanguage{" language * "}" * swap$ * "}" * }
if$
}
if$
}
%</lang>
% \end{macrocode}
% \end{macro}
%
% \begin{macro}{`format.note'}
% \changes{3.83}{1997 Apr 25}{Add macro}
% \changes{3.83}{1997 May 26}{Fix so unmatched brace warning suppressed}
% \changes{3.87}{1998 Jul 23}{Add option \texttt{url-nt}}
% Notes should be entered as though they were a sentence on their own.
% However, if they appear mid-sentence rather than after a block or sentence,
% the first letter must be lowercase. Thus if a note begins with a proper
% noun, it must be in braces. To avoid a warning about unmatched braces
% with the \texttt{change.case\$} function, check first if the leading
% character is an opening brace.
%
% With options \texttt{url,url-nt}, the URL text is treated as a note, and
% added here. It is output directly, not prepended to the note text. This
% means, if the note is to be a new sentence, the URL text starts that
% sentence, and the regular note is added to that sentence, comma between.
% \changes{3.89d1}{1999 July 20}{AO: encapsulate note for further processing}
% \changes{4.00}{1999 Sep 14}{PWD: remove url with \texttt{revdata}}
%
% \begin{macrocode}
FUNCTION {format.note}
{
%<*url-nt&!revdata>
url empty$
'skip$
%<!html> { "\urlprefix\url{" url * "}" * output }
%<html> { "<a href=" quote$ * url * quote$
%<html> * ">" * url * "</a>" * output }
if$
%</url-nt&!revdata>
note empty$
{ "" }
{ note #1 #1 substring$
duplicate$ "{" =
'skip$
{ output.state mid.sentence =
{ "l" }
{ "u" }
if$
change.case$
}
if$
note #2 global.max$ substring$ * "note" bibinfo.check
}
if$
}
% \end{macrocode}
% \end{macro}
%
% \begin{macro}{`format.title'}
% \changes{1.4(2.2)a}{1994 Sep 7}{Add enquote function to put titles in quotes,
% such that punctuation is inside quotes.}
% \changes{3.8}{1996 Apr 17}{Fix bug in quoted title and \texttt{blk-com}}
% \changes{3.83}{1997 Feb 4}{Add \texttt{qx} option, for comma outside
% quotes}
% For a quoted title, any punctuation in the title goes inside the quote.
% Otherwise, the comma or period following the title also goes inside.
% Exception is with \texttt{qx} option, in which case the comma goes
% outside, even when punctuation present; for period (\texttt{!blk-com})
% is added outside only when punctuation is absent.
%
% \changes{3.89d1}{1999 July 20}{AO: encapsulate title for further processing.}
% \changes{4.01}{2000 May 4}{Put \texttt{change.case\$} before \texttt{bibinfo.check}}
% \begin{macrocode}
FUNCTION {format.title}
{ title
%<*!atit-u>
duplicate$ empty$ 'skip$
{ "t" change.case$ }
if$
%</!atit-u>
"title" bibinfo.check
%<*tit-it|tit-qq|lang>
duplicate$ empty$ 'skip$
{
%<tit-it> emphasize
%<*!tit-it&tit-qq>
"\enquote{" swap$ *
%<*!qx>
%<*blk-com>
non.stop
%<!com-semi&!com-blank> { ",} " * }
%<com-semi> { ";} " * }
%<!com-semi&com-blank> { "} " * }
{ "} " * }
if$
%</blk-com>
%<!blk-com> add.period$ "}" *
%</!qx>
%<*qx>
%<*blk-com>
%<!com-semi&!com-blank> "}, " *
%<com-semi> "}; " *
%<!com-semi&com-blank> "} " *
%</blk-com>
%<!blk-com> "}" *
%</qx>
%</!tit-it&tit-qq>
%<lang> select.language
}
if$
%</tit-it|tit-qq|lang>
}
% \end{macrocode}
% \end{macro}
%
% \begin{macro}{`end.quote.title'}
% \changes{3.82}{1996 Nov 15}{Add macro to finish off quoted titles}
% For a quoted title, the punctuation appears in the quotes. For commas
% between block, this means the inter-block punctuation is already present,
% so it must be suppressed after every \texttt{format.title output}. This
% is done by setting the \texttt{output.state} to \texttt{before.all}, but
% only if there really was a title. Call this macro every time after
% titles are output.
% \begin{macrocode}
%<*blk-com&tit-qq>
FUNCTION {end.quote.title}
{ title empty$
'skip$
{ before.all 'output.state := }
if$
}
%</blk-com&tit-qq>
% \end{macrocode}
% \end{macro}
%
% \begin{macro}{`end.quote.btitle'}
% \changes{3.84}{1997 Oct 31}{Add function}
% Similar to |end.quote.title| except that it is only applied if titles of
% proceedings and collections are quoted, and if
% neither \texttt{edby}, \texttt{edby-par}, nor \texttt{edby-par} are selected
% (this is the default case in the relevant menu of the \texttt{makebst.tex} run).
% These options add text after the booktitle,
% so additional punctuation need not be suppressed. Unless there is no editor!
%
% Note: this function is called after the result of \texttt{format.in.ed.booktitle}
% has been output, and attempts to predict what that output had been.
% Would it not be better to call this function while that result is still
% on the stack?
% \begin{macrocode}
%<*bt-qq>
FUNCTION {end.quote.btitle}
{ booktitle empty$
'skip$
%<!edby&!edby-par&!edby-parc> { before.all 'output.state := }
%<*edby|edby-par|edby-parc>
{ editor empty$
{ before.all 'output.state := }
'skip$
if$
}
%</edby|edby-par|edby-parc>
if$
}
%</bt-qq>
% \end{macrocode}
% \end{macro}
%
% \begin{macro}{`make.full.names'}
% \changes{1.1}{1993 Nov 12}{Add key labels to \texttt{calc.long.label} and
% get {\tt'author} and {\tt'editor} in right order when author
% missing.}
% \changes{1.4(2.2)}{1994 Sep 5}{Remove \texttt{calc.long.label} and
% \texttt{format.long.lab.names}, replacing them with
% \texttt{format.full.names}, \texttt{make.full.names}, and adding
% \texttt{author.editor.key}, \texttt{author.key}, and \texttt{editor.key}}
% \changes{1.4(2.2)a}{1994 Sep 7}{Remove option \texttt{and-com} from
% \texttt{make.full.names}}
% \changes{1.5(2.3)}{1994 Sep 15}{Add full names for \texttt{natbib} v5.3}
% \changes{3.6}{1995 Dec 8}{Suppress `and' in full list if suppressed in short}
% \changes{3.6}{1995 Dec 8}{Font of `and' in lists same as in citations}
% \changes{3.85}{1996 Feb 6}{Recode author font}
% \changes{3.89}{1999 May 20}{Fix location of \texttt{and-xcom} code}
% In versions before 2.2, there were two functions \texttt{calc.long.label}
% and \texttt{format.long.lab.names} that made up the string
% \texttt{long.label} for each entry. This contains the full author list.
% However, there was a bug in the one routine, entered by mistake when an
% earlier bug was removed, and more seriously, the string
% \texttt{long.label} was limited to \texttt{entry.max\$} characters, 100 on
% my system. Author lists were truncated. Thus, \texttt{make.full.names}
% is used instead to enter the full list of names directly in the
% \texttt{output.bibitem} function, without an intermediate string. This
% involves changing the order of some function definitions, especially
% \texttt{output.bibitem} must come later.
% \changes{3.89}{1999 May 20}{Reset \texttt{t}; might still be ``others''
% from last format function}
% \changes{3.98}{1999 May 28}{Fix bug with \texttt{harnm}, missing brace}
% \begin{macrocode}
%<*har|cay|nat>
FUNCTION {format.full.names}
{'s :=
"" 't :=
#1 'nameptr :=
s num.names$ 'numnames :=
numnames 'namesleft :=
{ namesleft #0 > }
{ s nameptr
"{vv~}{ll}" format.name$
%<lab&and-rm> cite.name.font
't :=
nameptr #1 >
{
%<*nmlm>
%<m1> nameptr #1
%<m2> nameptr #2
%<m3> nameptr #3
%<m4> nameptr #4
%<m5> nameptr #5
%<m6> nameptr #6
%<m7> nameptr #7
%<m8> nameptr #8
%<m9> nameptr #9
%<m0> nameptr #0
%<m10> #10 +
%<m20> #20 +
%<m30> #30 +
%<m40> #40 +
%<m50> #50 +
%<m60> #60 +
%<m70> #70 +
%<m80> #80 +
%<m90> #90 +
#1 + =
%<x1> numnames #1
%<x2> numnames #2
%<x3> numnames #3
%<x4> numnames #4
%<x5> numnames #5
%<x6> numnames #6
%<x7> numnames #7
%<x8> numnames #8
%<x9> numnames #9
%<x0> numnames #0
%<x10> #10 +
%<x20> #20 +
%<x30> #30 +
%<x40> #40 +
%<x50> #50 +
%<x60> #60 +
%<x70> #70 +
%<x80> #80 +
%<x90> #90 +
> and
{ "others" 't :=
#1 'namesleft := }
'skip$
if$
%</nmlm>
namesleft #1 >
{ ", " * t * }
{
s nameptr "{ll}" format.name$ duplicate$ "others" =
{ 't := }
{ pop$ }
if$
t "others" =
{
%<lab&!and-rm&(etal-it|etal-rm)> cite.name.font
%<*!etal-it>
%<lab&and-rm&!etal-rm> " " * bbl.etal cite.name.font *
%<!lab|!and-rm|etal-rm> " " * bbl.etal *
%</!etal-it>
%<etal-it> " " * bbl.etal emphasize *
%<lab&!and-rm&!(etal-it|etal-rm)> cite.name.font
}
{
%<*!harnm>
%<*!and-xcom>
numnames #2 >
{ "," * }
'skip$
if$
%</!and-xcom>
%<!amper> bbl.and
%<amper> "\&"
%</!harnm>
%<harnm> "\harvardand{}"
space.word * t *
}
if$
}
if$
}
't
if$
nameptr #1 + 'nameptr :=
namesleft #1 - 'namesleft :=
}
while$
%<*lab&!and-rm>
t "others" =
'skip$
{ cite.name.font }
if$
%</lab&!and-rm>
}
FUNCTION {author.editor.key.full}
{ author empty$
{ editor empty$
{ key empty$
{ cite$ #1 #3 substring$ }
'key
if$
}
{ editor format.full.names }
if$
}
{ author format.full.names }
if$
}
FUNCTION {author.key.full}
{ author empty$
{ key empty$
{ cite$ #1 #3 substring$ }
'key
if$
}
{ author format.full.names }
if$
}
FUNCTION {editor.key.full}
{ editor empty$
{ key empty$
{ cite$ #1 #3 substring$ }
'key
if$
}
{ editor format.full.names }
if$
}
FUNCTION {make.full.names}
{ type$ "book" =
type$ "inbook" =
or
'author.editor.key.full
{ type$ "proceedings" =
'editor.key.full
'author.key.full
if$
}
if$
}
%</har|cay|nat>
% \end{macrocode}
% \end{macro}
%
% \begin{macro}{`output.bibitem'}
%\changes{1.1}{1993 Nov 12}{Test for missing year, set to {\tt????}.}
% The \texttt{output.bibitem} function formats the |\bibitem| entries.
%\changes{1.4(2.2)}{1994 Sep 5}{Move to later location, add
% \texttt{make.full.names} instead of inserting string \texttt{long.label}}
%\changes{1.5(2.3)}{1994 Sep 16}{Add option \texttt{nat} for full author list
% for \texttt{natbib.sty} version~5.3}
% \changes{3.84}{1997 Nov 18}{For \texttt{nat}, put label in braces}
% A user has pointed out to me that if the label argument in square brackets
% are put into braces (within the squares) it is then resistent to any
% problems if square braces should appear within the label. Do this, but
% only for the \texttt{nat} option.
% \begin{macrocode}
FUNCTION {output.bibitem}
{ newline$
%<*!html>
%<*ay>
%<!har&!nat> "\bibitem[" write$
%<!har&nat> "\bibitem[{" write$
%<har> "\harvarditem" write$
%<nmd> "\protect\citeauthoryear{" write$
%<ast> "\protect\astroncite{" write$
%<cay> "\protect\citeauthoryear{" make.full.names * "}{" * write$
%<cn> "\protect\citename{" write$
%<!har> label write$
%<har> make.full.names duplicate$ label =
%<har> 'skip$
%<har> { "[" label * "]" * write$ }
%<har> if$
%<har> "{" swap$ * "}{" * write$
%<har> year duplicate$ empty$
%<cn> ", }" year duplicate$ empty$
%<cay|nmd|ast> "}{" year duplicate$ empty$
%<(har|cn|cay|nmd|ast)&blkyear> { pop$ "" }
%<(har|cn|cay|nmd|ast)&!blkyear> { pop$ "????" }
%<har|cn|cay|nmd|ast> 'skip$
%<har|cn|cay|nmd|ast> if$
%<har> extra.label * "}{" * write$
%<cn> * extra.label * "]{" * write$
%<cay|nmd|ast> * extra.label * "}]{" * write$
%<alk> "]{" write$
%<!(har|cay|nmd|ast|alk|cn|nat)> ")]{" write$
%<nat> ")" make.full.names duplicate$ short.list =
%<nat> { pop$ }
%<nat> { * }
%<nat> if$
%<nat> "}]{" * write$
%</ay>
%<!ay&!(cite|alph)> "\bibitem{" write$
%<!ay&(cite|alph)> "\bibitem[" label * "]{" * write$
cite$ write$
"}" write$
newline$
""
%</!html>
%<*html>
%<*htdes>
"<dt><strong><tt>" write$
cite$ write$
"</tt></strong></dt>" write$ newline$
"<dd>"
%</htdes>
%<htlist&!htdes> "<li>"
%<!htlist&!htdes> "<p>"
%</html>
before.all 'output.state :=
}
% \end{macrocode}
% \end{macro}
%
% \begin{macro}{`if.digit'}
% \changes{3.84}{1997 Sep 16}{Add macro}
% Add \texttt{if.digit} and \texttt{n.separate} to convert large page numbers
% to a separated number.
% \begin{macrocode}
%<*pgsep-c|pgsep-s|pgsep-p>
FUNCTION {if.digit}
{ duplicate$ "0" =
swap$ duplicate$ "1" =
swap$ duplicate$ "2" =
swap$ duplicate$ "3" =
swap$ duplicate$ "4" =
swap$ duplicate$ "5" =
swap$ duplicate$ "6" =
swap$ duplicate$ "7" =
swap$ duplicate$ "8" =
swap$ "9" = or or or or or or or or or
}
% \end{macrocode}
% \end{macro}
%
% \begin{macro}{`n.separate'}
% \changes{3.84}{1997 Sep 16}{Add macro for options \texttt{pgsep-c},
% \texttt{pgsep-s}, \texttt{pgsep-p}}
% Large page numbers are to be separated in threes, with thin space, comma
% or period. The number must be 5 digits before the separation occurs.
% No provision is made for numbers of 7 or more digits.
% \begin{macrocode}
FUNCTION {n.separate}
{ 't :=
""
#0 'numnames :=
{ t empty$ not }
{ t #-1 #1 substring$ if.digit
{ numnames #1 + 'numnames := }
{ #0 'numnames := }
if$
t #-1 #1 substring$ swap$ *
t #-2 global.max$ substring$ 't :=
numnames #5 =
{ duplicate$ #1 #2 substring$ swap$
#3 global.max$ substring$
%<pgsep-c> "," swap$ * *
%<pgsep-p> "." swap$ * *
%<pgsep-s&!html> "\," swap$ * *
%<pgsep-s&html> " " swap$ * *
}
'skip$
if$
}
while$
}
%</pgsep-c|pgsep-s|pgsep-p>
% \end{macrocode}
% \end{macro}
%
% \begin{macro}{`n.dashify'}
% \begin{macrocode}
FUNCTION {n.dashify}
{
%<pgsep-c|pgsep-s|pgsep-p> n.separate
't :=
""
{ t empty$ not }
{ t #1 #1 substring$ "-" =
{ t #1 #2 substring$ "--" = not
{ "--" *
t #2 global.max$ substring$ 't :=
}
{ { t #1 #1 substring$ "-" = }
{ "-" *
t #2 global.max$ substring$ 't :=
}
while$
}
if$
}
{ t #1 #1 substring$ *
t #2 global.max$ substring$ 't :=
}
if$
}
while$
}
% \end{macrocode}
% \end{macro}
%
% \begin{macro}{`word.in'}
% \changes{2.0}{1994 Jan 31}{Function \texttt{word.in} constructed out of
% \texttt{bbl.in} or \texttt{bbl.iin}.}
% \changes{3.0}{1995 Feb 16}{Use only \texttt{bbl.in} and capitalize it
% as necessary; remove \texttt{bbl.iin}}
% \changes{3.81}{1996 Jun 19}{Add option \texttt{in-x} to suppress `in'}
% \changes{4.01}{2000 May 4}{Add option \texttt{in-it} to italicize `in'}
% The function \texttt{word.in} prints the word \textsl{in} for references
% that are
% contained in a larger work, or in conference proceedings. One may have a
% colon after the word with the option \texttt{in-col}. If blocks of text are
% to be separated with commas (option \texttt{blk-com}) then the word remains
% in lower case, as it is defined in \texttt{bbl.in}; but if blocks act as
% sentences, then it must be capitalized.
% \begin{macrocode}
FUNCTION {word.in}
%<in-x>{ "" }
%<*!in-x>
%<blk-com|blk-tita>{ bbl.in
%<!blk-com&!blk-tita>{ bbl.in capitalize
%<in-col> ":" *
%<in-it> emphasize
" " * }
%</!in-x>
% \end{macrocode}
% \end{macro}
%
% \begin{macro}{`format.date'}
% \changes{1.4(2.2)}{1994 Sep 6}{Add option \texttt{yr-per} to put period
% before date}
% \changes{1.5(2.3)}{1994 Sep 16}{Add \texttt{harvard} bracket names to year
% with new option \texttt{harnm}}
% \changes{1.6(2.4)}{1995 Feb 2}{Add \texttt{yr-blk} for no punctuation before
% the date}
% \changes{3.2}{1995 May 19}{Add \texttt{dtrev} option for year month}
% \changes{3.2}{1995 May 19}{Add \texttt{mth-bare} for dotless abbreviation
% of months}
% \changes{3.4}{1995 Sep 28}{Add \texttt{volp-dt} for date after volume}
% \changes{3.5}{1995 Oct 9}{Add brace pair after
% \texttt{\char`\\harvardyearright}}
% \changes{3.5}{1995 Oct 16}{Add \texttt{aymth} option for months in dates}
% \changes{3.8}{1996 Mar 19}{Add \texttt{vnum-dt} option}
% \changes{3.81}{1996 Sep 12}{Add \texttt{yr-com} option}
% \changes{3.82}{1996 Dec 12}{Fix bug that left off extra label for plain year}
% \changes{3.84}{1997 Oct 30}{Replace \texttt{volp-dt} with \texttt{jdt-p}}
% \changes{3.84}{1997 Oct 30}{Replace \texttt{vnum-dt} with \texttt{jdt-vs}}
% \changes{3.84}{1997 Oct 30}{Add \texttt{jdt-v}}
% \changes{3.85}{1998 Feb 10}{Do \texttt{yr-blk} right}
% \changes{3.86}{1998 Feb 25}{Add \texttt{jdt-pc} to add comma after year}
% \changes{3.87}{1998 Jul 23}{Add \texttt{xmth} to suppress month for numericals}
% \changes{3.87}{1998 Jul 23}{For \texttt{harnm}, suppress punctuation before date}
% \changes{3.89}{1999 May 12}{Add \texttt{blkyear} option}
% \changes{3.89d1}{1999 July 20}{AO: encapsulate the date for further processing}
% The new \texttt{harvard.sty} allows variable brackets around the date
% in the reference list. It uses |\harvardyearleft| and |\harvardyearright|
% in the \texttt{.bst} files. Allow this with the option \texttt{harnm},
% which could actually be used without the \texttt{har} option. Note that
% this overrides the other year formatting options.
% \begin{macrocode}
%<*ay>
FUNCTION {format.date}
{ year "year" bibinfo.check duplicate$ empty$
{
%<*!blkyear>
"empty year in " cite$ * "; set to ????" * warning$
pop$ "????"
%</!blkyear>
}
'skip$
if$
%<*aymth>
month "month" bibinfo.check duplicate$ empty$
'skip$
{
%<dtrev> swap$
" " * swap$
}
if$
*
%<mth-bare> remove.dots
%</aymth>
%<dtbf> bolden
extra.label *
%<*!harnm>
%<*yr-par|yr-brk|yr-col|yr-blk|yr-com|yr-per>
before.all 'output.state :=
%<yr-par> " (" swap$ * ")" *
%<!yr-par&yr-brk> " [" swap$ * "]" *
%<!yr-par&!yr-brk&yr-col> ": " swap$ *
%<!yr-par&!yr-brk&!yr-col&yr-com> ", " swap$ *
%<!yr-par&!yr-brk&!yr-col&!yr-com&yr-per> after.sentence 'output.state :=
%<!yr-par&!yr-brk&!yr-col&!yr-com&!yr-per&yr-blk> " " swap$ *
%</yr-par|yr-brk|yr-col|yr-blk|yr-com|yr-per>
%</!harnm>
%<harnm> before.all 'output.state :=
%<harnm> " \harvardyearleft " swap$ * "\harvardyearright{}" *
}
%</ay>
%<*!ay>
FUNCTION {format.date}
{
%<!xmth> month "month" bibinfo.check
%<xmth> ""
duplicate$ empty$
year "year" bibinfo.check duplicate$ empty$
{ swap$ 'skip$
{ "there's a month but no year in " cite$ * warning$ }
if$
*
}
{ swap$ 'skip$
{
%<showstack> month year
%<!dtrev> swap$
" " * swap$
}
if$
*
%<mth-bare> remove.dots
}
if$
%<dtbf> bolden
%<*yr-par|yr-brk|yr-col|yr-com|yr-per|yr-blk>
duplicate$ empty$
'skip$
{
before.all 'output.state :=
%<yr-par> " (" swap$ * ")" *
%<!yr-par&yr-brk> " [" swap$ * "]" *
%<!yr-par&!yr-brk&yr-col> ": " swap$ *
%<!yr-par&!yr-brk&!yr-col&yr-com> ", " swap$ *
%<!yr-par&!yr-brk&!yr-col&!yr-com&yr-per> after.sentence 'output.state :=
%<!yr-par&!yr-brk&!yr-col&!yr-com&!yr-per&yr-blk> " " swap$ *
}
if$
%</yr-par|yr-brk|yr-col|yr-com|yr-per|yr-blk>
}
%</!ay>
% \end{macrocode}
% \end{macro}
%
% \begin{macro}{`format.year'}
% \changes{3.84}{1997 Oct 30}{Add function}
% For the options that put the year into the journal specifications, use a
% special formatter separate from the regular date formatter.
% The year is always in parentheses (except for appended to journal name).
% \changes{3.89d1}{1999 July 20}{AO: encapsulate year for further processing}
% \begin{macrocode}
%<*jdt-p|jdt-pc|jdt-v|jdt-vs>
FUNCTION{format.year}
{ year "year" bibinfo.check duplicate$ empty$
{ "empty year in " cite$ *
%<ay&!blkyear> "; set to ????" *
warning$
%<ay&!blkyear> pop$ "????"
}
{
%<!ay&jdt-vs> " (" swap$ * ")" *
%<!ay&!jdt-vs> "(" swap$ * ")" *
}
if$
%<*ay>
extra.label *
%<jdt-vs> " (" swap$ * ")" *
%<!jdt-vs> "(" swap$ * ")" *
%</ay>
}
%</jdt-p|jdt-pc|jdt-v|jdt-vs>
% \end{macrocode}
% \end{macro}
%
% \begin{macro}{`format.btitle'}
% \changes{3.89d1}{1999 July 20}{AO: encapsulate title for further processing.}
% \begin{macrocode}
FUNCTION {format.btitle}
{ title "title" bibinfo.check
duplicate$ empty$ 'skip$
{
%<!btit-rm> emphasize
%<lang> select.language
}
if$
}
% \end{macrocode}
% \end{macro}
%
% \begin{macro}{`either.or.check'}
% \begin{macrocode}
FUNCTION {either.or.check}
{ empty$
'pop$
{ "can't use both " swap$ * " fields in " * cite$ * warning$ }
if$
}
% \end{macrocode}
% \end{macro}
%
% \begin{macro}{`format.bvolume'}
% \changes{4.11}{2003 Jun 23}{Add \texttt{ser-vol}}
% \begin{macrocode}
FUNCTION {format.bvolume}
{ volume empty$
{ "" }
{ bbl.volume volume tie.or.space.prefix
"volume" bibinfo.check * *
series "series" bibinfo.check
duplicate$ empty$ 'pop$
%<*!ser-vol>
{ swap$ bbl.of space.word * swap$
emphasize * }
%</!ser-vol>
%<ser-vol> { emphasize ", " * swap$ * }
if$
"volume and number" number either.or.check
}
if$
}
% \end{macrocode}
% \end{macro}
%
% \begin{macro}{`format.number.series'}
% \begin{macrocode}
FUNCTION {format.number.series}
{ volume empty$
{ number empty$
{ series field.or.null }
%<*num-xser>
{ series empty$
{ number "number" bibinfo.check }
{ output.state mid.sentence =
{ bbl.number }
{ bbl.number capitalize }
if$
number tie.or.space.prefix "number" bibinfo.check * *
bbl.in space.word *
series "series" bibinfo.check *
}
if$
}
%</num-xser>
%<*!num-xser>
{ output.state mid.sentence =
{ bbl.number }
{ bbl.number capitalize }
if$
number tie.or.space.prefix "number" bibinfo.check * *
series empty$
{ "there's a number but no series in " cite$ * warning$ }
{ bbl.in space.word *
series "series" bibinfo.check *
}
if$
}
%</!num-xser>
if$
}
{ "" }
if$
}
% \end{macrocode}
% \end{macro}
%
% \begin{macro}{`is.num'}
% \changes{2.0}{1994 Jan 31}{Add function to test for digit.}
% \changes{3.87h}{1998 Nov 27}{Option to suppress to save wiz-functions}
% This function takes the single-character string on the stack and returns
% 1 if it is a digit, else 0.
% \begin{macrocode}
%<*!xedn>
FUNCTION {is.num}
{ chr.to.int$
duplicate$ "0" chr.to.int$ < not
swap$ "9" chr.to.int$ > not and
}
% \end{macrocode}
% \end{macro}
%
% \begin{macro}{`extract.num'}
% \changes{2.0}{1994 Jan 31}{Add function to extract leading number from
% a literal string.}
% \changes{3.87h}{1998 Nov 27}{Option to suppress to save wiz-functions}
% This function tests the string on the stack to see if it begins with a
% number. If so, that number is left on the stack; if the string contains
% no numbers at the start, it is left unchanged. The idea is to convert
% \textsl{1st} to \textsl{1} and leave \textsl{first} as is.
% This is used by {\tt convert.edition}.
% \begin{macrocode}
FUNCTION {extract.num}
{ duplicate$ 't :=
"" 's :=
{ t empty$ not }
{ t #1 #1 substring$
t #2 global.max$ substring$ 't :=
duplicate$ is.num
{ s swap$ * 's := }
{ pop$ "" 't := }
if$
}
while$
s empty$
'skip$
{ pop$ s }
if$
}
% \end{macrocode}
% \end{macro}
%
% \begin{macro}{`convert.edition'}
% \changes{2.0}{1994 Jan 31}{Add function to convert \texttt{edition} entry
% text from word to a function}
% \changes{3.87h}{1998 Nov 27}{Option to suppress to save wiz-functions}
% \changes{3.89d1}{1999 July 20}{AO: change calling sequence: arg on stack}
% The function \texttt{convert.edition} takes the text in the field
% \texttt{edition} and changes it to the language-specific equivalent. As
% originally planned for \btx, this field should contain the words
% \textsl{First}, \textsl{Second}, etc. Being so explicit,
% it is not so easy to translate, nor to
% convert to \textsl{1st}, \textsl{2nd}, etc., if one wanted.
% This function carries out the translation, by changing
% \textsl{first} or \textsl{1} to \texttt{bbl.first}, and so
% on. The field is reduced to lower case to make it case insensitive. If no
% translation is found, then the original text in \texttt{edition} is used
% instead, as it stands. However, if the original is a number greater than
% the maximum for which text is provided, then \texttt{bbl.th} is added to
% it.
% \begin{macrocode}
FUNCTION {convert.edition}
{ extract.num "l" change.case$ 's :=
s "first" = s "1" = or
{ bbl.first 't := }
{ s "second" = s "2" = or
{ bbl.second 't := }
{ s "third" = s "3" = or
{ bbl.third 't := }
{ s "fourth" = s "4" = or
{ bbl.fourth 't := }
{ s "fifth" = s "5" = or
{ bbl.fifth 't := }
{ s #1 #1 substring$ is.num
%<!english&exlang> { s bbl.th * 't := }
%<english|!exlang> { s eng.ord 't := }
{ edition 't := }
if$
}
if$
}
if$
}
if$
}
if$
}
if$
t
}
%</!xedn>
% \end{macrocode}
% \end{macro}
%
% \begin{macro}{`format.edition'}
% \changes{2.0}{1994 Jan 31}{Add call to \texttt{convert.edition}}
% This function formats the text for the edition specification, such as
% ``Second edition''. It combines the edition number with the word
% \textsl{edition}.
% \changes{3.89d1}{1999 July 20}{AO: encapsulate edition for further processing.}
% \changes{4.01}{2000 May 4}{Put \texttt{change.case\$} before \texttt{bibinfo.check}}
% \begin{macrocode}
FUNCTION {format.edition}
{ edition duplicate$ empty$ 'skip$
{
%<!xedn> convert.edition
output.state mid.sentence =
{ "l" }
{ "t" }
if$ change.case$
"edition" bibinfo.check
" " * bbl.edition *
}
if$
}
% \end{macrocode}
% \end{macro}
%
% \begin{macrocode}
INTEGERS { multiresult }
% \end{macrocode}
%
% \begin{macro}{`multi.page.check'}
% \begin{macrocode}
FUNCTION {multi.page.check}
{ 't :=
#0 'multiresult :=
{ multiresult not
t empty$ not
and
}
{ t #1 #1 substring$
duplicate$ "-" =
swap$ duplicate$ "," =
swap$ "+" =
or or
{ #1 'multiresult := }
{ t #2 global.max$ substring$ 't := }
if$
}
while$
multiresult
}
% \end{macrocode}
% \end{macro}
%
% \begin{macro}{`format.pages'}
% \changes{3.6}{1995 Nov 24}{Add option \texttt{bkpg-par}}
% \changes{3.88}{1998 Dec 2}{Add option \texttt{bkpg-x}}
% \changes{3.89d1}{1999 July 20}{AO: encapsulate pages for further processing.}
% \changes{4.00}{1999 Dec 10}{Add \texttt{!ppx} test to avoid extra space}
% \begin{macrocode}
FUNCTION {format.pages}
{ pages duplicate$ empty$ 'skip$
{ duplicate$ multi.page.check
{
%<!bkpg-x&!ppx> bbl.pages swap$
n.dashify
}
{
%<!bkpg-x&!ppx> bbl.page swap$
}
if$
%<!bkpg-x&!ppx> tie.or.space.prefix
"pages" bibinfo.check
%<!bkpg-x&!ppx> * *
%<bkpg-par> "(" swap$ * ")" *
}
if$
}
% \end{macrocode}
% \end{macro}
%
% \begin{macro}{`first.page'}
% \begin{macrocode}
%<*jpg-1>
FUNCTION {first.page}
{ 't :=
""
{ t empty$ not t #1 #1 substring$ "-" = not and }
{ t #1 #1 substring$ *
t #2 global.max$ substring$ 't :=
}
while$
}
%</jpg-1>
% \end{macrocode}
% \end{macro}
%
% \begin{macro}{`format.journal.pages'}
% \changes{3.82}{1996 Nov 15}{Remove from \texttt{format.vol.num.pages} to
% be a separate function}
% \changes{3.84}{1997 Oct 30}{Remove option \texttt{vnum-pg}}
% \changes{3.84}{1997 Oct 30}{Replace \texttt{volp-dt} with \texttt{jdt-p}}
%
% \changes{3.89d1}{1999 July 20}{AO: encapsulate pages for further processing.}
%
% Note: this function gets called with something on the stack.
% It may be the volume and number.
% \begin{macrocode}
FUNCTION {format.journal.pages}
{ pages duplicate$ empty$ 'pop$
{ swap$ duplicate$ empty$
{ pop$ pop$ format.pages }
{
%<volp-sp> ": " *
%<*!volp-sp>
%<volp-blk> " " *
%<*!volp-blk>
%<volp-com> ", " *
%<*!volp-com>
%<volp-semi> "; " *
%<!volp-semi> ":" *
%</!volp-com>
%</!volp-blk>
%</!volp-sp>
%<!jdt-v&!jdt-vs&jdt-p> format.year * " " *
%<!jdt-v&!jdt-vs&!jdt-p&jdt-pc> format.year * ", " *
swap$
%<jpg-1> first.page
%<!jpg-1> n.dashify
%<*jwdpg>
pages multi.page.check
'bbl.pages
'bbl.page
if$
swap$ tie.or.space.prefix
%</jwdpg>
"pages" bibinfo.check
%<jwdpg> * *
*
}
if$
}
if$
}
% \end{macrocode}
% \end{macro}
%
% \begin{macro}{`format.journal.eid'}
%
% \changes{3.89d1}{1999 July 20}{AO: add function to emit the eid information.}
% This function is called with something on the stack (journal vol, number)
% and appends \texttt{eid} and \texttt{numpages} if those field are non-empty.
% Very similar to \texttt{format.journal.pages}.
%
% For the AGU style of including the DOI as part of the EID, the DOI number
% is appended too.
% \begin{macrocode}
FUNCTION {format.journal.eid}
{ eid "eid" bibinfo.check
duplicate$ empty$ 'pop$
{ swap$ duplicate$ empty$ 'skip$
{
%<volp-sp> ": " *
%<*!volp-sp>
%<volp-blk> " " *
%<*!volp-blk>
%<volp-com> ", " *
%<*!volp-com>
%<volp-semi> "; " *
%<!volp-semi> ":" *
%</!volp-com>
%</!volp-blk>
%</!volp-sp>
}
if$
swap$ *
%<*revdata>
numpages empty$ 'skip$
{ bbl.eidpp numpages tie.or.space.prefix
"numpages" bibinfo.check * *
" (" swap$ * ")" * *
}
if$
%</revdata>
}
if$
}
% \end{macrocode}
% \end{macro}
%
% \begin{macro}{`format.vol.num.pages'}
% \changes{1.4(2.2)}{1994 Sep 6}{Add option \texttt{volp-sp} to put space
% after colon in vol:~page.}
% \changes{1.5(2.3)c}{1995 Jan 20}{Add options \texttt{vnum-h},
% \texttt{vnum-nr} and \texttt{vnum-x} for various formats of
% journal vol number}
% \changes{1.7(2.5)}{1995 Feb 9}{Add options \texttt{vnum-sp} and
% \texttt{vnum-cm}}
% \changes{3.0}{1995 Mar 17}{Add option \texttt{volp-semi}}
% \changes{3.4}{1995 Sep 28}{Put \texttt{bolden} in right place for
% \texttt{vol-2bf} option}
% \changes{3.8}{1996 Mar 19}{Put date between volume and number}
% \changes{3.8}{1996 Mar 19}{Add possibilitity of `page' word}
% \changes{3.81}{1996 Jun 19}{Activate \texttt{jwdpg} option properly}
% \changes{3.81}{1996 Jun 19}{Add possibilitity of `volume' word}
% \changes{3.82}{1996 Nov 15}{Add option \texttt{pp-last}}
% Version 3.84, I have rationalized several options that placed the date in the
% journal specifications. It was rather chaotic before, but now it should be
% more systematic. This means some options have been removed, something that I
% do not like to do.
%
% The option \texttt{pp-last} suppresses the pages in the formatting macros, and
% sees to it that the pages are added just before any notes in those entries
% that take pages. This applies to more than just \texttt{article}, but to
% \texttt{inbook}, \texttt{incollection} as well.
%
% \changes{3.89d1}{1999 July 20}{AO: encapsulate the volume and number for
% further processing.}
% \begin{macrocode}
FUNCTION {format.vol.num.pages}
{ volume field.or.null
duplicate$ empty$ 'skip$
{
%<jwdvol> bbl.volume swap$ tie.or.space.prefix
"volume" bibinfo.check
%<jwdvol> * *
}
if$
%<vol-bf&!vol-2bf> bolden
%<!vol-bf&!vol-2bf&vol-it> emphasize
%<jdt-v|jdt-vs> format.year *
%<*!vnum-x>
number "number" bibinfo.check duplicate$ empty$ 'skip$
{
swap$ duplicate$ empty$
{ "there's a number but no volume in " cite$ * warning$ }
'skip$
if$
swap$
%<vnum-sp> "~(" swap$ * ")" *
%<!vnum-sp&vnum-cm> ", " swap$ *
%<!vnum-sp&!vnum-cm&vnum-nr> ", " bbl.nr * number tie.or.space.prefix pop$ * swap$ *
%<!vnum-sp&!vnum-cm&!vnum-nr&vnum-h> ", \#" swap$ *
%<!vnum-sp&!vnum-cm&!vnum-nr&!vnum-h&vnum-b> " " swap$ *
%<!vnum-sp&!vnum-cm&!vnum-nr&!vnum-h&!vnum-b> "(" swap$ * ")" *
}
if$ *
%<!vol-bf&vol-2bf> bolden
%</!vnum-x>
%<*!pp-last>
eid empty$
{ format.journal.pages }
{ format.journal.eid }
if$
%</!pp-last>
}
% \end{macrocode}
% \end{macro}
%
% \begin{macro}{`format.chapter.pages'}
% \changes{3.89d1}{1999 July 20}{AO: encapsulate series and chapter for
% further processing.}
% \begin{macrocode}
FUNCTION {format.chapter.pages}
{ chapter empty$
%<!pp-last> 'format.pages
%<pp-last> { "" }
{ type empty$
{ bbl.chapter }
{ type "l" change.case$
"type" bibinfo.check
}
if$
chapter tie.or.space.prefix
"chapter" bibinfo.check
* *
%<*!pp-last>
pages empty$
'skip$
{ ", " * format.pages * }
if$
%</!pp-last>
}
if$
}
% \end{macrocode}
% \end{macro}
%
% \begin{macro}{`bt.enquote'}
% \changes{3.84}{1997 Oct 31}{Add function}
% \changes{3.89d1}{1999 July 20}{AO: trap \texttt{empty\$} argument}
% This is to place the booktitle for proceedings and collections into quotes.
% If punctuation is to be included, then add a comma unless a stop already
% exists, or add a period under the only circumstances that
% |format.in.ed.booktitle| is followed by |new.sentence|.
% \begin{macrocode}
%<*bt-qq>
FUNCTION {bt.enquote}
{ duplicate$ empty$ 'skip$
{ "\enquote{" swap$ *
%<*!qx>
non.stop
{ ",} " * }
{ "}, " * }
if$
%</!qx>
%<*qx>
"}, " *
%</qx>
}
if$
}
%</bt-qq>
% \end{macrocode}
%
% \end{macro}
%
% \begin{macro}{`format.booktitle'}
% \changes{3.89d1}{1999 July 20}{AO: new function}
% The function \texttt{format.booktitle} pushes one object
% (the book title, suitably encapsulated) onto the stack.
% It is currently used in \texttt{format.incoll.inproc.crossref}
% and in \texttt{format.in.ed.booktitle}, and should be used whenever accessing
% the \texttt{booktitle} field for eventual output.
%
% If the book title is empty or missing, the function pushes an empty string.
% \begin{macrocode}
FUNCTION {format.booktitle}
{
booktitle "booktitle" bibinfo.check
%<!bt-qq&!bt-rm> emphasize
%<bt-qq> bt.enquote
}
% \end{macrocode}
% \end{macro}
%
% \begin{macro}{`format.in.ed.booktitle'}
% \changes{1.5(2.3)b}{1995 Jan 18}{Add option \texttt{edby-par} to put editors
% in parentheses}
% \changes{1.6(2.4)}{1995 Feb 2}{If \texttt{ed} and \texttt{edby} given
% together, abbreviate `edited by' to `ed(s).'}
% \changes{3.1}{1995 May 2}{Add option \texttt{edbyx} to replace `edited by'
% by `ed(s).'}
% \changes{3.81}{1996 Jun 26}{Add option \texttt{edcap}}
% \changes{3.84}{1997 Oct 10}{Fix bug that added extra space sometimes}
% \changes{3.88}{1998 Dec 2}{Book titles may also be roman}
% \changes{3.88}{1998 Dec 2}{New options \texttt{edby-parc} and \texttt{edbyw}}
% \changes{3.89d1}{1999 July 20}{AO: rewritten; encapsulates \texttt{booktitle} and
% \texttt{editor} for later processing}
% \changes{4.00}{1999 Sept 17}{PWD: fix up several bugs}
% Prior to version 3.81, the \textsl{Editor} or \textsl{Edited by} in
% parentheses was meant to be capitalized, but this did not work properly.
% Now the option \texttt{edcap} produces this, and default is not capitalized.
%
% Notes on \dtx{} options:
% \begin{itemize}
% \item
% The following combinations are available through the \texttt{makebst.tex} interface:
% \begin{verbatim}
% (
% <default>
% |edby ( |edbyx |edbyy|edbyw[edcap])
% |edby-par (|edcap|edbyx[edcap]|edbyy )
% |edby-parc(|edcap|edbyx )
% )
% \end{verbatim}
% \item
% \texttt{edby}, \texttt{edby-par}, and \texttt{edby-parc} are mutually exclusive
% and, except for the default, exhaustive.
% \item
% \texttt{edbyx}, \texttt{edbyw}, and \texttt{edbyy} are mutually exclusive
% and, except for the default, exhaustive.
% \item
% \texttt{edcap} is independent of the above two groups of options.
% \item
% When parentheses need to be applied, we make sure that the respective
% \dtx{} guard expressions are mutually exclusive.
% It makes no sense for \texttt{edbyw} to be in effect if either of
% \texttt{edby-par} or \texttt{edby-parc} is in effect.
% \item
% \texttt{makebst.tex} only activates \texttt{edcap} in certain cases,
% but we do no checking here, applying it consistently to the
% ``editor'' text entity.
% \item
% The code between \texttt{<!edpar>} and \verb+<edpar\|edparc>+
% \emph{must} match the corresponding code in \texttt{format.editors}.
% This means that in the default case, formatting is controlled by
% a \dtx{} mechanism entirely different from the other cases.
% \item \texttt{ser-ed} has been added to suit AGU. Result of series plus
% volume to go between booktitle and editors; must remove \texttt{format.bvolume}
% from \texttt{incollection} and \texttt{inproceedings}.
% \end{itemize}
%
% \begin{macrocode}
FUNCTION {format.in.ed.booktitle}
{ format.booktitle duplicate$ empty$ 'skip$
{
%<showstack>% btitle
%<*ser-ed>
format.bvolume duplicate$ empty$ 'pop$
{ ", " swap$ * * }
if$
%</ser-ed>
editor "editor" format.names.ed duplicate$ empty$ 'pop$
{
%<*!(edby|edby-par|edby-parc)>
%<showstack>% btitle ednms
%<!edpar&!edparxc> "," *
" " *
get.bbl.editor
%<bkedcap> capitalize
%<edpar> "(" swap$ * "), " *
%<!edpar&(edparc|edparxc)> "(" swap$ * ") " *
%<!edpar&!(edparc|edparxc)> ", " *
* swap$
%<showstack>% eds btitle
%</!(edby|edby-par|edby-parc)>
%<*edby|edby-par|edby-parc>
%<showstack>% btitle ednms
%<edbyx|edbyy|edbyw> get.bbl.editor
%<!(edbyx|edbyy|edbyw)> bbl.edby
%<edcap> capitalize
%<!(edby-par|edby-parc)&edbyw> "(" swap$ * ")" *
%<showstack>% btitle ednms ed
%<(edby-par|edby)&edbyy> swap$ "," *
" " * swap$ *
%<showstack>% btitle ednms-ed
%<(edby-par|edby-parc)&!edbyw> "(" swap$ * ")" *
swap$
%<edby|edby-parc> "," *
" " * swap$
%</edby|edby-par|edby-parc>
%<showstack>% btitle ednms-ed (or ednms-ed btitle)
* }
if$
%<showstack>% btitle-ednms-ed (or ednms-ed-btitle) (or btitle)
word.in swap$ *
}
if$
}
% \end{macrocode}
% \end{macro}
%
% \begin{macro}{`empty.misc.check'}
% \begin{macrocode}
%<*!ay>
FUNCTION {empty.misc.check}
{ author empty$ title empty$ howpublished empty$
month empty$ year empty$ note empty$
and and and and and
%<!seq-no|alph> key empty$ not and
{ "all relevant fields are empty in " cite$ * warning$ }
'skip$
if$
}
%</!ay>
% \end{macrocode}
% \end{macro}
%
% \begin{macro}{`format.thesis.type'}
% \begin{macrocode}
FUNCTION {format.thesis.type}
{ type duplicate$ empty$
'pop$
{ swap$ pop$
"t" change.case$ "type" bibinfo.check
}
if$
}
% \end{macrocode}
% \end{macro}
%
% \begin{macro}{`format.tr.number'}
% \changes{4.01}{2000 May 4}{Encapsulate number}
% \begin{macrocode}
FUNCTION {format.tr.number}
{ number "number" bibinfo.check
type duplicate$ empty$
{ pop$ bbl.techrep }
'skip$
if$
"type" bibinfo.check
swap$ duplicate$ empty$
{ pop$ "t" change.case$ }
{ tie.or.space.prefix * * }
if$
}
% \end{macrocode}
% \end{macro}
%
% \begin{macro}{`format.article.crossref'}
%\changes{1.3(2.1)}{1994 Jul 1}{Emphasize \texttt{journal} with
% \texttt{emphasize}, not explicitly}
% \changes{3.89d1}{1999 July 20}{AO: encapsulate journal for further processing.}
% The \texttt{journal} field was emphasized emplicitly, but it should be
% done by command.
% \begin{macrocode}
FUNCTION {format.article.crossref}
{
%<*!ay>
key duplicate$ empty$
{ pop$
journal duplicate$ empty$
{ "need key or journal for " cite$ * " to crossref " * crossref * warning$ }
{ "journal" bibinfo.check emphasize word.in swap$ * }
if$
}
{ word.in swap$ * " " *}
if$
%</!ay>
%<ay> word.in
%<!html> " \cite{" * crossref * "}" *
%<html> " <tt>" * crossref * "</tt>" *
}
% \end{macrocode}
% \end{macro}
%
% \begin{macro}{`format.crossref.editor'}
% \changes{3.89d1}{1999 July 20}{AO: editor encapsulated for later processing}
% \changes{3.89d1}{1999 July 20}{AO: fixed typo: "etal_rm"->"etal-rm"}
% \begin{macrocode}
%<*!ay>
FUNCTION {format.crossref.editor}
{ editor #1 "{vv~}{ll}" format.name$
%<nmft&nmfted&nmand-rm> bib.name.font
"editor" bibinfo.check
editor num.names$ duplicate$
#2 >
{ pop$
%<nmft&nmfted&!nmand-rm&(etal-it|etal-rm)> bib.name.font
"editor" bibinfo.check
" " * bbl.etal
%<etal-it> emphasize
*
%<nmft&nmfted&!nmand-rm&!(etal-it|etal-rm)> bib.name.font
%<nmft&nmfted&!nmand-rm&!(etal-it|etal-rm)> "others" 't :=
}
{ #2 <
'skip$
{ editor #2 "{ff }{vv }{ll}{ jj}" format.name$ "others" =
{
%<nmft&nmfted&!nmand-rm&(etal-it|etal-rm)> bib.name.font
"editor" bibinfo.check
" " * bbl.etal
%<etal-it> emphasize
*
%<nmft&nmfted&!nmand-rm&!(etal-it|etal-rm)> bib.name.font
%<nmft&nmfted&!nmand-rm&!(etal-it|etal-rm)> "others" 't :=
}
{
%<*!harnm>
%<!amper> bbl.and space.word
%<amper> " \& "
%</!harnm>
%<harnm> " \harvardand\ "
* editor #2 "{vv~}{ll}" format.name$
%<nmft&nmfted&nmand-rm> bib.name.font
"editor" bibinfo.check
*
}
if$
}
if$
}
if$
%<*nmft&nmfted&!nmand-rm>
t "others" =
'skip$
{ bib.name.font "editor" bibinfo.check }
if$
%</nmft&nmfted&!nmand-rm>
}
%</!ay>
% \end{macrocode}
% \end{macro}
%
% \begin{macro}{`format.book.crossref'}
%\changes{1.3(2.1)}{1994 Jul 1}{Emphasize \texttt{series} with
% \texttt{emphasize}, not explicitly}
% \changes{3.89d1}{1999 July 20}{AO: encapsulate volume and series for
% further processing.}
% The \texttt{series} field was emphasized emplicitly, but it should be
% done by command.
% \begin{macrocode}
FUNCTION {format.book.crossref}
{ volume duplicate$ empty$
{ "empty volume in " cite$ * "'s crossref of " * crossref * warning$
pop$ word.in
}
{ bbl.volume
%<!(blk-com|blk-tita)> capitalize
swap$ tie.or.space.prefix "volume" bibinfo.check * * bbl.of space.word *
}
if$
%<*!ay>
editor empty$
editor field.or.null author field.or.null =
or
{ key empty$
{ series empty$
{ "need editor, key, or series for " cite$ * " to crossref " *
crossref * warning$
"" *
}
{ series emphasize * }
if$
}
{ key * }
if$
}
{ format.crossref.editor * }
if$
%</!ay>
%<!html> " \cite{" * crossref * "}" *
%<html> " <tt>" * crossref * "</tt>" *
}
% \end{macrocode}
% \end{macro}
%
% \begin{macro}{`format.incoll.inproc.crossref'}
%\changes{1.3(2.1)}{1994 Jul 1}{Emphasize \texttt{booktitle} with
% \texttt{emphasize}, not explicitly}
% \changes{3.89d1}{1999 July 20}{AO: call \texttt{format.booktitle}}
% The \texttt{booktitle} field was emphasized emplicitly, but it should be
% done by command.
% \begin{macrocode}
FUNCTION {format.incoll.inproc.crossref}
{
%<*!ay>
editor empty$
editor field.or.null author field.or.null =
or
{ key empty$
{ format.booktitle duplicate$ empty$
{ "need editor, key, or booktitle for " cite$ * " to crossref " *
crossref * warning$
}
{ word.in swap$ * }
if$
}
{ word.in key * " " *}
if$
}
{ word.in format.crossref.editor * " " *}
if$
%</!ay>
%<ay> word.in
%<!html> " \cite{" * crossref * "}" *
%<html> " <tt>" * crossref * "</tt>" *
}
% \end{macrocode}
% \end{macro}
%
% \begin{macro}{`format.org.or.pub'}
% \changes{3.3}{1995 Aug 7}{Add option \texttt{add-pub} which makes use
% of this function}
% \changes{3.8}{1996 Mar 12}{Add option \texttt{pub-par} to put publisher
% in parentheses}
% \changes{3.81}{1996 Sep 16}{Add option \texttt{pub-date} to put publisher
% and date in parentheses together}
% \changes{3.82}{1996 Dec 16}{Add \texttt{add.blank} for \texttt{pub-par}}
% \changes{3.88}{1998 Dec 2}{Add extra label with \texttt{pub-date}}
% \changes{3.88}{1998 Dec 2}{Option \texttt{pub-nopar} to suppress parentheses
% with \texttt{pub-date}}
% \changes{3.88}{1998 Dec 3}{Change to include organization if present}
% \changes{4.02}{2000 June 27}{Include \texttt{dtbf} option with \texttt{pub-date}}
% Psychology journals often want \textit{address}: \textit{publisher}.
%
% \textsl{Nature} wants publisher and date in parentheses, and when both
% are there, they are merged into one set.
%
% Call function \texttt{add.blank} before parentheses so suppress preceding
% punctuation, which looks strange when publisher in parentheses.
%
% MPG Jahrbuch wants publisher and year, but without parentheses. Add
% \texttt{pub-nopar} to be used with \texttt{pub-date}.
%
% Have now (3.87.h) extended this function to include the organization, if
% present. This is for \texttt{inproceedings} and \texttt{proceedings} where
% the publisher is optional, and organization too. If the publisher is missing,
% but the organization present, it is formatted like the publisher. This
% complication comes from styles that want the publisher/organization to have
% the date included, all in parentheses.
%
% This function is called by \texttt{format.publisher.address} and
% \texttt{format.organization.address}, each putting the appropriate text
% into the stack first.
% \changes{3.89d1}{1999 July 20}{AO: encapsulate address and year for
% further processing.}
%
% \begin{macrocode}
FUNCTION {format.org.or.pub}
{ 't :=
""
%<*pub-date&!ay>
year empty$
{ "empty year in " cite$ * warning$ }
'skip$
if$
%</pub-date&!ay>
%<*!(pub-date&ay)>
address empty$ t empty$ and
%<pub-date> year empty$ and
'skip$
{
%</!(pub-date&ay)>
%<pub-par|(pub-date&!pub-xpar)> add.blank "(" *
%<*add-pub>
address "address" bibinfo.check *
t empty$
'skip$
%</add-pub>
%<*!add-pub>
t empty$
{ address "address" bibinfo.check *
}
{ t *
address empty$
'skip$
{ ", " * address "address" bibinfo.check * }
if$
}
%</!add-pub>
%<*add-pub>
{ address empty$
'skip$
{ ": " * }
if$
t *
}
%</add-pub>
if$
%<*pub-date&!ay>
year empty$
'skip$
{ t empty$ address empty$ and
'skip$
{ ", " * }
if$
year "year" bibinfo.check
%<dtbf> bolden
*
}
if$
%</pub-date&!ay>
%<*pub-date&ay>
year duplicate$ empty$
%<*!blkyear>
{ "empty year in " cite$ * "; set to ????" * warning$
pop$ "????" }
%</!blkyear>
%<*blkyear>
{ "empty year in " cite$ * warning$
pop$ "" }
%</blkyear>
%<!dtbf> { "year" bibinfo.check extra.label * }
%<dtbf> { "year" bibinfo.check bolden extra.label * }
if$
t empty$ address empty$ and
{ * }
%<!pub-xc> { ", " swap$ * * }
%<pub-xc> { " " swap$ * * }
if$
%</pub-date&ay>
%<pub-par|(pub-date&!pub-xpar)> ")" *
%<*!(pub-date&ay)>
}
if$
%</!(pub-date&ay)>
}
% \end{macrocode}
% \end{macro}
%
% \begin{macro}{`format.publisher.address'}
% \changes{3.88}{1998 Dec 3}{Add macro; works with \texttt{format.org.or.pub}}
% \changes{3.89d1}{1999 July 20}{AO: encapsulate \texttt{publisher}
% and \texttt{organization}}
% \changes{4.00}{1999 Oct 28}{Check with \texttt{bibinfo.warn}}
% \begin{macrocode}
FUNCTION {format.publisher.address}
{ publisher "publisher" bibinfo.warn format.org.or.pub
}
% \end{macrocode}
% \end{macro}
%
% \begin{macro}{`format.organization.address'}
% \changes{3.88}{1998 Dec 3}{Add macro; works with \texttt{format.org.or.pub}}
% \begin{macrocode}
FUNCTION {format.organization.address}
{ organization "organization" bibinfo.check format.org.or.pub
}
% \end{macrocode}
% \end{macro}
%
% \begin{macro}{`name.or.dash'}
% \changes{3.83}{1997 Feb 5}{Add function to replace repeated names by dash}
% \changes{4.06}{2003 Apr 2}{Add double and triple dashes}
% This function stores what is on the stack, compares it with previous value,
% and replaces it with a long dash if they are equal. What is on the stack
% should be author or editor names for the current entry.
% \begin{macrocode}
%<*nmdash>
STRINGS {oldname}
FUNCTION {name.or.dash}
{ 's :=
oldname empty$
{ s 'oldname := s }
{ s oldname =
%<*!au-col>
%<!nmd-2&!nmd-3> { "---" }
%<nmd-2&!nmd-3> { "---{}---" }
%<nmd-3> { "---{}---{}---" }
%</!au-col>
%<*au-col>
%<!nmd-2&!nmd-3> { "---" add.blank }
%<nmd-2&!nmd-3> { "---{}---" add.blank }
%<nmd-3> { "---{}---{}---" add.blank }
%</au-col>
{ s 'oldname := s }
if$
}
if$
}
%</nmdash>
% \end{macrocode}
% \end{macro}
%
% \begin{macro}{`article'}
% \changes{1.5(2.3)b}{1995 Jan 18}{Add option \texttt{yrp-x} to suppress
% punctuation following date at beginning}
% \changes{3.0}{1995 Mar 8}{Add option \texttt{yrp-col} to add colon after
% date at beginning}
% \changes{3.0}{1995 Mar 20}{Add option \texttt{jxper} to remove periods
% from journal name}
% \changes{3.2}{1995 May 19}{Add option \texttt{dt-jnl} to make date part of
% the journal specification, follows journal name.}
% \changes{3.4}{1995 Sep 28}{Add option \texttt{au-col}}
% \changes{3.6}{1995 Nov 23}{Add option \texttt{jttl-rm}}
% \changes{3.7}{1996 Feb 5}{Put \texttt{purify\$} before \texttt{emphasize}}
% \changes{3.81}{1996 Jun 26}{Add option \texttt{blk-tita} for article only}
% \changes{3.83}{1997 Feb 5}{Add option \texttt{blknt} for period before notes}
% \changes{3.88}{1999 Feb 25}{Add option \texttt{injnl} for `in' with journal
% names}
%
% \changes{3.89d1}{1999 July 20}{AO: call \texttt{format.journal} and
% \texttt{format.journal.eid}; call \texttt{format.eprint}, and
% \texttt{format.url}.}
% \changes{4.02}{2000 June 27}{Fix bug with texttt{injnl}}
% \changes{4.10}{2003 May 28}{Add \texttt{format.doi}}
% \begin{macrocode}
FUNCTION {article}
{ output.bibitem
format.authors "author" output.check
%<ay> author format.key output
%<au-col> add.colon
%<nmdash> name.or.dash
%<*dt-beg&!jdt-p&!jdt-pc&!jdt-vs&!jdt-v>
format.date "year" output.check
date.block
%</dt-beg&!jdt-p&!jdt-pc&!jdt-vs&!jdt-v>
%<!dt-beg&!blk-com&!blk-tit&!blk-tita> new.block
%<*!jtit-x>
format.title "title" output.check
%<blk-com&tit-qq> end.quote.title
%<!blk-com&!blk-tit&!blk-tita> new.block
%<*blk-tit|blk-tita>
%<!tit-col> new.sentence
%<tit-col> add.colon
%</blk-tit|blk-tita>
%</!jtit-x>
crossref missing$
{
journal
%<jxper> remove.dots
"journal" bibinfo.check
%<!jttl-rm> emphasize
%<injnl> word.in swap$ *
"journal" output.check
%<jnm-x> add.blank
%<*!dt-beg&!dt-end&dt-jnl&!jdt-p&!jdt-pc&!jdt-vs&!jdt-v>
format.date "year" output.check
date.block
%</!dt-beg&!dt-end&dt-jnl&!jdt-p&!jdt-pc&!jdt-vs&!jdt-v>
format.vol.num.pages output
%<doi&agu-doi> format.doi output
%<*!dt-beg&!dt-end&!dt-jnl&!jdt-p&!jdt-pc&!jdt-vs&!jdt-v>
format.date "year" output.check
%</!dt-beg&!dt-end&!dt-jnl&!jdt-p&!jdt-pc&!jdt-vs&!jdt-v>
}
{ format.article.crossref output.nonnull
%<!pp-last> format.pages output
}
if$
%<*pp-last>
eid empty$
{ format.journal.pages }
{ format.journal.eid }
if$
%</pp-last>
%<issn> format.issn output
%<doi&!agu-doi> format.doi output
%<*url-blk&!harnm&!revdata>
%<!blk-com&!blk-tit&!blk-tita> new.block
format.url output
%</url-blk&!harnm&!revdata>
%<!blk-com&!blk-tit&!blk-tita> new.block
%<(blk-com|blk-tit|blk-tita)&blknt> new.sentence
format.note output
%<*!dt-beg&dt-end&!jdt-p&!jdt-pc&!jdt-vs&!jdt-v>
%<!blk-com&!blk-tit&!blk-tita> new.block
format.date "year" output.check
%</!dt-beg&dt-end&!jdt-p&!jdt-pc&!jdt-vs&!jdt-v>
%<eprint> format.eprint output
%<*revdata>
format.url output
%</revdata>
fin.entry
%<harnm|url-nl> write.url
}
% \end{macrocode}
% \end{macro}
%
% \begin{macro}{`book'}
%\changes{2.0a}{1994 Aug 30}{Fix up \texttt{new.sentence} so not added with
% \texttt{blk-com}}
% \changes{3.89d1}{1999 July 20}{AO: call \texttt{format.eprint}, and \texttt{format.url}.}
% \changes{4.10}{2003 May 28}{Add \texttt{format.doi}}
% \begin{macrocode}
FUNCTION {book}
{ output.bibitem
author empty$
{ format.editors "author and editor" output.check
%<ay> editor format.key output
%<!edpar&(edparc|edparxc)&!au-col> add.blank
%<au-col> add.colon
%<nmdash> name.or.dash
}
{ format.authors output.nonnull
%<au-col> add.colon
%<nmdash> name.or.dash
crossref missing$
{ "author and editor" editor either.or.check }
'skip$
if$
}
if$
%<dt-beg&!pub-date> format.date "year" output.check
%<dt-beg&!pub-date> date.block
%<!dt-beg&!blk-com&!blk-tit&!blk-tita> new.block
format.btitle "title" output.check
crossref missing$
{ format.bvolume output
%<!blk-com&!blk-tit&!blk-tita> new.block
%<blk-tit&!tit-col> new.sentence
%<blk-tit&tit-col> add.colon
%<!numser> format.number.series output
%<pre-edn> format.edition output
%<!blk-com&!blk-tit&!blk-tita> new.sentence
%<numser> format.number.series output
%<pg-bk&pg-pre> format.book.pages output
format.publisher.address output
}
{
%<!blk-com&!blk-tit&!blk-tita> new.block
%<blk-tit&!tit-col> new.sentence
%<blk-tit&tit-col> add.colon
format.book.crossref output.nonnull
%<!dt-beg&!dt-end&pub-date> format.date "year" output.check
}
if$
%<!pre-edn> format.edition output
%<!dt-beg&!dt-end&!pub-date> format.date "year" output.check
%<isbn> format.isbn output
%<pg-bk&!pg-pre> format.book.pages output
%<doi> format.doi output
%<*url-blk&!harnm&!revdata>
%<!blk-com&!blk-tit&!blk-tita> new.block
format.url output
%</url-blk&!harnm&!revdata>
%<!blk-com&!blk-tit&!blk-tita> new.block
%<(blk-com|blk-tit|blk-tita)&blknt> new.sentence
format.note output
%<*!dt-beg&dt-end&!pub-date>
%<!blk-com&!blk-tit&!blk-tita> new.block
format.date "year" output.check
%</!dt-beg&dt-end&!pub-date>
%<eprint> format.eprint output
%<revdata> format.url output
fin.entry
%<(harnm|url-nl)&!revdata> write.url
}
% \end{macrocode}
% \end{macro}
%
% \begin{macro}{`booklet'}
% \changes{3.89d1}{1999 July 20}{AO: call \texttt{format.eprint}, and \texttt{format.url}.}
% \changes{4.10}{2003 May 28}{Add \texttt{format.doi}}
% \begin{macrocode}
FUNCTION {booklet}
{ output.bibitem
format.authors output
%<ay> author format.key output
%<au-col> add.colon
%<nmdash> name.or.dash
%<ay&dt-beg> format.date "year" output.check
%<!ay&dt-beg> format.date output
%<dt-beg> date.block
%<!dt-beg&!blk-com&!blk-tit&!blk-tita> new.block
format.title "title" output.check
%<blk-com&tit-qq> end.quote.title
%<!blk-com&!blk-tit&!blk-tita> new.block
%<blk-tit&!tit-col> new.sentence
%<blk-tit&tit-col> add.colon
howpublished "howpublished" bibinfo.check output
address "address" bibinfo.check output
%<ay&!dt-beg&!dt-end> format.date "year" output.check
%<!ay&!dt-beg&!dt-end> format.date output
%<isbn> format.isbn output
%<pg-bk> format.book.pages output
%<doi> format.doi output
%<*url-blk&!harnm&!revdata>
%<!blk-com&!blk-tit&!blk-tita> new.block
format.url output
%</url-blk&!harnm&!revdata>
%<!blk-com&!blk-tit&!blk-tita> new.block
%<(blk-com|blk-tit|blk-tita)&blknt> new.sentence
format.note output
%<*ay&!dt-beg&dt-end>
%<!blk-com&!blk-tit&!blk-tita> new.block
format.date "year" output.check
%</ay&!dt-beg&dt-end>
%<*!ay&!dt-beg&dt-end>
%<!blk-com&!blk-tit&!blk-tita> new.block
format.date output
%</!ay&!dt-beg&dt-end>
%<eprint> format.eprint output
%<revdata> format.url output
fin.entry
%<(harnm|url-nl)&!revdata> write.url
}
% \end{macrocode}
% \end{macro}
%
% \begin{macro}{`inbook'}
% \changes{3.86}{1998 Feb 25}{Use \texttt{format.date} in place of
% \texttt{year} alone}
% \changes{3.89d1}{1999 July 20}{AO: call \texttt{format.eprint}, and \texttt{format.url}.}
% \changes{4.10}{2003 May 28}{Add \texttt{format.doi}}
% The medical journals, with option \texttt{dt-jnl}, have the date as part of
% the journal specification. For chapters in books, they want date and pages
% to appear at the end, with a space between them. (For journals, there is to be
% no space.) Suppress the chapter specification (for now).
%
% The \texttt{dt-jnl} option usually behaves as the default, except for some
% special entries, like this one.
%
% \changes{4.13}{2004 Feb 9}{Restore chap specification with \texttt{dt-jnl} option.}
% Restore the chapter specification (2004 Feb 9) after someone complained.
% There are still some bugs here. If some date punctuation is specified, say
% with \texttt{yrp-semi) for a semi-colon after the year, this appears always,
% even if there is no text following. But then this to be an unlikely wish anyway,
% since such punctuation options are best suited for \texttt{dt-beg}.
% \begin{macrocode}
FUNCTION {inbook}
{ output.bibitem
author empty$
{ format.editors "author and editor" output.check
%<ay> editor format.key output
%<au-col> add.colon
%<nmdash> name.or.dash
}
{ format.authors output.nonnull
%<au-col> add.colon
%<nmdash> name.or.dash
crossref missing$
{ "author and editor" editor either.or.check }
'skip$
if$
}
if$
%<dt-beg&!pub-date> format.date "year" output.check
%<dt-beg&!pub-date> date.block
%<!dt-beg&!blk-com&!blk-tit&!blk-tita> new.block
format.btitle "title" output.check
crossref missing$
{
%<pre-pub&numser> format.number.series output
%<pre-pub> format.publisher.address output
format.bvolume output
%<*dt-beg|dt-end|!dt-jnl|a|!a>
format.chapter.pages "chapter and pages" output.check
%</dt-beg|dt-end|!dt-jnl|a|!a>
%<!blk-com&!blk-tit&!blk-tita> new.block
%<blk-tit&!tit-col> new.sentence
%<blk-tit&tit-col> add.colon
%<!numser> format.number.series output
%<pre-edn> format.edition output
%<!blk-com&!blk-tit&!blk-tita> new.sentence
%<!pre-pub&numser> format.number.series output
%<!pre-pub> format.publisher.address output
}
{
%<*dt-beg|dt-end|!dt-jnl|a|!a>
format.chapter.pages "chapter and pages" output.check
%</dt-beg|dt-end|!dt-jnl|a|!a>
%<!blk-com&!blk-tit&!blk-tita> new.block
%<blk-tit&!tit-col> new.sentence
%<blk-tit&tit-col> add.colon
format.book.crossref output.nonnull
%<!dt-beg&!dt-end&!dt-jnl&pub-date> format.date "year" output.check
}
if$
%<!pre-edn> format.edition output
%<!dt-beg&!dt-end&!dt-jnl&!pub-date> format.date "year" output.check
%<*isbn>
crossref missing$
{ format.isbn output }
'skip$
if$
%</isbn>
%<*(!dt-beg&!dt-end&dt-jnl)&!pub-date>
format.date "year" output.check
date.block
%</(!dt-beg&!dt-end&dt-jnl)&!pub-date>
%<pp-last> format.pages "pages" output.check
%<doi> format.doi output
%<*url-blk&!harnm&!revdata>
%<!blk-com&!blk-tit&!blk-tita> new.block
format.url output
%</url-blk&!harnm&!revdata>
%<!blk-com&!blk-tit&!blk-tita> new.block
%<(blk-com|blk-tit|blk-tita)&blknt> new.sentence
format.note output
%<*!dt-beg&dt-end&!pub-date>
%<!blk-com&!blk-tit&!blk-tita> new.block
format.date "year" output.check
%</!dt-beg&dt-end&!pub-date>
%<eprint> format.eprint output
%<revdata> format.url output
fin.entry
%<(harnm|url-nl)&!revdata> write.url
}
% \end{macrocode}
% \end{macro}
%
% \begin{macro}{`incollection'}
% \changes{3.89d1}{1999 July 20}{AO: call \texttt{format.eprint}, and \texttt{format.url}.}
% \changes{4.10}{2003 May 28}{Add \texttt{format.doi}}
% \begin{macrocode}
% \changes{4.13}{2004 Feb 9}{Restore chap specification with \texttt{dt-jnl} option.}
FUNCTION {incollection}
{ output.bibitem
format.authors "author" output.check
%<ay> author format.key output
%<au-col> add.colon
%<nmdash> name.or.dash
%<dt-beg&!pub-date> format.date "year" output.check
%<dt-beg&!pub-date> date.block
%<!dt-beg&!blk-com&!blk-tit&!blk-tita> new.block
%<*!jtit-x>
format.title "title" output.check
%<blk-com&tit-qq> end.quote.title
%<!blk-com&!blk-tit&!blk-tita> new.block
%<blk-tit&!tit-col> new.sentence
%<blk-tit&tit-col> add.colon
%</!jtit-x>
crossref missing$
{ format.in.ed.booktitle "booktitle" output.check
%<bt-qq> end.quote.btitle
%<pre-pub&numser> format.number.series output
%<pre-pub> format.publisher.address output
%<!ser-ed> format.bvolume output
%<!numser> format.number.series output
%<pre-edn> format.edition output
format.chapter.pages output
%<!blk-com&!blk-tit&!blk-tita> new.sentence
%<!pre-pub&numser> format.number.series output
%<!pre-pub> format.publisher.address output
%<!pre-edn> format.edition output
%<!dt-beg&!dt-end&!dt-jnl&!pub-date> format.date "year" output.check
%<isbn> format.isbn output
}
{ format.incoll.inproc.crossref output.nonnull
format.chapter.pages output
}
if$
%<*(!dt-beg&!dt-end&dt-jnl)&!pub-date>
format.date "year" output.check
date.block
%</(!dt-beg&!dt-end&dt-jnl)&!pub-date>
%<pp-last> format.pages "pages" output.check
%<doi> format.doi output
%<*url-blk&!harnm&!revdata>
%<!blk-com&!blk-tit&!blk-tita> new.block
format.url output
%</url-blk&!harnm&!revdata>
%<!blk-com&!blk-tit&!blk-tita> new.block
%<(blk-com|blk-tit|blk-tita)&blknt> new.sentence
format.note output
%<*!dt-beg&dt-end&!pub-date>
%<!blk-com&!blk-tit&!blk-tita> new.block
format.date "year" output.check
%</!dt-beg&dt-end&!pub-date>
%<eprint> format.eprint output
%<revdata> format.url output
fin.entry
%<(harnm|url-nl)&!revdata> write.url
}
% \end{macrocode}
% \end{macro}
%
% \begin{macro}{`inproceedings'}
% \changes{3.81}{1996 Sep 13}{Reorganize organization/publisher}
% \changes{3.85}{1998 Feb 5}{Fix extraneous page output without
% \texttt{pp-last}}
% \changes{3.89d1}{1999 July 20}{AO: call \texttt{format.eprint}, and \texttt{format.url}.}
% \changes{4.05}{2002 Oct 21}{Fix bug with \texttt{pp-last} and \texttt{dt-beg}}
% \changes{4.10}{2003 May 28}{Add \texttt{format.doi}}
% \begin{macrocode}
FUNCTION {inproceedings}
{ output.bibitem
format.authors "author" output.check
%<ay> author format.key output
%<au-col> add.colon
%<nmdash> name.or.dash
%<dt-beg&!pub-date> format.date "year" output.check
%<dt-beg&!pub-date> date.block
%<!dt-beg&!blk-com&!blk-tit&!blk-tita> new.block
%<*!jtit-x>
format.title "title" output.check
%<blk-com&tit-qq> end.quote.title
%<!blk-com&!blk-tit&!blk-tita> new.block
%<blk-tit&!tit-col> new.sentence
%<blk-tit&tit-col> add.colon
%</!jtit-x>
crossref missing$
{ format.in.ed.booktitle "booktitle" output.check
%<bt-qq> end.quote.btitle
%<*!pre-pub>
%<!ser-ed> format.bvolume output
%<!numser> format.number.series output
%<(dt-beg|dt-end|!dt-jnl)&!pp-last> format.pages output
%</!pre-pub>
%<!blk-com&!blk-tit&!blk-tita> new.sentence
%<numser> format.number.series output
publisher empty$
{ format.organization.address output }
{ organization "organization" bibinfo.check output
format.publisher.address output
}
if$
%<!dt-beg&!dt-end&!dt-jnl&!pub-date> format.date "year" output.check
%<*pre-pub>
format.bvolume output
%<!numser> format.number.series output
%<(dt-beg|dt-end|!dt-jnl)&!pp-last> format.pages output
%</pre-pub>
%<isbn> format.isbn output
%<issn> format.issn output
}
{ format.incoll.inproc.crossref output.nonnull
%<(dt-beg|dt-end|!dt-jnl)&!pp-last> format.pages output
}
if$
%<*!dt-beg&!dt-end&dt-jnl&!pp-last>
%<!pub-date> format.date "year" output.check
%<!pub-date> date.block
%<jdt-v|jdt-vs|jdt-p|!jdt-pc> add.blank
format.pages "pages" output.check
%</!dt-beg&!dt-end&dt-jnl&!pp-last>
%<pp-last> format.pages "pages" output.check
%<doi> format.doi output
%<*url-blk&!harnm&!revdata>
%<!blk-com&!blk-tit&!blk-tita> new.block
format.url output
%</url-blk&!harnm&!revdata>
%<!blk-com&!blk-tit&!blk-tita> new.block
%<(blk-com|blk-tit|blk-tita)&blknt> new.sentence
format.note output
%<*!dt-beg&dt-end&!pub-date>
%<!blk-com&!blk-tit&!blk-tita> new.block
format.date "year" output.check
%</!dt-beg&dt-end&!pub-date>
%<eprint> format.eprint output
%<revdata> format.url output
fin.entry
%<(harnm|url-nl)&!revdata> write.url
}
% \end{macrocode}
% \end{macro}
%
% \begin{macro}{`conference'}
% \begin{macrocode}
FUNCTION {conference} { inproceedings }
% \end{macrocode}
% \end{macro}
%
% \begin{macro}{`manual'}
% \changes{3.89d1}{1999 July 20}{AO: call \texttt{format.eprint}, and \texttt{format.url}.}
% \changes{4.10}{2003 May 28}{Add \texttt{format.doi}}
% \begin{macrocode}
%<*ay>
FUNCTION {manual}
{ output.bibitem
format.authors output
author format.key output
%<au-col> add.colon
%<nmdash> name.or.dash
%<dt-beg> format.date "year" output.check
%<dt-beg> date.block
%<!dt-beg&!blk-com&!blk-tit&!blk-tita> new.block
format.btitle "title" output.check
%<blk-tit&!tit-col> new.sentence
%<blk-tit&tit-col> add.colon
%<!blk-com&!blk-tit&!blk-tita> organization address new.block.checkb
organization "organization" bibinfo.check output
address "address" bibinfo.check output
format.edition output
%<!dt-beg&!dt-end> format.date "year" output.check
%<doi> format.doi output
%<*url-blk&!harnm&!revdata>
%<!blk-com&!blk-tit&!blk-tita> new.block
format.url output
%</url-blk&!harnm&!revdata>
%<!blk-com&!blk-tit&!blk-tita> new.block
%<(blk-com|blk-tit|blk-tita)&blknt> new.sentence
format.note output
%<*!dt-beg&dt-end>
%<!blk-com&!blk-tit&!blk-tita> new.block
format.date "year" output.check
%</!dt-beg&dt-end>
%<eprint> format.eprint output
%<revdata> format.url output
fin.entry
%<(harnm|url-nl)&!revdata> write.url
}
%</ay>
%<*!ay>
FUNCTION {manual}
{ output.bibitem
author empty$
{ organization "organization" bibinfo.check
duplicate$ empty$ 'pop$
{ output
address "address" bibinfo.check output
}
if$
}
{ format.authors output.nonnull }
if$
%<au-col> add.colon
%<nmdash> name.or.dash
%<ay&dt-beg> format.date "year" output.check
%<!ay&dt-beg> format.date output
%<dt-beg> date.block
%<!dt-beg&!blk-com&!blk-tit&!blk-tita> new.block
format.btitle "title" output.check
%<blk-tit&!tit-col> new.sentence
%<blk-tit&tit-col> add.colon
author empty$
{ organization empty$
{
%<!blk-com&!blk-tit&!blk-tita> address new.block.checka
address "address" bibinfo.check output
}
'skip$
if$
}
{
%<!blk-com&!blk-tit&!blk-tita> organization address new.block.checkb
organization "organization" bibinfo.check output
address "address" bibinfo.check output
}
if$
format.edition output
%<ay&!dt-beg&!dt-end> format.date "year" output.check
%<!ay&!dt-beg&!dt-end> format.date output
%<doi> format.doi output
%<*url-blk&!harnm&!revdata>
%<!blk-com&!blk-tit&!blk-tita> new.block
format.url output
%</url-blk&!harnm&!revdata>
%<!blk-com&!blk-tit&!blk-tita> new.block
%<(blk-com|blk-tit|blk-tita)&blknt> new.sentence
format.note output
%<*ay&!dt-beg&dt-end>
%<!blk-com&!blk-tit&!blk-tita> new.block
format.date "year" output.check
%</ay&!dt-beg&dt-end>
%<*!ay&!dt-beg&dt-end>
%<!blk-com&!blk-tit&!blk-tita> new.block
format.date output
%</!ay&!dt-beg&dt-end>
%<eprint> format.eprint output
%<revdata> format.url output
fin.entry
%<(harnm|url-nl)&!revdata> write.url
}
%</!ay>
% \end{macrocode}
% \end{macro}
%
% \begin{macro}{`mastersthesis'}
% \changes{2.0}{1994 Feb 7}{Add \texttt{thtit-a} to format thesis titles like
% articles instead of books.}
% \changes{3.89d1}{1999 July 20}{AO: school via \texttt{bibinfo.warn}; call
% \texttt{format.eprint}, and \texttt{format.url}.}
% \changes{4.03}{2002 Jan 14}{Add \texttt{thtit-x}.}
% \changes{4.10}{2003 May 28}{Add \texttt{format.doi}}
% To format a master's thesis.
% \begin{macrocode}
FUNCTION {mastersthesis}
{ output.bibitem
format.authors "author" output.check
%<ay> author format.key output
%<au-col> add.colon
%<nmdash> name.or.dash
%<dt-beg> format.date "year" output.check
%<dt-beg> date.block
%<!dt-beg&!blk-com&!blk-tit&!blk-tita> new.block
%<*!thtit-x>
%<!thtit-a> format.btitle
%<thtit-a> format.title
"title" output.check
%<thtit-a&blk-com&tit-qq> end.quote.title
%<!blk-com&!blk-tit&!blk-tita> new.block
%<blk-tit&!tit-col> new.sentence
%<blk-tit&tit-col> add.colon
%</!thtit-x>
bbl.mthesis format.thesis.type output.nonnull
school "school" bibinfo.warn output
address "address" bibinfo.check output
%<!dt-beg&!dt-end> format.date "year" output.check
%<doi> format.doi output
%<*url-blk&!harnm&!revdata>
%<!blk-com&!blk-tit&!blk-tita> new.block
format.url output
%</url-blk&!harnm&!revdata>
%<!blk-com&!blk-tit&!blk-tita> new.block
%<(blk-com|blk-tit|blk-tita)&blknt> new.sentence
format.note output
%<*!dt-beg&dt-end>
%<!blk-com&!blk-tit&!blk-tita> new.block
format.date "year" output.check
%</!dt-beg&dt-end>
%<eprint> format.eprint output
%<revdata> format.url output
fin.entry
%<(harnm|url-nl)&!revdata> write.url
}
% \end{macrocode}
% \end{macro}
%
% \begin{macro}{`misc'}
% \begin{macrocode}
FUNCTION {misc}
{ output.bibitem
format.authors output
%<ay> author format.key output
%<au-col> add.colon
%<nmdash> name.or.dash
%<ay&dt-beg> format.date "year" output.check
%<!ay&dt-beg> format.date output
%<*ay>
%<dt-beg> date.block
%<!dt-beg&!blk-com&!blk-tit&!blk-tita> new.block
format.title output
%<blk-com&tit-qq> end.quote.title
%<!blk-com&!blk-tit&!blk-tita> new.block
%<blk-tit&!tit-col> new.sentence
%<blk-tit&tit-col> add.colon
%</ay>
%<*!ay>
%<!blk-com&!blk-tit&!blk-tita> title howpublished new.block.checkb
format.title output
%<blk-com&tit-qq> end.quote.title
%<blk-tit&!tit-col> new.sentence
%<blk-tit&tit-col> add.colon
%<!blk-com&!blk-tit&!blk-tita> howpublished new.block.checka
%</!ay>
howpublished "howpublished" bibinfo.check output
%<ay&!dt-beg&!dt-end> format.date "year" output.check
%<!ay&!dt-beg&!dt-end> format.date output
%<doi> format.doi output
%<*url-blk&!harnm&!revdata>
%<!blk-com&!blk-tit&!blk-tita> new.block
format.url output
%</url-blk&!harnm&!revdata>
%<!blk-com&!blk-tit&!blk-tita> new.block
%<(blk-com|blk-tit|blk-tita)&blknt> new.sentence
format.note output
%<*ay&!dt-beg&dt-end>
%<!blk-com&!blk-tit&!blk-tita> new.block
format.date "year" output.check
%</ay&!dt-beg&dt-end>
%<*!ay&!dt-beg&dt-end>
%<!blk-com&!blk-tit&!blk-tita> new.block
format.date output
%</!ay&!dt-beg&dt-end>
%<eprint> format.eprint output
%<revdata> format.url output
fin.entry
%<(harnm|url-nl)&!revdata> write.url
%<!ay> empty.misc.check
}
% \end{macrocode}
% \end{macro}
%
% \begin{macro}{`phdthesis'}
% \changes{2.0}{1994 Feb 7}{Add \texttt{thtit-a} to format thesis titles like
% articles instead of books.}
% \changes{3.89d1}{1999 July 20}{AO: school via \texttt{bibinfo.warn}; call
% \texttt{format.eprint}, and \texttt{format.url}.}
% \changes{4.03}{2002 Jan 14}{Add \texttt{thtit-x}.}
% \changes{4.10}{2003 May 28}{Add \texttt{format.doi}}
% To format a doctoral thesis.
% \begin{macrocode}
FUNCTION {phdthesis}
{ output.bibitem
format.authors "author" output.check
%<ay> author format.key output
%<au-col> add.colon
%<nmdash> name.or.dash
%<dt-beg> format.date "year" output.check
%<dt-beg> date.block
%<!dt-beg&!blk-com&!blk-tit&!blk-tita> new.block
%<*!thtit-x>
%<!thtit-a> format.btitle
%<thtit-a> format.title
"title" output.check
%<thtit-a&blk-com&tit-qq> end.quote.title
%<!blk-com&!blk-tit&!blk-tita> new.block
%<blk-tit&!tit-col> new.sentence
%<blk-tit&tit-col> add.colon
%</!thtit-x>
bbl.phdthesis format.thesis.type output.nonnull
school "school" bibinfo.warn output
address "address" bibinfo.check output
%<!dt-beg&!dt-end> format.date "year" output.check
%<doi> format.doi output
%<*url-blk&!harnm&!revdata>
%<!blk-com&!blk-tit&!blk-tita> new.block
format.url output
%</url-blk&!harnm&!revdata>
%<!blk-com&!blk-tit&!blk-tita> new.block
%<(blk-com|blk-tit|blk-tita)&blknt> new.sentence
format.note output
%<*!dt-beg&dt-end>
%<!blk-com&!blk-tit&!blk-tita> new.block
format.date "year" output.check
%</!dt-beg&dt-end>
%<eprint> format.eprint output
%<revdata> format.url output
fin.entry
%<(harnm|url-nl)&!revdata> write.url
}
% \end{macrocode}
% \end{macro}
%
% \begin{macro}{`proceedings'}
% \changes{3.89d1}{1999 July 20}{AO: call \texttt{format.eprint}, and \texttt{format.url}.}
% \changes{4.10}{2003 May 28}{Add \texttt{format.doi}}
% \begin{macrocode}
%<*ay>
FUNCTION {proceedings}
{ output.bibitem
format.editors output
editor format.key output
%<au-col> add.colon
%<nmdash> name.or.dash
%<dt-beg> format.date "year" output.check
%<dt-beg> date.block
%<!dt-beg&!blk-com&!blk-tit&!blk-tita> new.block
format.btitle "title" output.check
format.bvolume output
%<!numser> format.number.series output
%<!blk-com&!blk-tit&!blk-tita> new.sentence
%<numser> format.number.series output
publisher empty$
{ format.organization.address output }
{ organization "organization" bibinfo.check output
format.publisher.address output
}
if$
%<!dt-beg&!dt-end&!pub-date> format.date "year" output.check
%<isbn> format.isbn output
%<issn> format.issn output
%<doi> format.doi output
%<*url-blk&!harnm&!revdata>
%<!blk-com&!blk-tit&!blk-tita> new.block
format.url output
%</url-blk&!harnm&!revdata>
%<!blk-com&!blk-tit&!blk-tita> new.block
%<(blk-com|blk-tit|blk-tita)&blknt> new.sentence
format.note output
%<*!dt-beg&dt-end&!pub-date>
%<!blk-com&!blk-tit&!blk-tita> new.block
format.date "year" output.check
%</!dt-beg&dt-end&!pub-date>
%<eprint> format.eprint output
%<revdata> format.url output
fin.entry
%<(harnm|url-nl)&!revdata> write.url
}
%</ay>
%<*!ay>
FUNCTION {proceedings}
{ output.bibitem
editor empty$
{ organization "organization" bibinfo.check output
}
{ format.editors output.nonnull }
if$
%<au-col> add.colon
%<nmdash> name.or.dash
%<dt-beg> format.date "year" output.check
%<dt-beg> date.block
%<!dt-beg&!blk-com&!blk-tit&!blk-tita> new.block
format.btitle "title" output.check
format.bvolume output
%<!numser> format.number.series output
editor empty$
{ publisher empty$
'skip$
{
%<!blk-com&!blk-tit&!blk-tita> new.sentence
%<numser> format.number.series output
format.publisher.address output
}
if$
}
{ publisher empty$
{
%<!blk-com&!blk-tit&!blk-tita> new.sentence
format.organization.address output }
{
%<!blk-com&!blk-tit&!blk-tita> new.sentence
organization "organization" bibinfo.check output
format.publisher.address output
}
if$
}
if$
%<!dt-beg&!dt-end&!pub-date> format.date "year" output.check
%<isbn> format.isbn output
%<issn> format.issn output
%<doi> format.doi output
%<*url-blk&!harnm&!revdata>
%<!blk-com&!blk-tit&!blk-tita> new.block
format.url output
%</url-blk&!harnm&!revdata>
%<!blk-com&!blk-tit&!blk-tita> new.block
%<(blk-com|blk-tit|blk-tita)&blknt> new.sentence
format.note output
%<*!dt-beg&dt-end>
%<!blk-com&!blk-tit&!blk-tita> new.block
format.date "year" output.check
%</!dt-beg&dt-end>
%<eprint> format.eprint output
%<revdata> format.url output
fin.entry
%<(harnm|url-nl)&!revdata> write.url
}
%</!ay>
% \end{macrocode}
% \end{macro}
%
% \begin{macro}{`techreport'}
% \changes{3.5}{1995 Oct 4}{Add option \texttt{trtit-b}}
% \changes{3.83}{1997 Feb 25}{Add option \texttt{trnum-it}}
% \changes{3.89d1}{1999 July 20}{AO: institution via \texttt{bibinfo.warn}; call
% \texttt{format.eprint}, and \texttt{format.url}.}
% \changes{4.10}{2003 May 28}{Add \texttt{format.doi}}
% \begin{macrocode}
FUNCTION {techreport}
{ output.bibitem
format.authors "author" output.check
%<ay> author format.key output
%<au-col> add.colon
%<nmdash> name.or.dash
%<dt-beg> format.date "year" output.check
%<dt-beg> date.block
%<!dt-beg&!blk-com&!blk-tit&!blk-tita> new.block
%<trtit-b> format.btitle
%<!trtit-b> format.title
"title" output.check
%<!trtit-b&blk-com&tit-qq> end.quote.title
%<!blk-com&!blk-tit&!blk-tita> new.block
%<blk-tit&!tit-col> new.sentence
%<blk-tit&tit-col> add.colon
%<!trnum-it> format.tr.number output.nonnull
%<trnum-it> format.tr.number emphasize output.nonnull
institution "institution" bibinfo.warn output
address "address" bibinfo.check output
%<!dt-beg&!dt-end> format.date "year" output.check
%<doi> format.doi output
%<*url-blk&!harnm&!revdata>
%<!blk-com&!blk-tit&!blk-tita> new.block
format.url output
%</url-blk&!harnm&!revdata>
%<!blk-com&!blk-tit&!blk-tita> new.block
%<(blk-com|blk-tit|blk-tita)&blknt> new.sentence
format.note output
%<*!dt-beg&dt-end>
%<!blk-com&!blk-tit&!blk-tita> new.block
format.date "year" output.check
%</!dt-beg&dt-end>
%<eprint> format.eprint output
%<revdata> format.url output
fin.entry
%<(harnm|url-nl)&!revdata> write.url
}
% \end{macrocode}
% \end{macro}
%
% \begin{macro}{`unpublished'}
% \changes{3.85}{1997 Nov 25}{Fix date at normal end}
% \changes{3.89d1}{1999 July 20}{AO: call \texttt{format.eprint}, and \texttt{format.url}.}
% \changes{4.10}{2003 May 28}{Add \texttt{format.doi}}
% \begin{macrocode}
FUNCTION {unpublished}
{ output.bibitem
format.authors "author" output.check
%<ay> author format.key output
%<au-col> add.colon
%<nmdash> name.or.dash
%<ay&dt-beg> format.date "year" output.check
%<!ay&dt-beg> format.date output
%<dt-beg> date.block
%<!dt-beg&!blk-com&!blk-tit&!blk-tita> new.block
format.title "title" output.check
%<blk-com&tit-qq> end.quote.title
%<ay&!dt-beg&!dt-end> format.date "year" output.check
%<!ay&!dt-beg&!dt-end> format.date output
%<doi> format.doi output
%<*url-blk&!harnm&!revdata>
%<!blk-com&!blk-tit&!blk-tita> new.block
format.url output
%</url-blk&!harnm&!revdata>
%<!blk-com&!blk-tit&!blk-tita> new.block
%<(blk-com|blk-tit|blk-tita)&blknt> new.sentence
format.note "note" output.check
%<*ay&!dt-beg&dt-end>
%<!blk-com&!blk-tit&!blk-tita> new.block
format.date output
%</ay&!dt-beg&dt-end>
%<*!ay&!dt-beg&dt-end>
%<!blk-com&!blk-tit&!blk-tita> new.block
format.date output
%</!ay&!dt-beg&dt-end>
%<eprint> format.eprint output
%<revdata> format.url output
fin.entry
%<(harnm|url-nl)&!revdata> write.url
}
% \end{macrocode}
% \end{macro}
%
% \begin{macro}{`default.type'}
% \begin{macrocode}
FUNCTION {default.type} { misc }
% \end{macrocode}
% \end{macro}
%
% \begin{macrocode}
READ
% \end{macrocode}
%
% \begin{macrocode}
%<*ay|alph|!seq-no>
% \end{macrocode}
%
% \begin{macro}{`sortify'}
% \changes{3.8}{1996 Feb 29}{Do not allow unsorted alphas}
% In \texttt{btxbst.doc}/\texttt{.mbs}, the \texttt{sortify} function is
% left out for unsorted alpha-style citations. This leads to an error,
% because it is still used. So leave it in here too. \emph{In fact, do away
% with unsorted alpha style, since it is as useless as unsorted author--year
% listings.}
% \begin{macrocode}
FUNCTION {sortify}
{ purify$
"l" change.case$
}
% \end{macrocode}
% \end{macro}
%
% \begin{macrocode}
INTEGERS { len }
% \end{macrocode}
%
% \begin{macro}{`chop.word'}
% \begin{macrocode}
FUNCTION {chop.word}
{ 's :=
'len :=
s #1 len substring$ =
{ s len #1 + global.max$ substring$ }
's
if$
}
% \end{macrocode}
% \end{macro}
%
% \begin{macrocode}
%<*!ay&alph>
% \end{macrocode}
%
% \begin{macro}{`format.lab.names'}
% \changes{3.8}{1996 Feb 29}{Add option \texttt{alph} for \texttt{alpha.bst}
% style of labels}
% \changes{3.84}{1997 Nov 4}{Add options \texttt{alf-1} and \texttt{alf-f}}
% \changes{3.85}{1997 Dec 1}{Add option \texttt{jnrlab}}
% \changes{3.85}{1996 Feb 6}{Recode author font}
% The function \texttt{format.lab.names} formats by author--year or the
% \texttt{alpha} style as in the original \texttt{alpha.bst}.
% Only major difference is that there should be no unsorted (\texttt{seq-no})
% versions of this. Patashnik was clearly very unhappy about accommodating
% such an animal, and in fact, his unsorted alpha style crashes \btx.
% I also provide the \texttt{vonx} option here to ignore the \textsl{von}
% part of the name.
%
% \begin{macrocode}
INTEGERS { et.al.char.used }
% \end{macrocode}
%
% \begin{macrocode}
FUNCTION {initialize.et.al.char.used}
{ #0 'et.al.char.used :=
}
% \end{macrocode}
%
% \begin{macrocode}
EXECUTE {initialize.et.al.char.used}
% \end{macrocode}
%
% \begin{macrocode}
FUNCTION {format.lab.names}
{ 's :=
%<*alf-1>
%<!vonx> s #1 "{v{}}{l{}}" format.name$
%<vonx> s #1 "{l{}}" format.name$
duplicate$ text.length$ #2 <
{ pop$ s #1 "{ll}" format.name$ #3 text.prefix$ }
'skip$
if$
%</alf-1>
%<*!alf-1&alf-f>
%<!vonx> s #1 "{vv{}}{ll}" format.name$
%<vonx> s #1 "{ll}" format.name$
%</!alf-1&alf-f>
%<*!alf-1&!alf-f>
s num.names$ 'numnames :=
numnames #1 >
{ numnames #4 >
{ #3 'namesleft := }
{ numnames 'namesleft := }
if$
#1 'nameptr :=
""
{ namesleft #0 > }
{ nameptr numnames =
{ s nameptr "{ff }{vv }{ll}{ jj}" format.name$ "others" =
{ "{\etalchar{+}}" *
#1 'et.al.char.used :=
}
%<!vonx> { s nameptr "{v{}}{l{}}" format.name$ * }
%<vonx> { s nameptr "{l{}}" format.name$ * }
if$
}
%<!vonx> { s nameptr "{v{}}{l{}}" format.name$ * }
%<vonx> { s nameptr "{l{}}" format.name$ * }
if$
nameptr #1 + 'nameptr :=
namesleft #1 - 'namesleft :=
}
while$
numnames #4 >
{ "{\etalchar{+}}" *
#1 'et.al.char.used :=
}
'skip$
if$
}
%<!vonx> { s #1 "{v{}}{l{}}" format.name$
%<vonx> { s #1 "{l{}}" format.name$
duplicate$ text.length$ #2 <
{ pop$ s #1 "{ll}" format.name$ #3 text.prefix$ }
'skip$
if$
}
if$
%</!alf-1&!alf-f>
}
% \end{macrocode}
%
% \begin{macrocode}
%</!ay&alph>
% \end{macrocode}
% \changes{3.89}{1999 May 20}{Reset \texttt{t}; might still be ``others''
% from last format function}
% \begin{macrocode}
%<*ay>
FUNCTION {format.lab.names}
{ 's :=
"" 't :=
%<!jnrlab> s #1 "{vv~}{ll}" format.name$
%<*jnrlab>
%<!nm-rv&!nm-rvv&!nm-rvx&!nm-rvcx> s #1 "{vv~}{ll}{, jj}" format.name$
%<nm-rv|nm-rvv|nm-rvx|nm-rvcx> s #1 "{vv~}{ll}{ jj}" format.name$
%</jnrlab>
%<lab&and-rm> cite.name.font
s num.names$ duplicate$
#2 >
{ pop$
%<lab&!and-rm&(etal-it|etal-rm)> cite.name.font
%<*!etal-it>
%<lab&and-rm&!etal-rm> " " * bbl.etal cite.name.font *
%<!lab|!and-rm|etal-rm> " " * bbl.etal *
%</!etal-it>
%<etal-it> " " * bbl.etal emphasize *
%<lab&!and-rm&!(etal-it|etal-rm)> cite.name.font
%<lab&!and-rm> "others" 't :=
}
{ #2 <
'skip$
{ s #2 "{ff }{vv }{ll}{ jj}" format.name$ "others" =
{
% %<lab&!and-rm&(etal-it|etal-rm)> cite.name.font
%<*!etal-it>
%<lab&and-rm&!etal-rm> " " * bbl.etal cite.name.font *
%<!lab|!and-rm|etal-rm> " " * bbl.etal *
%</!etal-it>
%<etal-it> " " * bbl.etal emphasize *
%<lab&!and-rm&!(etal-it|etal-rm)> cite.name.font
%<lab&!and-rm> "others" 't :=
}
%<*!harnm>
%<*!amper>
{ bbl.and space.word * s #2 "{vv~}{ll}" format.name$
%<lab&and-rm> cite.name.font
* }
%</!amper>
%<*amper>
{ " \& " * s #2 "{vv~}{ll}" format.name$
%<lab&and-rm> cite.name.font
* }
%</amper>
%</!harnm>
%<*harnm>
{ " \harvardand{} " * s #2 "{vv~}{ll}" format.name$
%<lab&and-rm> cite.name.font
* }
%</harnm>
if$
}
if$
}
if$
%<*lab&!and-rm>
t "others" =
'skip$
{ cite.name.font }
if$
%</lab&!and-rm>
}
%</ay>
% \end{macrocode}
% \end{macro}
%
% \begin{macro}{`author.key.label'}
% \begin{macro}{`author.editor.key.label'}
% \begin{macro}{`author.key.organization.label'}
% \begin{macro}{`editor.key.organization.label'}
% \begin{macro}{`editor.key.label'}
% Have to be very careful with the options \texttt{ay}, \texttt{alph}, and
% \texttt{seq-no} here. The first two are actually mutually exclusive, and
% \texttt{ay} should dominate. The \texttt{seq-no} option only applies for
% numerical (\texttt{!ay}) but not alphabetic (\texttt{alph}) selections.
% This whole block of coding dealing with labels is only included for
% author--year or alphabetic or ordered numerical.
% That is, \texttt{ay} or \texttt{alph} or \texttt{!seq-no} is true.
% \begin{macrocode}
%<*ay|alph>
FUNCTION {author.key.label}
{ author empty$
{ key empty$
{ cite$ #1 #3 substring$ }
%<ay> 'key
%<!ay> { key #3 text.prefix$ }
if$
}
{ author format.lab.names }
if$
}
FUNCTION {author.editor.key.label}
{ author empty$
{ editor empty$
{ key empty$
{ cite$ #1 #3 substring$ }
%<ay> 'key
%<!ay> { key #3 text.prefix$ }
if$
}
{ editor format.lab.names }
if$
}
{ author format.lab.names }
if$
}
%</ay|alph>
%<*!ay&alph>
FUNCTION {author.key.organization.label}
{ author empty$
{ key empty$
{ organization empty$
{ cite$ #1 #3 substring$ }
{ "The " #4 organization chop.word #3 text.prefix$ }
if$
}
{ key #3 text.prefix$ }
if$
}
{ author format.lab.names }
if$
}
FUNCTION {editor.key.organization.label}
{ editor empty$
{ key empty$
{ organization empty$
{ cite$ #1 #3 substring$ }
{ "The " #4 organization chop.word #3 text.prefix$ }
if$
}
{ key #3 text.prefix$ }
if$
}
{ editor format.lab.names }
if$
}
%</!ay&alph>
%<*ay>
FUNCTION {editor.key.label}
{ editor empty$
{ key empty$
{ cite$ #1 #3 substring$ }
'key
if$
}
{ editor format.lab.names }
if$
}
% \end{macrocode}
% \end{macro}
% \end{macro}
% \end{macro}
% \end{macro}
% \end{macro}
%
% \begin{macro}{`calc.short.authors'}
% \changes{3.3}{1995 Sep 4}{Add function to store short list of authors
% for later test}
% \begin{macrocode}
FUNCTION {calc.short.authors}
{ type$ "book" =
type$ "inbook" =
or
'author.editor.key.label
{ type$ "proceedings" =
'editor.key.label
'author.key.label
if$
}
if$
'short.list :=
}
% \end{macrocode}
% \end{macro}
%
% \begin{macro}{`calc.label'}
% \changes{1.5(2.3)a}{1994 Oct 11}{Add option \texttt{note-yr}}
% \changes{3.0}{1995 Mar 3}{Add options \texttt{lab-bf} and \texttt{lab-sc}}
% \changes{3.3}{1995 Sep 4}{Use \texttt{calc.short.authors}}
% \changes{3.8}{1996 Feb 29}{Add \texttt{calc.label} from \texttt{alpha.bst}}
% \changes{3.89}{1999 May 12}{Add \texttt{keyxyr} option}
% \begin{macrocode}
FUNCTION {calc.label}
{ calc.short.authors
short.list
%<!(har|ast|cay|nmd|alk|cn)> "("
%<har|ast|cay|nmd|alk|cn> ", "
*
year duplicate$ empty$
%<keyxyr> short.list key field.or.null = or
%<(blkyear|keyxyr)> { pop$ "" }
%<!(blkyear|keyxyr)> { pop$ "????" }
%<!note-yr> { purify$ #-1 #4 substring$ }
%<note-yr> 'skip$
if$
*
'label :=
}
%</ay>
%<*!ay&alph>
FUNCTION {calc.label}
{ type$ "book" =
type$ "inbook" =
or
'author.editor.key.label
{ type$ "proceedings" =
'editor.key.organization.label
{ type$ "manual" =
'author.key.organization.label
'author.key.label
if$
}
if$
}
if$
duplicate$
year field.or.null purify$ #-1 #2 substring$
*
'label :=
year field.or.null purify$ #-1 #4 substring$
*
sortify 'sort.label :=
}
% \end{macrocode}
% \end{macro}
%
% \begin{macrocode}
%</!ay&alph>
% \end{macrocode}
%
% \begin{macrocode}
%<*ay>
% \end{macrocode}
%
% \begin{macrocode}
%<*har|cay|nmd|ast|cn>
% \end{macrocode}
%
% \begin{macro}{`calc.short.label'}
% \changes{3.3}{1995 Sep 4}{Use \texttt{calc.short.authors}}
%
% \begin{macrocode}
FUNCTION {calc.short.label}
{ calc.short.authors short.list
'label :=
}
% \end{macrocode}
% \end{macro}
%
% \begin{macrocode}
%</har|cay|nmd|ast|cn>
% \end{macrocode}
%
% \begin{macrocode}
%</ay>
% \end{macrocode}
%
% \begin{macro}{`sort.format.names'}
% \changes{1.7(2.5)}{1995 Feb 9}{Make ordering of `et al' works by year
% and authors and not just year}
% \changes{3.0}{1995 Feb 27}{Option \texttt{nm-revf} to act just as default}
% \changes{3.2}{1995 Jun 16}{Add option \texttt{vonx} so sorting ignores the
% \emph{von} part of the name}
% \changes{3.5}{1995 Oct 24}{For limited authors, sort only on those present}
% \changes{3.5}{1995 Oct 24}{`Et al' considered author before all others}
% \changes{3.83}{1997 Feb 25}{`Et al' considered author after all others}
% \begin{macrocode}
FUNCTION {sort.format.names}
{ 's :=
#1 'nameptr :=
""
s num.names$ 'numnames :=
numnames 'namesleft :=
{ namesleft #0 > }
{ s nameptr
%<*!nm-init&!nm-rev&!nm-rev1&!nm-rv&!nm-rvx&!nm-rvcx&!nm-rvv>
%<!vonx> "{vv{ } }{ll{ }}{ ff{ }}{ jj{ }}"
%<vonx> "{ll{ }}{ ff{ }}{ jj{ }}"
%</!nm-init&!nm-rev&!nm-rev1&!nm-rv&!nm-rvx&!nm-rvcx&!nm-rvv>
%<*nm-init|nm-rev|nm-rev1|nm-rv|nm-rvx|nm-rvcx|nm-rvv>
%<!vonx> "{vv{ } }{ll{ }}{ f{ }}{ jj{ }}"
%<vonx> "{ll{ }}{ f{ }}{ jj{ }}"
%</nm-init|nm-rev|nm-rev1|nm-rv|nm-rvx|nm-rvcx|nm-rvv>
format.name$ 't :=
nameptr #1 >
{
%<*nmlm>
%<m1> nameptr #1
%<m2> nameptr #2
%<m3> nameptr #3
%<m4> nameptr #4
%<m5> nameptr #5
%<m6> nameptr #6
%<m7> nameptr #7
%<m8> nameptr #8
%<m9> nameptr #9
%<m0> nameptr #0
%<m10> #10 +
%<m20> #20 +
%<m30> #30 +
%<m40> #40 +
%<m50> #50 +
%<m60> #60 +
%<m70> #70 +
%<m80> #80 +
%<m90> #90 +
#1 + =
%<x1> numnames #1
%<x2> numnames #2
%<x3> numnames #3
%<x4> numnames #4
%<x5> numnames #5
%<x6> numnames #6
%<x7> numnames #7
%<x8> numnames #8
%<x9> numnames #9
%<x0> numnames #0
%<x10> #10 +
%<x20> #20 +
%<x30> #30 +
%<x40> #40 +
%<x50> #50 +
%<x60> #60 +
%<x70> #70 +
%<x80> #80 +
%<x90> #90 +
> and
{ "others" 't :=
#1 'namesleft := }
'skip$
if$
%</nmlm>
" " *
namesleft #1 = t "others" = and
{ "zzzzz" * }
%<*seq-lab|seq-key>
{ numnames #2 > nameptr #2 = and
{ "zz" * year field.or.null * " " * }
'skip$
if$
t sortify *
}
%</seq-lab|seq-key>
%<!seq-lab&!seq-key> { t sortify * }
if$
}
{ t sortify * }
if$
nameptr #1 + 'nameptr :=
namesleft #1 - 'namesleft :=
}
while$
}
% \end{macrocode}
% \end{macro}
%
% \begin{macro}{`sort.format.title'}
% \begin{macrocode}
FUNCTION {sort.format.title}
{ 't :=
"A " #2
"An " #3
"The " #4 t chop.word
chop.word
chop.word
sortify
#1 global.max$ substring$
}
% \end{macrocode}
% \end{macro}
%
% \begin{macro}{`author.sort'}
% \begin{macrocode}
FUNCTION {author.sort}
{ author empty$
{ key empty$
{ "to sort, need author or key in " cite$ * warning$
""
}
{ key sortify }
if$
}
{ author sort.format.names }
if$
}
% \end{macrocode}
% \end{macro}
%
% \begin{macro}{`author.editor.sort'}
% \begin{macrocode}
FUNCTION {author.editor.sort}
{ author empty$
{ editor empty$
{ key empty$
{ "to sort, need author, editor, or key in " cite$ * warning$
""
}
{ key sortify }
if$
}
{ editor sort.format.names }
if$
}
{ author sort.format.names }
if$
}
% \end{macrocode}
% \end{macro}
%
% \begin{macro}{`negate.year'}
% \changes{4.03}{2002 Jan 14}{Add function for ordering by descending years}
% This function negates the year by substituting each digit by its
% complement. That is, 0 $\rightarrow$ 9, 1 $\rightarrow$ 8, etc. This is used
% to provide ordering by descending year (latest year first).
% \begin{macrocode}
%<*seq-yrr&!seq-yr>
FUNCTION {negate.year}
{ year empty$
{ "99999" }
{ year #1 #1 substring$ chr.to.int$ #105 swap$ - int.to.chr$
year #2 #1 substring$ chr.to.int$ #105 swap$ - int.to.chr$ *
year #3 #1 substring$ chr.to.int$ #105 swap$ - int.to.chr$ *
year #4 #1 substring$ chr.to.int$ #105 swap$ - int.to.chr$ *
}
if$
}
%</seq-yrr&!seq-yr>
% \end{macrocode}
% \end{macro}
%
% \begin{macrocode}
%<*ay>
% \end{macrocode}
%
% \begin{macro}{`editor.sort'}
% \begin{macrocode}
FUNCTION {editor.sort}
{ editor empty$
{ key empty$
{ "to sort, need editor or key in " cite$ * warning$
""
}
{ key sortify }
if$
}
{ editor sort.format.names }
if$
}
% \end{macrocode}
% \end{macro}
%
% \begin{macrocode}
%<*seq-no>
% \end{macrocode}
%
% \begin{macrocode}
INTEGERS { seq.num }
% \end{macrocode}
%
% \begin{macro}{`init.seq'}
% \begin{macrocode}
FUNCTION {init.seq}
{ #0 'seq.num :=}
% \end{macrocode}
% \end{macro}
%
% \begin{macrocode}
EXECUTE {init.seq}
% \end{macrocode}
%
% \begin{macro}{`int.to.fix'}
% \begin{macrocode}
FUNCTION {int.to.fix}
{ "000000000" swap$ int.to.str$ *
#-1 #10 substring$
}
% \end{macrocode}
% \end{macro}
%
% \begin{macrocode}
%</seq-no>
% \end{macrocode}
%
% \begin{macro}{`presort'}
% \changes{3.81}{1996 Sep 16}{Add option \texttt{seq-no} to author--year}
% For unsorted author--year, make up the final sorting order in
% \texttt{sort.label} with the original sequence number, for unsorting later.
% \begin{macrocode}
FUNCTION {presort}
{ calc.label
label sortify
" "
*
%<*!seq-no>
type$ "book" =
type$ "inbook" =
or
'author.editor.sort
{ type$ "proceedings" =
'editor.sort
'author.sort
if$
}
if$
#1 entry.max$ substring$
%</!seq-no>
%<*seq-no>
seq.num #1 + 'seq.num :=
seq.num int.to.fix
%</seq-no>
'sort.label :=
sort.label
*
" "
*
%<seq-yr> " " * year field.or.null *
%<seq-yrr&!seq-yr> " " * negate.year field.or.null *
%<*!seq-key&!seq-yr&!seq-yrr>
title field.or.null
sort.format.title
%</!seq-key&!seq-yr&!seq-yrr>
%<seq-key|seq-yr|seq-yrr> cite$
*
#1 entry.max$ substring$
'sort.key$ :=
}
% \end{macrocode}
% \end{macro}
%
% \begin{macrocode}
%</ay>
% \end{macrocode}
%
% \begin{macrocode}
%<*!ay>
% \end{macrocode}
%
% \begin{macro}{`author.organization.sort'}
% \begin{macrocode}
FUNCTION {author.organization.sort}
{ author empty$
{ organization empty$
{ key empty$
{ "to sort, need author, organization, or key in " cite$ * warning$
""
}
{ key sortify }
if$
}
{ "The " #4 organization chop.word sortify }
if$
}
{ author sort.format.names }
if$
}
% \end{macrocode}
% \end{macro}
%
% \begin{macro}{`editor.organization.sort'}
% \begin{macrocode}
FUNCTION {editor.organization.sort}
{ editor empty$
{ organization empty$
{ key empty$
{ "to sort, need editor, organization, or key in " cite$ * warning$
""
}
{ key sortify }
if$
}
{ "The " #4 organization chop.word sortify }
if$
}
{ editor sort.format.names }
if$
}
% \end{macrocode}
% \end{macro}
%
% \begin{macro}{`presort'}
% \begin{macrocode}
FUNCTION {presort}
%<*alph>
{ calc.label
sort.label
" "
*
type$ "book" =
%</alph>
%<!alph>{ type$ "book" =
type$ "inbook" =
or
'author.editor.sort
{ type$ "proceedings" =
'editor.organization.sort
{ type$ "manual" =
'author.organization.sort
'author.sort
if$
}
if$
}
if$
%<alph> *
" "
*
%<seq-yrr> negate.year field.or.null sortify
%<!seq-yrr> year field.or.null sortify
%<!(seq-yr|seq-yrr)|alph> *
" "
*
%<(seq-yr|seq-yrr)&!alph> swap$ *
title field.or.null
sort.format.title
*
#1 entry.max$ substring$
'sort.key$ :=
}
% \end{macrocode}
% \end{macro}
%
% \begin{macrocode}
%</!ay>
% \end{macrocode}
%
% \begin{macrocode}
ITERATE {presort}
% \end{macrocode}
%
% \begin{macrocode}
SORT
% \end{macrocode}
%
% \begin{macrocode}
%</ay|alph|!seq-no>
% \end{macrocode}
%
% \subsection{`forward.pass'}
% \changes{3.4}{1995 Sep 5}{Include number of references in argument to
% \texttt{thebibliography} environment}
% With version~6.0 of \texttt{natbib}, the author-year styles can also be
% used for numerical citations; then the \texttt{thebibliography} environment
% must have an argument indicating the length of the longest label.
% Simply count the references and add this number as the argument.
% \begin{macrocode}
%<*ay>
% \end{macrocode}
%
% \begin{macrocode}
STRINGS { last.label next.extra }
% \end{macrocode}
%
% \begin{macrocode}
INTEGERS { last.extra.num number.label }
% \end{macrocode}
%
% \begin{macro}{`initialize.extra.label.stuff'}
% \begin{macrocode}
FUNCTION {initialize.extra.label.stuff}
{ #0 int.to.chr$ 'last.label :=
"" 'next.extra :=
#0 'last.extra.num :=
#0 'number.label :=
}
% \end{macrocode}
% \end{macro}
%
% \begin{macro}{`forward.pass'}
% \begin{macrocode}
FUNCTION {forward.pass}
{ last.label label =
{ last.extra.num #1 + 'last.extra.num :=
last.extra.num int.to.chr$ 'extra.label :=
}
{ "a" chr.to.int$ 'last.extra.num :=
"" 'extra.label :=
label 'last.label :=
}
if$
number.label #1 + 'number.label :=
}
% \end{macrocode}
% \end{macro}
%
% \begin{macrocode}
%</ay>
% \end{macrocode}
%
% \begin{macrocode}
%<*!ay&alph>
% \end{macrocode}
%
% \begin{macrocode}
STRINGS { longest.label last.sort.label next.extra }
% \end{macrocode}
%
% \begin{macrocode}
INTEGERS { longest.label.width last.extra.num }
% \end{macrocode}
%
% \begin{macro}{`initialize.longest.label'}
% \begin{macrocode}
FUNCTION {initialize.longest.label}
{ "" 'longest.label :=
#0 int.to.chr$ 'last.sort.label :=
"" 'next.extra :=
#0 'longest.label.width :=
#0 'last.extra.num :=
}
% \end{macrocode}
% \end{macro}
%
% \begin{macro}{`forward.pass'}
% \begin{macrocode}
FUNCTION {forward.pass}
{ last.sort.label sort.label =
{ last.extra.num #1 + 'last.extra.num :=
last.extra.num int.to.chr$ 'extra.label :=
}
{ "a" chr.to.int$ 'last.extra.num :=
"" 'extra.label :=
sort.label 'last.sort.label :=
}
if$
}
% \end{macrocode}
% \end{macro}
%
% \begin{macrocode}
%</!ay&alph>
% \end{macrocode}
%
% \begin{macro}{`reverse.pass'}
% \changes{3.3}{1995 Aug 7}{Put extra label in braces}
% The extra label is added in braces so that natbib can treat it as one unit.
% This allows extra labels to be more than one letter long. For non-NFSS
% emphasizing, this is no problem, since labels go in |{\em a}|, but for
% non-emphasizing and for NFSS, it caused troubles without the braces.
% The trouble arises with multiple citations in one |\cite| in which
% authors and years are the same, and only the extra label is given for
% the next one. Note: |\emph{a}| is more than one letter long in this sense,
% so it is not just a problem for more than 26 papers with same authors and
% year.
%
% \changes{3.81}{1996 Jun 17}{Add \texttt{\char`\\natexlab}}
% The command |\natexlab| now encloses the extra label for \texttt{natbib}
% styles. This command normally just prints its argument, but for numerical
% citation mode, it swallows its argument. This allows the extra labels to
% be suppressed for numerical citations where they are superfluous.
% The enclosing braces mentioned above must be included here to make the
% entire extra label text a single token for \texttt{natbib}.
% \begin{macrocode}
%<*ay>
% \end{macrocode}
%
% \begin{macrocode}
FUNCTION {reverse.pass}
{ next.extra "b" =
{ "a" 'extra.label := }
'skip$
if$
extra.label 'next.extra :=
extra.label
%<xlab-it> emphasize
%<*!html>
duplicate$ empty$
'skip$
{ "{\natexlab{" swap$ * "}}" * }
if$
%</!html>
'extra.label :=
%<!(har|ast|cay|nmd|cn)> label extra.label * 'label :=
}
% \end{macrocode}
%
% \begin{macrocode}
%</ay>
% \end{macrocode}
%
% \begin{macrocode}
%<*!ay&alph>
% \end{macrocode}
%
% \begin{macrocode}
FUNCTION {reverse.pass}
{ next.extra "b" =
{ "a" 'extra.label := }
'skip$
if$
label extra.label * 'label :=
label width$ longest.label.width >
{ label 'longest.label :=
label width$ 'longest.label.width :=
}
'skip$
if$
extra.label 'next.extra :=
}
% \end{macrocode}
%
% \begin{macrocode}
%</!ay&alph>
% \end{macrocode}
% \end{macro}
%
% \begin{macrocode}
%<ay>EXECUTE {initialize.extra.label.stuff}
%<!ay&alph>EXECUTE {initialize.longest.label}
% \end{macrocode}
%
% \begin{macrocode}
%<*ay|alph>
ITERATE {forward.pass}
% \end{macrocode}
%
% \begin{macrocode}
REVERSE {reverse.pass}
% \end{macrocode}
%
% \begin{macrocode}
%</ay|alph>
% \end{macrocode}
%
% \begin{macrocode}
%<*ay>
FUNCTION {bib.sort.order}
{ sort.label
" "
*
%<seq-yrr> negate.year field.or.null sortify
%<!seq-yrr> year field.or.null sortify
%<(seq-yr|seq-yrr)&!(seq-lab|seq-key)> swap$
*
" "
*
%<*!seq-key&!seq-yr&!seq-yrr>
title field.or.null
sort.format.title
%</!seq-key&!seq-yr&!seq-yrr>
%<seq-key|seq-yr|seq-yrr> cite$
*
#1 entry.max$ substring$
'sort.key$ :=
%<har|cay|nmd|cn|ast> calc.short.label
}
% \end{macrocode}
%
% \begin{macrocode}
ITERATE {bib.sort.order}
% \end{macrocode}
%
% \begin{macrocode}
SORT
% \end{macrocode}
%
% \begin{macrocode}
%</ay>
% \end{macrocode}
%
% \begin{macrocode}
%<*!ay&!alph>
% \end{macrocode}
%
% \begin{macrocode}
STRINGS { longest.label }
% \end{macrocode}
%
% \begin{macrocode}
INTEGERS { number.label longest.label.width }
% \end{macrocode}
%
% \begin{macrocode}
FUNCTION {initialize.longest.label}
{ "" 'longest.label :=
#1 'number.label :=
#0 'longest.label.width :=
}
% \end{macrocode}
%
% \begin{macrocode}
FUNCTION {longest.label.pass}
%<*!cite>
{ number.label int.to.str$ 'label :=
number.label #1 + 'number.label :=
%</!cite>
%<cite>{ cite$ 'label :=
label width$ longest.label.width >
{ label 'longest.label :=
label width$ 'longest.label.width :=
}
'skip$
if$
}
% \end{macrocode}
%
% \begin{macrocode}
EXECUTE {initialize.longest.label}
% \end{macrocode}
%
% \begin{macrocode}
ITERATE {longest.label.pass}
% \end{macrocode}
%
% \begin{macrocode}
%</!ay&!alph>
% \end{macrocode}
%
% \begin{macro}{`begin.bib'}
% \changes{2.0}{1994 Jan 31}{For \texttt{german}, add the definition of
% {\tt\protect\bslash qq} to replace double-quote character.}
% \changes{2.0}{1994 Jan 31}{For \texttt{babel}, read in file
% \texttt{babelbst.tex} in \texttt{thebibliography} to define the word
% commands.}
% \changes{3.4}{1995 Sep 5}{Add number of references as argument}
% \changes{3.89d1}{1999 July 20}{AO: provide default meanings for procedures used.}
% The function \texttt{begin.bib} writes the initial text to the \texttt{.bbl}
% file. The most important matter here is that the \texttt{thebibliography}
% environment is invoked.
%
% Note: the French quotation marks are called `guillimets'; Adobe erroneously
% named the symbols `guillimot', which is an arctic bird. The error has so
% propagated, that it can no longer be corrected. \LaTeX\ took it over.
% \begin{macrocode}
FUNCTION {begin.bib}
%<*!html>
%<*!ay&alph>
{ et.al.char.used
{ "\newcommand{\etalchar}[1]{$^{#1}$}" write$ newline$ }
'skip$
if$
preamble$ empty$
%</!ay&alph>
%<ay|!alph>{ preamble$ empty$
'skip$
{ preamble$ write$ newline$ }
if$
%<ay> "\begin{thebibliography}{" number.label int.to.str$ * "}" *
%<!ay> "\begin{thebibliography}{" longest.label * "}" *
write$ newline$
%<*(!nmft&(nmft-it|nmft-sc|nmft-bf|nmft-def))|(!lab&(lab-it|lab-bf|lab-sc|lab-def))>
"\typeout{**********************************}" write$ newline$
"\typeout{WARNING WARNING WARNING WARNING WARNING}" write$ newline$
"\typeout{The bst file has been generated with inconsistent options}"
write$ newline$
"\typeout{Read the warning message at the start of the bst file}"
write$ newline$
"\typeout{**********************************}" write$ newline$
%</(!nmft&(nmft-it|nmft-sc|nmft-bf|nmft-def))|(!lab&(lab-it|lab-bf|lab-sc|lab-def))>
%<*!plntx>
%<!tit-it&tit-qq&qt-s> "\newcommand{\enquote}[1]{`#1'}"
%<!tit-it&tit-qq&!qt-s&!qt-g> "\newcommand{\enquote}[1]{``#1''}"
%</!plntx>
%<*plntx>
%<!tit-it&tit-qq&qt-s> "\def\enquote#1{`#1'}"
%<!tit-it&tit-qq&!qt-s&!qt-g> "\def\enquote#1{``#1''}"
%</plntx>
%<*!tit-it&tit-qq&!qt-s&qt-g>
%<!plntx> "\ProvideTextCommand{\guillemotleft}{OT1}{%"
%<plntx> "\def\guillemotleft{%"
write$ newline$
" \leavevmode\raise .27ex\hbox{$\scriptscriptstyle\ll$}}"
write$ newline$
%<!plntx> "\ProvideTextCommand{\guillemotright}{OT1}{%"
%<plntx> "\def\guillemotright{%"
write$ newline$
" \leavevmode\raise .27ex\hbox{$\scriptscriptstyle\gg$}}"
write$ newline$
%<!plntx> "\newcommand{\enquote}[1]{\guillemotleft#1\guillemotright}"
%<plntx> "\def\enquote#1{\guillemotleft#1\guillemotright}"
%</!tit-it&tit-qq&!qt-s&qt-g>
%<!tit-it&tit-qq> write$ newline$
%<umlaut> "\let\qq=\" quote$ * write$ newline$
%<em-ul> "\expandafter\ifx\csname uline\endcsname\relax\let\uline\underline\fi"
%<em-ul> write$ newline$
%<*ay>
%<!plntx> "\providecommand{\natexlab}[1]{#1}"
%<plntx> "\expandafter\ifx\csname natexlab\endcsname\relax\def\natexlab#1{#1}\fi"
write$ newline$
%<*har>
"{\catcode`\|=0\catcode`\#=12\catcode`\@=11\catcode`\\=12" write$ newline$
"|immediate|write|@auxout{\expandafter\ifx\csname natexlab\endcsname\relax\gdef\natexlab#1{#1}\fi}}"
write$ newline$
%</har>
%</ay>
%<*nmft&nmft-def>
%<!plntx> "\providecommand{\bibnamefont}[1]{#1}"
%<plntx> "\expandafter\ifx\csname bibnamefont\endcsname\relax"
%<plntx> write$ newline$
%<plntx> " \def\bibnamefont#1{#1}\fi"
write$ newline$
%</nmft&nmft-def>
%<*nmft&fnm-def>
%<!plntx> "\providecommand{\bibfnamefont}[1]{#1}"
%<plntx> "\expandafter\ifx\csname bibfnamefont\endcsname\relax"
%<plntx> write$ newline$
%<plntx> " \def\bibfnamefont#1{#1}\fi"
write$ newline$
%</nmft&fnm-def>
%<*lab&lab-def>
%<!plntx> "\providecommand{\citenamefont}[1]{#1}"
%<plntx> "\expandafter\ifx\csname citenamefont\endcsname\relax"
%<plntx> write$ newline$
%<plntx> " \def\citenamefont#1{#1}\fi"
write$ newline$
%</lab&lab-def>
%<*(url&!harnm)|eprint>
%<*!plntx>
%<nfss> "\providecommand{\url}[1]{\texttt{#1}}"
%<!nfss> "\providecommand{\url}[1]{{\tt #1}}"
write$ newline$
"\providecommand{\urlprefix}{URL }"
write$ newline$
%</!plntx>
%<*plntx>
"\expandafter\ifx\csname url\endcsname\relax"
write$ newline$
%<nfss> " \def\url#1{\texttt{#1}}\fi"
%<!nfss> " \def\url#1{{\tt #1}}\fi"
write$ newline$
"\expandafter\ifx\csname urlprefix\endcsname\relax\def\urlprefix{URL }\fi"
write$ newline$
%</plntx>
%</(url&!harnm)|eprint>
%<*doi>
"\expandafter\ifx\csname urlstyle\endcsname\relax"
write$ newline$
%<*!plntx>
" \providecommand{\doi}[1]{doi:\discretionary{}{}{}#1}\else"
write$ newline$
" \providecommand{\doi}{doi:\discretionary{}{}{}\begingroup \urlstyle{rm}\Url}\fi"
write$ newline$
%</!plntx>
%<*plntx>
" \expandafter\ifx\csname doi\endcsname\relax"
write$ newline$
" \def\doi#1{doi:\discretionary{}{}{}#1}\fi \else"
write$ newline$
" \expandafter\ifx\csname doi\endcsname\relax"
write$ newline$
" \def\doi{doi:\discretionary{}{}{}\begingroup \urlstyle{rm}\Url}\fi \fi"
write$ newline$
%</plntx>
%</doi>
%<*lang>
%<!plntx> "\providecommand{\selectlanguage}[1]{\relax}"
%<*plntx>
"\expandafter\ifx\csname selectlanguage\endcsname\relax"
write$ newline$
" \def\selectlanguage#1{}\fi"
%</plntx>
write$ newline$
%</lang>
%<*!plntx>
%<*babel>
"\input{babelbst.tex}" write$ newline$
"\newcommand{\Capitalize}[1]{\uppercase{#1}}" write$ newline$
"\newcommand{\capitalize}[1]{\expandafter\Capitalize#1}" write$ newline$
%</babel>
%<*annote>
"\providecommand{\bibAnnoteFile}[1]{%"
write$ newline$
" \IfFileExists{#1}{\begin{quotation}\noindent\textsc{Key:} #1\\"
write$ newline$
" \textsc{Annotation:}\ \input{#1}\end{quotation}}{}}"
write$ newline$
"\providecommand{\bibAnnote}[2]{%"
write$ newline$
" \begin{quotation}\noindent\textsc{Key:} #1\\"
write$ newline$
" \textsc{Annotation:}\ #2\end{quotation}}"
write$ newline$
%</annote>
%</!plntx>
%<*bibinfo>
%<!plntx> "\providecommand{\bibinfo}[2]{#2}"
%<plntx> "\expandafter\ifx\csname bibinfo\endcsname\relax\def\bibinfo#1#2{#2}\fi"
write$ newline$
%</bibinfo>
%<*eprint>
%<!plntx> "\providecommand{\eprint}[2][]{\url{#2}}"
%<plntx> "\expandafter\ifx\csname eprint\endcsname\relax\def\eprint#1{\url{#1}}\fi"
write$ newline$
%</eprint>
}
%</!html>
%<*html>
{
"<html><head><title>Bibliography Listing</title></head>" write$ newline$
"<body>" write$ newline$
"<h2>Bibliography</h2>" write$ newline$
%<htdes>"<dl>" write$ newline$
%<!htdes&htlist>"<ol>" write$ newline$
}
%</html>
% \end{macrocode}
% \end{macro}
%
% \begin{macrocode}
EXECUTE {begin.bib}
% \end{macrocode}
%
% \begin{macrocode}
EXECUTE {init.state.consts}
% \end{macrocode}
%
% \begin{macrocode}
ITERATE {call.type$}
% \end{macrocode}
%
% \begin{macro}{`end.bib'}
% \begin{macrocode}
FUNCTION {end.bib}
{ newline$
%<!html> "\end{thebibliography}" write$ newline$
%<html> "</dl></body></html>" write$ newline$
}
% \end{macrocode}
% \end{macro}
%
% \begin{macrocode}
EXECUTE {end.bib}
% \end{macrocode}
%
% \begin{macrocode}
%</!head>
% \end{macrocode}
%
% \begin{macrocode}
%</!options&!driver&!bblbst>
% \end{macrocode}
%
% \section{The File \texttt{babelbst.tex} for English}
% The following contains the definitions for the \texttt{babel} language
% selection as they apply to English. This file may be extracted with
% \dtx{} and the option \texttt{bblbst}.
% \begin{macrocode}
%<*bblbst>
% This is babelbst.tex for English.
% It should serve as a model for other languages.
% Alternatively, store it under a different name (e.g. englbst.tex)
% and then \input it with a command in babelbst.tex.
\def\bbland{and} \def\bbletal{et~al.}
\def\bbleditors{editors} \def\bbleds{eds.}
\def\bbleditor{editor} \def\bbled{ed.}
\def\bbledby{edited by}
\def\bbledition{edition} \def\bbledn{edn.}
\def\bblvolume{volume} \def\bblvol{vol.}
\def\bblof{of}
\def\bblnumber{number} \def\bblno{no.}
\def\bblin{in}
\def\bblpages{pages} \def\bblpp{pp.}
\def\bblpage{page} \def\bblp{p.}
\def\bbleidpp{pages}
\def\bblchapter{chapter} \def\bblchap{chap.}
\def\bbltechreport{Technical Report}
\def\bbltechrep{Tech. Rep.}
\def\bblmthesis{Master's thesis}
\def\bblphdthesis{Ph.D. thesis}
\def\bblfirst{First} \def\bblfirsto{1st}
\def\bblsecond{Second} \def\bblsecondo{2nd}
\def\bblthird{Third} \def\bblthirdo{3rd}
\def\bblfourth{Fourth} \def\bblfourtho{4th}
\def\bblfifth{Fifth} \def\bblfiftho{5th}
\def\bblst{st} \def\bblnd{nd} \def\bblrd{rd}
\def\bblth{th}
\def\bbljan{January} \def\bblfeb{February} \def\bblmar{March}
\def\bblapr{April} \def\bblmay{May} \def\bbljun{June}
\def\bbljul{July} \def\bblaug{August} \def\bblsep{September}
\def\bbloct{October} \def\bblnov{November} \def\bbldec{December}
%</bblbst>
% \end{macrocode}
%
% \Finale
|